US20150368653A1 - Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors - Google Patents

Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20150368653A1
US20150368653A1 US14/716,141 US201514716141A US2015368653A1 US 20150368653 A1 US20150368653 A1 US 20150368653A1 US 201514716141 A US201514716141 A US 201514716141A US 2015368653 A1 US2015368653 A1 US 2015368653A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
morpholino oligomer
antisense
antisense morpholino
oligomer
inflammation
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US14/716,141
Inventor
Patrick L. Iversen
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Sarepta Therapeutics Inc
Original Assignee
Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. filed Critical Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc.
Priority to US14/716,141 priority Critical patent/US20150368653A1/en
Publication of US20150368653A1 publication Critical patent/US20150368653A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/11DNA or RNA fragments; Modified forms thereof; Non-coding nucleic acids having a biological activity
    • C12N15/113Non-coding nucleic acids modulating the expression of genes, e.g. antisense oligonucleotides; Antisense DNA or RNA; Triplex- forming oligonucleotides; Catalytic nucleic acids, e.g. ribozymes; Nucleic acids used in co-suppression or gene silencing
    • C12N15/1138Non-coding nucleic acids modulating the expression of genes, e.g. antisense oligonucleotides; Antisense DNA or RNA; Triplex- forming oligonucleotides; Catalytic nucleic acids, e.g. ribozymes; Nucleic acids used in co-suppression or gene silencing against receptors or cell surface proteins
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/06Antiasthmatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P19/00Drugs for skeletal disorders
    • A61P19/02Drugs for skeletal disorders for joint disorders, e.g. arthritis, arthrosis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/28Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating neurodegenerative disorders of the central nervous system, e.g. nootropic agents, cognition enhancers, drugs for treating Alzheimer's disease or other forms of dementia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/10Type of nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/11Antisense
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/31Chemical structure of the backbone
    • C12N2310/314Phosphoramidates
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/32Chemical structure of the sugar
    • C12N2310/323Chemical structure of the sugar modified ring structure
    • C12N2310/3233Morpholino-type ring
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/35Nature of the modification
    • C12N2310/351Conjugate
    • C12N2310/3513Protein; Peptide

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to antisense oligonucleotides and other agents that target nuclear hormone receptors (NHRs) and methods of use thereof.
  • NHRs nuclear hormone receptors
  • NHR nuclear hormone receptor
  • the nuclear hormone receptor (NHR) family of transcription factors bind low molecular weight ligands and either stimulate or repress transcription. See, e.g., V. Laudet et al., The Nuclear Receptor Facts Book, 345, (2002) and (Gronemeyer, Gustafsson et al. 2004)).
  • NHRs stimulate transcription by binding to DNA and inducing transcription of specific genes.
  • NHRs may also stimulate transcription by not binding to DNA but through the modulation of the activity of other DNA binding proteins. This process of stimulation of transcription is called transactivation.
  • NHRs also repress transcription by interacting with other transcription factors or coactivators and inhibiting the ability of these other transcription factors or coactivators from inducing transcription of specific genes. This type of repression is called transrepression (see V. Laudet et al (2002) and (Newton, Leigh et al. 2010).
  • glucocorticoid receptor is a member of the nuclear hormone receptor family of transcription factors, and a member of the steroid hormone family of transcription factors.
  • Glucocorticoids that interact with GR have been used for over 50 years to treat inflammatory diseases. Although glucocorticoids are potent anti-inflammatory agents, their systemic use is limited by numerous side effects. A compound that causes GR to retain the anti-inflammatory efficacy of glucocorticoids while minimizing the side effects such as diabetes, osteoporosis and glaucoma would be of great benefit to a very large number of patients with inflammatory diseases or other conditions. The art is therefore in need of effective and relatively specific modulators of NHRs such as GRs.
  • FIG. 1A shows an exemplary morpholino oligomer structure with a phosphorodiamidate linkage
  • FIG. 1B shows a morpholino oligomer as in FIG. 1A , but where the backbone linkages contain one positively charged group in the form of a (piperazino) phosphorodiamidate linkage;
  • FIG. 1C shows a conjugate of an arginine-rich peptide and an antisense oligomer, in accordance with one embodiment of the invention
  • FIGS. 1D-G show the repeating subunit segment of exemplary morpholino oligonucleotides, designated D through G.
  • FIG. 2 shows the exon organization of the human and murine GR gene and the human PR gene with the associated GenBank numbers.
  • the human GR schematic shows the exon locations for several of the known alternatively spliced forms of the gene.
  • FIG. 3 shows the target location of the exemplary targeting sequences for the human GR gene relative to the exon 5 and 6 splice donor and acceptor sites.
  • FIG. 4 shows that antisense treatment induces precise exon-skipping of exon 6 of the glucocorticoid receptor in rat hepatocytes.
  • the presence of the expected 504 bp band relative to 780 bp full-length band indicates removal of exon 6. This result was confirmed by sequencing the 504 bp band.
  • FIG. 5 shows that intranasally administered antisense agents induce precise exon-skipping of exon 7 of the glucocorticoid receptor in an in vivo mouse model. This figure indicates the presence of the expected alternative splice isoform lacking exon 7 (635 bp) compared to the band from the full length mRNA (780 bp).
  • FIGS. 6A-6D show that antisense-induced exon-skipping of exon 6 of the glucocorticoid receptor reduces activation of CD4 + and CD8 + T-cells.
  • FIG. 6A shows that MuSA6 treatment reduces the mean fluorescence intensity of cell-surface activation marker CD25 on the surface of CD8 + T-cells.
  • FIG. 6B shows that MuSA6 treatment also reduces the percentage of dividing CD8 + T-cells relative to controls.
  • FIGS. 6C and 6D show the same results for CD4 + T-cells.
  • the figure legends refer to MuSA6-PPMO (SEQ ID NO:16 conjugated to the peptide of SEQ ID NO:19) and Peptide only (SEQ ID NO: 19).
  • the present invention relates generally to compositions and methods for modulating expression of nuclear hormone receptors (NHR) from the nuclear hormone receptor superfamily (NHRSF), mainly by controlling or altering the splicing of pre-mRNA that codes for the receptors.
  • NHRs nuclear hormone receptor superfamily
  • GR glucocorticoid receptors
  • the antisense oligonucleotides and agents described herein lead to increased expression of ligand-independent or other selected forms of the receptors, and decreased expression of their inactive forms.
  • Embodiments of the present invention include nucleic acids and nucleic acid analogs that are complementary to selected exonic or intronic sequences of an NHR, including the “ligand-binding exons” and/or adjacent introns of a NHRSF pre-mRNA, among other NHR-domains described herein.
  • the term “ligand-binding exons” refers to exon(s) that are present in the wild-type mRNA but are removed from the primary transcript (the “pre-mRNA”) to make a ligand-independent form of the mRNA.
  • complementarity can be based on sequences in the sequence of pre-mRNA that spans a splice site, which includes, but is not limited to, complementarity based on sequences that span an exon-intron junction. In other embodiments, complementarity can be based solely on the sequence of the intron. In other embodiments, complementarity can be based solely on the sequence of the exon.
  • NHR modulators may be useful in treating NHR-associated diseases, including diseases associated with the expression products of genes whose transcription is stimulated or repressed by NHRs.
  • modulators of NHRs that inhibit AP-1 and/or NF- ⁇ B can be useful in the treatment of inflammatory and immune diseases and disorders such as osteoarthritis, rheumatoid arthritis, multiple sclerosis, asthma, inflammatory bowel disease, transplant rejection, and graft vs. host disease, among others described herein and known in the art.
  • Compounds that antagonize transactivation can be useful in treating metabolic diseases associated with increased levels of glucocorticoid, such as diabetes, osteoporosis and glaucoma, among others.
  • compounds that agonize transactivation can be useful in treating metabolic diseases associated with a deficiency in glucocorticoid, such as Addison's disease and others.
  • antisense or RNA interference chemistries there are several alternative antisense or RNA interference chemistries available and known to those skilled in the art.
  • One important feature of certain antisense chemistries is the ability to hybridize to a target RNA without causing degradation of the target by RNase H, as with 2′-deoxy oligonucleotides (“antisense oligonucleotides” hereafter “ASON”).
  • ASON 2′-deoxy oligonucleotides
  • Such compounds may also be referred to as splice-switching oligomers (SSOs).
  • SSOs include, but are not limited to, 2′ O-modified oligonucleotides and ribonucleosidephosphorothioates as well as peptide nucleic acids (PNA), morpholinos, locked nucleic acids (LNA), and other polymers lacking ribofuranosyl-based linkages.
  • PNA peptide nucleic acids
  • LNA locked nucleic acids
  • Embodiments of the present invention include methods of modulating nuclear hormone receptor (NHR) activity or expression in a cell, comprising contacting the cell with an antisense oligomer composed of morpholino subunits linked by phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkages joining a morpholino nitrogen of one subunit to a 5′ exocyclic carbon of an adjacent subunit, wherein the oligonucleotide contains between 10-40 bases and a targeting sequence of at least 10 contiguous bases complementary to a target sequence, wherein the target sequence is a pre-mRNA transcript of the NHR, thereby modulating activity or expression of the NHR.
  • the NHR is selected from Table 1.
  • the oligomer alters splicing of the pre-mRNA transcript and increases expression of a variant of the NHR. In some embodiments, the oligomer induces full or partial exon-skipping of one or more exons of the pre-mRNA transcript. In certain embodiments, the one or more exons encode at least a portion of a ligand-binding domain of the NHR, and the variant is a ligand independent form of the NHR. In certain embodiments, the one or more exons encode at least a portion of a transactivation domain of the NHR, and the variant has reduced transcriptional activation activity. In certain embodiments, the one or more exons encode at least a portion of a DNA-binding domain of the NHR.
  • the one or more exons encode at least a portion of an N-terminal activation domain of the NHR. In certain embodiments, the one or more exons encode at least a portion of a carboxy-terminal domain of the NHR. In specific embodiments, the variant binds to NF- ⁇ B, AP-1, or both, and reduces transcription of one or more of their pro-inflammatory target genes.
  • the oligomer agonizes a transactivation/transcriptional activity of the NHR. In other embodiments, the oligomer antagonizes a transactivation/transcriptional activity of the NHR. In certain embodiments, the oligomer agonizes a transrepression activity of the NHR. In other embodiments, the oligomer antagonizes a transrepression activity of the NHR. In specific embodiments, the oligomer antagonizes a transactivation/transcriptional activity of the NHR and agonizes a transrepression activity of the NHR.
  • the NHR is a glucocorticoid receptor (GR), a progesterone receptor (GR), or an androgen receptor (AR).
  • the NHR is the GR.
  • the target sequence is SEQ ID NO:1. In certain embodiments, the targeting sequence is selected from SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41.
  • the cell is in a subject. Certain embodiments include reducing inflammation or an inflammatory response in the subject. Other embodiments comprise increasing inflammation or an inflammatory response in the subject.
  • Embodiments of the present invention also include substantially uncharged antisense oligomers, composed of morpholino subunits linked by phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkages joining a morpholino nitrogen of one subunit to a 5′ exocyclic carbon of an adjacent subunit, wherein the oligonucleotide contains between 10-40 bases and a targeting sequence of at least 10 contiguous bases complementary to a target sequence, wherein the target sequence is a pre-mRNA transcript of a nuclear hormone receptor (NHR).
  • NHR nuclear hormone receptor
  • the oligomer contains about 10%-50% intersubunit cationic linkages.
  • the oligomer comprises an arginine-rich carrier peptide.
  • the peptide is linked at its C-terminus to the 5′ end of the oligonucleotide through a one- or two-amino acid linker. In other embodiments, the peptide is linked at its C-terminus to the 3′ end of the oligonucleotide through a one- or two-amino acid linker.
  • the linker is Ahx ⁇ Ala, wherein Ahx is 6-amino hexanoic acid and ⁇ Ala is ⁇ -alanine.
  • the peptide is selected from SEQ ID NOS:18-26.
  • the morpholino subunits in the oligonucleotide are joined by phosphorodiamidate linkages, in accordance with the structure:
  • Z is S or O
  • each said linkage is selected from:
  • each R 4 is H, CH 3 or null
  • R3 is selected from H, lower alkyl, C( ⁇ NH)NH 2 , Z-L-NHC( ⁇ NH)NH 2 , and
  • L, R 3 , and R 4 and R 5 are defined as above, and R 6 is H or lower alkyl; and at least one said linkage is selected from cationic linkages (b1), (b2), and (b3).
  • each of R 1 and R 2 , in linkages of type (a), is methyl.
  • At least one linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, R 4 is H, CH 3 , or an electron pair, and R 3 is selected from H, CH 3 , C( ⁇ NH)NH 2 , and C(O)-L-NHC( ⁇ NH)NH 2 .
  • At least one linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, R 4 is an electron pair, and R 3 is selected from C( ⁇ NH)NH 2 and C(O)-L-NHC( ⁇ NH)NH 2 .
  • At least one linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, R 4 is an electron pair, and R 3 is selected from C( ⁇ NH)NH 2 and C(O)-L-NHC( ⁇ NH)NH 2 .
  • R 3 is C(O)-L-NHC(NH)NH2, and L is a hydrocarbon having the structure —(CH 2 ) n —, where n is 1 to 12.
  • At least one linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, and each of R 3 and R 4 is independently H or CH 3 .
  • Also included are methods of modulating inflammation in a subject comprising administering to the subject an antisense oligomer composed of morpholino subunits linked by phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkages joining a morpholino nitrogen of one subunit to a 5′ exocyclic carbon of an adjacent subunit, wherein the oligonucleotide contains between 10-40 bases and a targeting sequence of at least 10 contiguous bases complementary to a target sequence, wherein the target sequence is a pre-mRNA transcript of a nuclear hormone receptor (NHR), thereby modulating inflammation in the subject.
  • NHR nuclear hormone receptor
  • Certain embodiments include reducing an acute inflammatory response, reducing a chronic inflammatory response, or both. Other embodiments include increasing an acute inflammatory response, increasing a chronic inflammatory response, or both. Certain embodiments comprise modulating the activation, inflammatory molecule secretion, proliferation, activity, migration, or adhesion of one or more immune cells or vascular cells.
  • the one or more inflammatory molecules comprise plasma-derived inflammatory molecules of any one or more of the complement system, kinin system, coagulation system, or fibrinolysis system.
  • the one or more inflammatory molecules comprise cell-derived inflammatory molecules of any one or more of lysosome granules, vasoactive amines, eicosanoids, cytokines, acute-phase proteins, or nitric oxide.
  • Certain embodiments relate to modulating an inflammatory response or inflammatory condition associated with one or more tissues, tissue systems, or organs selected from skin, hair follicles, nervous system, auditory system or balance organs, respiratory system, gastroesophogeal tissues, gastrointestinal system, vascular system, liver, gallbladder, lymphatic/immune system, uro-genital system, musculoskeletal system, adipose tissue, mammaries, and endocrine system.
  • Some embodiments include treating inflammation associated with hypersensitivity, an auto-inflammatory condition, cancer, systemic inflammatory response syndrome (SIRS), or cytokine storm.
  • SIRS systemic inflammatory response syndrome
  • Certain embodiments include treating inflammation associated with any one or more of granulomatous inflammation, fibrinous inflammation, purulent inflammation, serous inflammation, or ulcerative inflammation. Certain embodiments treating inflammation associated with one or more wounds. Certain embodiments treating inflammation associated with chronic obstructive pulmonary disorder (COPD). Certain embodiments comprising increasing the inflammatory response to treat a primary or secondary immunodeficiency. Also included are pharmaceutical composition, comprising an oligomer as described herein an a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • an element means one element or more than one element.
  • An “agonist” refers to an agent that intensifies or mimics a selected biological activity of an NHR. Examples of such biological activities include transactivation and transrepression. Included are partial and full agonists.
  • antagonist refers to an agent that inhibits or attenuates a selected biological activity of an NHR. Examples of such biological activities include transactivation and transrepression. Included are partial and full antagonists.
  • coding sequence is meant any nucleic acid sequence that contributes to the code for the polypeptide product of a gene.
  • non-coding sequence refers to any nucleic acid sequence that does not contribute to the code for the polypeptide product of a gene.
  • complementarity refers to polynucleotides (i.e., a sequence of nucleotides) related by the base-pairing rules. For example, the sequence “A-G-T,” is complementary to the sequence “T-C-A.” Complementarity may be “partial,” in which only some of the nucleic acids' bases are matched according to the base pairing rules. Or, there may be “complete” or “total” complementarity between the nucleic acids. The degree of complementarity between nucleic acid strands has significant effects on the efficiency and strength of hybridization between nucleic acid strands.
  • some embodiments can include one or more but preferably 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, or 1 mismatches with respect to the target RNA. Variations at any location within the oligomer are included. In certain embodiments, variations in sequence near the termini of an oligomer are generally preferable to variations in the interior, and if present are typically within about 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, or 1 nucleotides of the 5′ and/or 3′ terminus.
  • cell penetrating peptide or “CPP” are used interchangeably and refer to cationic cell penetrating peptides, also called transport peptides, carrier peptides, or peptide transduction domains.
  • the peptides as shown herein, have the capability of inducing cell penetration within 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, or 100% of cells of a given cell culture population, including all integers in between, and allow macromolecular translocation within multiple tissues in vivo upon systemic administration.
  • antisense oligomer or “antisense compound” or “antisense oligonucleotide” or “oligonucleotide” are used interchangeably and refer to a sequence of cyclic subunits, each bearing a base-pairing moiety, linked by intersubunit linkages that allow the base-pairing moieties to hybridize to a target sequence in a nucleic acid (typically an RNA) by Watson-Crick base pairing, to form a nucleic acid:oligomer heteroduplex within the target sequence.
  • the cyclic subunits may be based on ribose or another pentose sugar or, in certain embodiments, a morpholino group (see description of morpholino oligomers below).
  • PNAs peptide nucleic acids
  • LNAs locked nucleic acids
  • siRNA agents RNA interference agents
  • Such an antisense oligomer can be designed to block or inhibit translation of mRNA or to inhibit natural pre-mRNA splice processing, or induce degradation of targeted mRNAs, and may be said to be “directed to” or “targeted against” a target sequence with which it hybridizes.
  • the target sequence includes a region including an AUG start codon of an mRNA, a 3′ or 5′ splice site of a pre-processed mRNA, a branch point.
  • the target sequence may be within an exon or within an intron.
  • the target sequence for a splice site may include an mRNA sequence having its 5′ end 1 to about 25 base pairs downstream of a normal splice acceptor junction in a preprocessed mRNA.
  • a preferred target sequence for a splice is any region of a preprocessed mRNA that includes a splice site or is contained entirely within an exon coding sequence or spans a splice acceptor or donor site.
  • An oligomer is more generally said to be “targeted against” a biologically relevant target, such as an NHR mRNA, when it is targeted against the nucleic acid of the target in the manner described above.
  • antisense oligonucleotides that comprise, consist essentially of, or consist of one or more of SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41. Also included are variants of these antisense oligomers, including variant oligomers having 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, 97%, 98%, or 99% (including all integers in between) sequence identity or sequence homology to any one of SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41, and/or variants that differ from these sequences by about 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 nucleotides, preferably those variants that modulate NHR expression in a cell.
  • oligonucleotides of any one or more of SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41 which comprise a suitable number of charged linkages, as described herein, e.g., up to about 1 per every 2-5 uncharged linkages, such as about 4-5 per every 10 uncharged linkages, and/or which comprise an Arg-rich peptide attached thereto, as also described herein.
  • morpholino oligomer or “PMO” (phosphoramidate- or phosphorodiamidate morpholino oligomer) refer to an oligonucleotide analog composed of morpholino subunit structures, where (i) the structures are linked together by phosphorus-containing linkages, one to three atoms long, preferably two atoms long, and preferably uncharged or cationic, joining the morpholino nitrogen of one subunit to a 5′ exocyclic carbon of an adjacent subunit, and (ii) each morpholino ring bears a purine or pyrimidine or an equivalent base-pairing moiety effective to bind, by base specific hydrogen bonding, to a base in a polynucleotide.
  • PMO phosphoramidate- or phosphorodiamidate morpholino oligomer
  • FIG. 1A shows a preferred phosphorodiamidate linkage type. Variations can be made to this linkage as long as they do not interfere with binding or activity.
  • the oxygen attached to phosphorus may be substituted with sulfur (thiophosphorodiamidate).
  • the 5′ oxygen may be substituted with amino or lower alkyl substituted amino.
  • the pendant nitrogen attached to phosphorus may be unsubstituted, monosubstituted, or disubstituted with (optionally substituted) lower alkyl. See also the discussion of cationic linkages below.
  • the purine or pyrimidine base pairing moiety is typically adenine, cytosine, guanine, uracil, thymine or inosine.
  • the synthesis, structures, and binding characteristics of morpholino oligomers are detailed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,698,685, 5,217,866, 5,142,047, 5,034,506, 5,166,315, 5,521,063, and 5,506,337, and PCT Appn. Nos. PCT/US07/11435 (cationic linkages) and U.S. Ser. No. 08/012,804 (improved synthesis), all of which are incorporated herein by reference.
  • oligonucleotide analog refers to an oligonucleotide having (i) a modified backbone structure, e.g., a backbone other than the standard phosphodiester linkage found in natural oligo- and polynucleotides, and (ii) optionally, modified sugar moieties, e.g., morpholino moieties rather than ribose or deoxyribose moieties.
  • Oligonucleotide analogs support bases capable of hydrogen bonding by Watson-Crick base pairing to standard polynucleotide bases, where the analog backbone presents the bases in a manner to permit such hydrogen bonding in a sequence-specific fashion between the oligonucleotide analog molecule and bases in a standard polynucleotide (e.g., single-stranded RNA or single-stranded DNA).
  • Preferred analogs are those having a substantially uncharged, phosphorus containing backbone.
  • a substantially uncharged, phosphorus containing backbone in an oligonucleotide analog is one in which a majority of the subunit linkages, e.g., between 50-100%, typically at least 60% to 100% or 75% or 80% of its linkages, are uncharged, and contain a single phosphorous atom.
  • Antisense oligonucleotides and oligonucleotide analogs may contain between about 8 and 40 subunits, typically about 8-25 subunits, and preferably about 12 to 25 subunits. In certain embodiments, oligonucleotides may have exact sequence complementarity to the target sequence or near complementarity, as defined below.
  • a “subunit” of an oligonucleotide refers to one nucleotide (or nucleotide analog) unit.
  • the term may refer to the nucleotide unit with or without the attached intersubunit linkage, although, when referring to a “charged subunit”, the charge typically resides within the intersubunit linkage (e.g., a phosphate or phosphorothioate linkage or a cationic linkage, as shown in FIG. 1B ).
  • the purine or pyrimidine base pairing moiety is typically adenine, cytosine, guanine, uracil, thymine or inosine. Also included are bases such as pyridin-4-one, pyridin-2-one, phenyl, pseudouracil, 2,4,6-trime115thoxy benzene, 3-methyl uracil, dihydrouridine, naphthyl, aminophenyl, 5-alkylcytidines (e.g., 5-methylcytidine), 5-alkyluridines (e.g., ribothymidine), 5-halouridine (e.g., 5-bromouridine) or 6-azapyrimidines or 6-alkylpyrimidines (e.g.
  • 6-methyluridine 6-methyluridine
  • propyne quesosine, 2-thiouridine, 4-thiouridine, wybutosine, wybutoxosine, 4-acetyltidine, 5-(carboxyhydroxymethyl)uridine, 5′-carboxymethylaminomethyl-2-thiouridine, 5-carboxymethylaminomethyluridine, ⁇ -D-galactosylqueosine, 1-methyladenosine, 1-methylinosine, 2,2-dimethylguanosine, 3-methylcytidine, 2-methyladenosine, 2-methylguanosine, N6-methyladenosine, 7-methylguanosine, 5-methoxyaminomethyl-2-thiouridine, 5-methylaminomethyluridine, 5-methylcarbonyhnethyluridine, 5-methyloxyuridine, 5-methyl-2-thiouridine, 2-methylthio-N6-isopentenyladenosine, ⁇ -D-mannosylqueosine
  • modified bases in this aspect is meant nucleotide bases other than adenine (A), guanine (G), cytosine (C), thymine (T), and uracil (U), as illustrated above; such bases can be used at any position in the antisense molecule.
  • Ts and Us are interchangeable. For instance, with other antisense chemistries such as 2′-O-methyl antisense oligonucleotides that are more RNA-like, the T bases may be shown as U (see, e.g., Sequence Listing).
  • amino acid subunit or “amino acid residue” can refer to an ⁇ -amino acid residue (—CO—CHR—NH—) or a ⁇ - or other amino acid residue (e.g., —CO—(CH 2 ) n CHR—NH—), where R is a side chain (which may include hydrogen) and n is 1 to 7, preferably 1 to 4.
  • naturally occurring amino acid refers to an amino acid present in proteins found in nature, such as the 20 (L)-amino acids utilized during protein biosynthesis as well as others such as 4-hydroxyproline, hydroxylysine, desmosine, isodesmosine, homocysteine, citrulline and ornithine.
  • non-natural amino acids refers to those amino acids not present in proteins found in nature, examples include beta-alanine ( ⁇ -Ala), 6-aminohexanoic acid (Ahx) and 6-aminopentanoic acid.
  • non-natural amino acids include, without limitation, (D)-amino acids, norleucine, norvaline, p-fluorophenylalanine, ethionine and the like, which are known to a person skilled in the art.
  • isolated is meant material that is substantially or essentially free from components that normally accompany it in its native state.
  • an “isolated polynucleotide” or “isolated oligonucleotide,” as used herein, may refer to a polynucleotide that has been purified or removed from the sequences that flank it in a naturally-occurring state, e.g., a DNA fragment that has been removed from the sequences that are normally adjacent to the fragment.
  • an “effective amount” or “therapeutically effective amount” refers to an amount of therapeutic compound, such as an antisense oligomer or RNA interference agent (e.g., siRNA), administered to a mammalian subject, either as a single dose or as part of a series of doses, which is effective to produce a desired therapeutic effect.
  • an antisense oligomer this effect is typically brought about by inhibiting translation or natural splice-processing of a selected target sequence.
  • An “effective amount,” targeted against an NHR also relates to an amount effective to modulate expression of the NHR.
  • “enhance” or “enhancing,” or “increase” or “increasing,” or “stimulate” or “stimulating,” refers generally to the ability of one or antisense or RNAi compounds or compositions to produce or cause a greater physiological response (i.e., downstream effects) in a cell or a subject, as compared to the response caused by either no antisense compound or a control compound.
  • An “increased” or “enhanced” amount is typically a “statistically significant” amount, and may include an increase that is 1.1, 1.2, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 15, 20, 30, 40, 50 or more times (e.g., 500, 1000 times) (including all integers and decimal points in between and above 1), e.g., 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, etc.) the amount produced by no antisense compound (the absence of an agent) or a control compound.
  • the term “reduce” or “inhibit” may relate generally to the ability of one or more antisense or RNAi compounds of the invention to “decrease” a relevant physiological or cellular response, such as a symptom of a disease or condition described herein, as measured according to routine techniques in the diagnostic art. Relevant physiological or cellular responses (in vivo or in vitro) will be apparent to persons skilled in the art, and may include, for example, reductions in inflammation.
  • a “decrease” in a response may be “statistically significant” as compared to the response produced by no antisense compound or a control composition, and may include a 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 100% decrease, including all integers in between.
  • target sequence refers to a portion of the target RNA against which the oligonucleotide or antisense agent is directed, that is, the sequence to which the oligonucleotide will hybridize by Watson-Crick base pairing of a complementary sequence.
  • the target sequence may be a contiguous region of a pre-mRNA that includes both intron and exon target sequence. In certain other embodiments, the target sequence will consist exclusively of either intron or exon sequences.
  • targeting sequence refers to the sequence in an oligonucleotide or other antisense agent that is complementary (meaning, in addition, substantially complementary) to the target sequence in the RNA genome.
  • the entire sequence, or only a portion, of the antisense compound may be complementary to the target sequence.
  • the targeting sequence is formed of contiguous bases, but may alternatively be formed of non-contiguous sequences that when placed together, e.g., from opposite ends of the oligonucleotide, constitute sequence that spans the target sequence.
  • the target and targeting sequences may be selected such that binding of the antisense compound is to a region of a NHR pre-mRNA that causes exon skipping of those exon or exons that encode the NHR ligand-binding domain.
  • Target and targeting sequences are described as “complementary” to one another when hybridization occurs in an antiparallel configuration.
  • a targeting sequence may have “near” or “substantial” complementarity to the target sequence and still function for the purpose of the present invention, that is, it may still be functionally “complementary.”
  • an oligonucleotide may have at most one mismatch with the target sequence out of 10 nucleotides, and preferably at most one mismatch out of 20.
  • an oligonucleotide may have at least 90% sequence homology, and preferably at least 95% sequence homology, with the exemplary antisense targeting sequences described herein.
  • An oligonucleotide “specifically hybridizes” to a target polynucleotide if the oligomer hybridizes to the target under physiological conditions, with a Tm substantially greater than 45° C., preferably at least 50° C., and typically 60° C.-80° C. or higher.
  • Tm substantially greater than 45° C., preferably at least 50° C., and typically 60° C.-80° C. or higher.
  • Such hybridization preferably corresponds to stringent hybridization conditions.
  • the Tm is the temperature at which 50% of a target sequence hybridizes to a complementary polynucleotide.
  • such hybridization may occur with “near” or “substantial” complementarity of the antisense oligomer to the target sequence, as well as with exact complementarity.
  • Homology refers to the percentage number of amino acids that are identical or constitute conservative substitutions. Homology may be determined using sequence comparison programs such as GAP (Deveraux et al., 1984 , Nucleic Acids Research 12, 387-395). In this way sequences of a similar or substantially different length to those cited herein could be compared by insertion of gaps into the alignment, such gaps being determined, for example, by the comparison algorithm used by GAP.
  • sequence identity or, for example, comprising a “sequence 50% identical to,” as used herein, refer to the extent that sequences are identical on a nucleotide-by-nucleotide basis or an amino acid-by-amino acid basis over a window of comparison.
  • a “percentage of sequence identity” may be calculated by comparing two optimally aligned sequences over the window of comparison, determining the number of positions at which the identical nucleic acid base (e.g., A, T, C, G, I) or the identical amino acid residue (e.g., Ala, Pro, Ser, Thr, Gly, Val, Leu, Ile, Phe, Tyr, Trp, Lys, Arg, His, Asp, Glu, Asn, Gln, Cys and Met) occurs in both sequences to yield the number of matched positions, dividing the number of matched positions by the total number of positions in the window of comparison (i.e., the window size), and multiplying the result by 100 to yield the percentage of sequence identity.
  • the identical nucleic acid base e.g., A, T, C, G, I
  • the identical amino acid residue e.g., Ala, Pro, Ser, Thr, Gly, Val, Leu, Ile, Phe, Tyr, Trp, Lys
  • references to describe sequence relationships between two or more polynucleotides or polypeptides include “reference sequence,” “comparison window,” “sequence identity,” “percentage of sequence identity,” and “substantial identity”.
  • a “reference sequence” is at least 8 or 10 but frequently 15 to 18 and often at least 25 monomer units, inclusive of nucleotides and amino acid residues, in length.
  • two polynucleotides may each comprise (1) a sequence (i.e., only a portion of the complete polynucleotide sequence) that is similar between the two polynucleotides, and (2) a sequence that is divergent between the two polynucleotides
  • sequence comparisons between two (or more) polynucleotides are typically performed by comparing sequences of the two polynucleotides over a “comparison window” to identify and compare local regions of sequence similarity.
  • a “comparison window” refers to a conceptual segment of at least 6 contiguous positions, usually about 50 to about 100, more usually about 100 to about 150 in which a sequence is compared to a reference sequence of the same number of contiguous positions after the two sequences are optimally aligned.
  • the comparison window may comprise additions or deletions (i.e., gaps) of about 20% or less as compared to the reference sequence (which does not comprise additions or deletions) for optimal alignment of the two sequences.
  • Optimal alignment of sequences for aligning a comparison window may be conducted by computerized implementations of algorithms (GAP, BESTFIT, FASTA, and TFASTA in the Wisconsin Genetics Software Package Release 7.0, Genetics Computer Group, 575 Science Drive Madison, Wis., USA) or by inspection and the best alignment (i.e., resulting in the highest percentage homology over the comparison window) generated by any of the various methods selected.
  • GAP Garnier et al.
  • BESTFIT Pearson FASTA
  • FASTA Pearson's Alignment of sequences
  • TFASTA Pearson's Alignment of Altschul et al.
  • a detailed discussion of sequence analysis can be found in Unit 19.3 of Ausubel et al., “Current Protocols in Molecular Biology,” John Wiley & Sons Inc, 1994-1998, Chapter 15.
  • a “nuclease-resistant” oligomeric molecule refers to one whose backbone is substantially resistant to nuclease cleavage, in non-hybridized or hybridized form; by common extracellular and intracellular nucleases in the body; that is, the oligomer shows little or no nuclease cleavage under normal nuclease conditions in the body to which the oligomer is exposed.
  • heteroduplex refers to a duplex between an antisense oligonucleotide and the complementary portion of a target RNA.
  • a “nuclease-resistant heteroduplex” refers to a heteroduplex formed by the binding of an antisense oligomer to its complementary target, such that the heteroduplex is substantially resistant to in vivo degradation by intracellular and extracellular nucleases, such as RNaseH, which are capable of cutting double-stranded RNA/RNA or RNA/DNA complexes.
  • a “base-specific intracellular binding event involving a target RNA” refers to the specific binding of an antisense oligonucleotide to a target RNA sequence inside a cell.
  • the base specificity of such binding is sequence dependent.
  • a single-stranded polynucleotide can specifically bind to a single-stranded polynucleotide that is complementary in sequence.
  • body fluid encompasses a variety of sample types obtained from a subject including, urine, saliva, plasma, blood, spinal fluid, or other sample of biological origin, such as skin cells or dermal debris, and may refer to cells or cell fragments suspended therein, or the liquid medium and its solutes.
  • relative amount is used where a comparison is made between a test measurement and a control measurement.
  • the relative amount of a reagent forming a complex in a reaction is the amount reacting with a test specimen, compared with the amount reacting with a control specimen.
  • the control specimen may be run separately in the same assay, or it may be part of the same sample (for example, normal tissue surrounding a malignant area in a tissue section).
  • Treatment of an individual or a cell is any type of intervention provided as a means to alter the natural course of a disease or pathology in the individual or cell.
  • Treatment includes, but is not limited to, administration of, e.g., a pharmaceutical composition, and may be performed either prophylactically, or subsequent to the initiation of a pathologic event or contact with an etiologic agent.
  • Treatment includes any desirable effect on the symptoms or pathology of a disease or condition associated with inflammation, among others described herein.
  • prophylactic treatments which can be directed to reducing the rate of progression of the disease or condition being treated, delaying the onset of that disease or condition, or reducing the severity of its onset. “Treatment” or “prophylaxis” does not necessarily indicate complete eradication, cure, or prevention of the disease or condition, or associated symptoms thereof.
  • agent is “actively taken up by mammalian cells” when the agent can enter the cell by a mechanism other than passive diffusion across the cell membrane.
  • the agent may be transported, for example, by “active transport,” referring to transport of agents across a mammalian cell membrane by e.g., an ATP-dependent transport mechanism, or by “facilitated transport,” referring to transport of antisense agents across the cell membrane by a transport mechanism that requires binding of the agent to a transport protein, which then facilitates passage of the bound agent across the membrane.
  • active transport referring to transport of agents across a mammalian cell membrane by e.g., an ATP-dependent transport mechanism
  • facilitated transport referring to transport of antisense agents across the cell membrane by a transport mechanism that requires binding of the agent to a transport protein, which then facilitates passage of the bound agent across the membrane.
  • oligonucleotide analogs preferably have a substantially uncharged backbone, as defined below.
  • the antisense compound may be formulated in a complexed form, such as an agent having an anionic backbone complexed with cationic lipids or liposomes, which can be taken into cells by an endocytotic mechanism.
  • the antisense oligonucleotide may also be conjugated, e.g., at its 5′ or 3′ end, to an arginine-rich peptide, such as a portion of the HIV TAT protein, polyarginine, or to combinations of arginine and other amino acids including the non-natural amino acids 6-aminohexanoic acid (Ahx) and beta-alanine ( ⁇ -Ala).
  • arginine-rich delivery peptides are listed as SEQ ID NOs:18-26. These exemplary arginine-rich delivery peptides facilitate transport into the target host cell as described (Moulton, Nelson et al. 2004).
  • a “subject,” as used herein, may include any animal that exhibits a symptom, or is at risk for exhibiting a symptom, which can be treated with an antisense compound of the invention, such as a subject that has or is at risk for having an inflammatory condition.
  • Suitable subjects include laboratory animals (such as mouse, rat, rabbit, or guinea pig), farm animals, and domestic animals or pets (such as a cat or dog).
  • Non-human primates and, preferably, human patients, are included.
  • RNA interference such as those involving double stranded RNA-molecules, or dsRNA.
  • double-stranded means two separate nucleic acid strands comprising a region in which at least a portion of the strands are sufficiently complementary to hydrogen bond and form a duplex structure.
  • duplex or “duplex structure” refers to the region of a double stranded molecule wherein the two separate strands are substantially complementary, and thus hybridize to each other.
  • dsRNA refers to a ribonucleic acid molecule having a duplex structure comprising two complementary and anti-parallel nucleic acid strands (i.e., the sense and antisense strands). Not all nucleotides of a dsRNA must exhibit Watson-Crick base pairs; the two RNA strands may be substantially complementary. The RNA strands may have the same or a different number of nucleotides.
  • dsRNA also includes “siRNA” or short interfering RNA.
  • the term “ribonucleotide” or “nucleotide” can, in the case of a modified RNA or nucleotide surrogate, also refer to a modified nucleotide, or surrogate replacement moiety at one or more positions.
  • the dsRNA is or includes a region which is at least partially complementary to the target RNA.
  • the dsRNA is fully complementary to the target RNA. It is not necessary that there be perfect complementarity between the dsRNA and the target, but the correspondence must be sufficient to enable the dsRNA, or a cleavage product thereof, to direct sequence specific silencing, such as by RNAi cleavage of the target RNA.
  • Complementarity, or degree of homology with the target strand is most critical in the antisense strand. While perfect complementarity, particularly in the antisense strand, is often desired some embodiments can include one or more but preferably 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, or fewer mismatches with respect to the target RNA. The mismatches are most tolerated in the terminal regions, and if present are preferably in a terminal region or regions, e.g., within 6, 5, 4, or 3 nucleotides of the 5′ and/or 3′ terminus.
  • the sense strand need only be substantially complementary with the antisense strand to maintain the overall double-strand character of the molecule.
  • modified dsRNA refers to a dsRNA molecule that comprises at least one alteration that renders it more resistant to nucleases (e.g., protein kinase) than an identical dsRNA molecule that recognizes the same target RNA.
  • Modified dsRNAs may include a single-stranded nucleotide overhang and/or at least one substituted nucleotide.
  • nucleotide overhang refers to the unpaired nucleotide or nucleotides that protrude from the duplex structure when a 3′-end of one RNA strand extends beyond the 5′-end of the other complementary strand, or vice versa.
  • “Blunt” or “blunt end” means that there are no unpaired nucleotides at that end of the dsRNA, i.e., no nucleotide overhang.
  • a “blunt ended” dsRNA is a dsRNA that is double stranded over its entire length, i.e., no nucleotide overhang at either end of the molecule.
  • terminal base pair refers to the last nucleotide base pair on one end of the duplex region of a double-stranded molecule.
  • a dsRNA or other molecule is blunt ended (i.e., has no nucleotide overhangs)
  • the last nucleotide base pairs at both ends of the molecule are terminal base pairs.
  • the last nucleotide base pair(s) immediately adjacent the nucleotide overhang(s) is the terminal base pair at that end(s) of the molecule.
  • vector delivery systems that are capable of expressing the oligomeric, NHR-targeted exon skipping sequences of the present invention, such as vectors that express a polynucleotide sequence comprising any one or more of SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41, or variants thereof, as described herein, or that express a polynucleotide sequence that is complementary to any or more of the target sequences in Table 1 or set forth in SEQ ID NO:1.
  • vector or “nucleic acid construct” is meant a polynucleotide molecule, preferably a DNA molecule derived, for example, from a plasmid, bacteriophage, yeast or virus, into which a polynucleotide can be inserted or cloned.
  • a vector preferably contains one or more unique restriction sites and can be capable of autonomous replication in a defined host cell including a target cell or tissue or a progenitor cell or tissue thereof, or be integrable with the genome of the defined host such that the cloned sequence is reproducible.
  • the vector can be an autonomously replicating vector, i.e., a vector that exists as an extra-chromosomal entity, the replication of which is independent of chromosomal replication, e.g., a linear or closed circular plasmid, an extra-chromosomal element, a mini-chromosome, or an artificial chromosome.
  • the vector can contain any means for assuring self-replication.
  • the vector can be one which, when introduced into the host cell, is integrated into the genome and replicated together with the chromosome(s) into which it has been integrated.
  • a vector or nucleic acid construct system can comprise a single vector or plasmid, two or more vectors or plasmids, which together contain the total DNA to be introduced into the genome of the host cell, or a transposon.
  • the choice of the vector will typically depend on the compatibility of the vector with the host cell into which the vector is to be introduced.
  • the vector or nucleic acid construct is preferably one which is operably functional in a mammalian cell, such as a muscle cell.
  • the vector can also include a selection marker such as an antibiotic or drug resistance gene, or a reporter gene (i.e., green fluorescent protein, luciferase), that can be used for selection or identification of suitable transformants or transfectants.
  • Exemplary delivery systems may include viral vector systems (i.e., viral-mediated transduction) including, but not limited to, retroviral (e.g., lentiviral) vectors, adenoviral vectors, adeno-associated viral vectors, and herpes viral vectors, among others known in the art.
  • viral vector systems i.e., viral-mediated transduction
  • retroviral e.g., lentiviral
  • adenoviral vectors e.g., adenoviral vectors
  • adeno-associated viral vectors e.g., adeno-associated viral vectors
  • herpes viral vectors i.e., herpes viral vectors, among others known in the art.
  • operably linked means placing an oligomer-encoding sequence under the regulatory control of a promoter, which then controls the transcription of the oligomer.
  • a wild-type gene or gene product is that which is most frequently observed in a population and is thus arbitrarily designed the “normal” or “wild-type” form of the gene.
  • Alkyl refers to a fully saturated monovalent radical containing carbon and hydrogen, which may be branched, linear, or cyclic (cycloalkyl). Examples of alkyl groups are methyl, ethyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, n-heptyl, isopropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclopentyl, ethylcyclopentyl, and cyclohexyl.
  • lower alkyl alkyl groups having one to six carbon atoms
  • lower alkyl alkyl groups having one to six carbon atoms
  • lower alkyl refers to C 1 to C 4 alkyl.
  • Alkenyl refers to an unsaturated monovalent radical containing carbon and hydrogen, which may be branched, linear, or cyclic.
  • the alkenyl group may be monounsaturated or polyunsaturated. Generally preferred are alkenyl groups having one to six carbon atoms, referred to as “lower alkenyl.”
  • Alkynyl refers to an unsaturated straight or branched chain hydrocarbon radical containing from 2 to 18 carbons comprising at least one carbon to carbon triple bond. Examples include without limitation ethynyl, propynyl, iso-propynyl, butynyl, iso-butynyl, tert-butynyl, pentynyl and hexynyl.
  • lower alkynyl refers to an alkynyl group, as defined herein, containing between 2 and 8 carbons.
  • Cycloalkyl refers to a mono- or poly-cyclic alkyl radical. Examples include without limitation cyclobutyl, cycopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl and cyclooctyl.
  • Aryl refers to a substituted or unsubstituted monovalent aromatic radical, generally having a single ring (e.g., phenyl) or two condensed rings (e.g., naphthyl). This term includes heteroaryl groups, which are aromatic ring groups having one or more nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur atoms in the ring, such as furyl, pyrrolyl, pyridyl, and indolyl.
  • substituted is meant that one or more ring hydrogens in the aryl group is replaced with a halide such as fluorine, chlorine, or bromine; with a lower alkyl group containing one or two carbon atoms; nitro, amino, methylamino, dimethylamino, methoxy, halomethoxy, halomethyl, or haloethyl.
  • Preferred substituents include halogen, methyl, ethyl, and methoxy.
  • aryl groups having a single ring are preferred.
  • Alkyl refers to an alkyl, preferably lower (C 1 -C 4 , more preferably C 1 -C 2 ) alkyl, substituent which is further substituted with an aryl group; examples are benzyl (—CH 2 C 6 H 5 ) and phenethyl (—CH 2 CH 2 C 6 H 5 ).
  • Thioalkoxy refers to a radical of the formula —SRc where Rc is an alkyl radical as defined herein.
  • the term “lower thioalkoxy” refers to an alkoxy group, as defined herein, containing between 1 and 8 carbons.
  • Alkoxy refers to a radical of the formula —ORda where Rd is an alkyl radical as defined herein.
  • Rd is an alkyl radical as defined herein.
  • lower alkoxy refers to an alkoxy group, as defined herein, containing between 1 and 8 carbons. Examples of alkoxy groups include, without limitation, methoxy and ethoxy.
  • Alkoxyalkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with an alkoxy group.
  • Carbonyl refers to the —C( ⁇ O)— radical.
  • “Amidinyl” refers to the H 2 N(C ⁇ NH 2 )CH— radical.
  • Amino refers to the —NH 2 radical.
  • Alkylamino refers to a radical of the formula —NHRd or —NRdRd where each Rd is, independently, an alkyl radical as defined herein.
  • the term “lower alkylamino” refers to an alkylamino group, as defined herein, containing between 1 and 8 carbons.
  • Heterocycle means a 5- to 7-membered monocyclic, or 7- to 10-membered bicyclic, heterocyclic ring which is either saturated, unsaturated, or aromatic, and which contains from 1 to 4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur, and wherein the nitrogen and sulfur heteroatoms may be optionally oxidized, and the nitrogen heteroatom may be optionally quaternized, including bicyclic rings in which any of the above heterocycles are fused to a benzene ring.
  • the heterocycle may be attached via any heteroatom or carbon atom.
  • the ring atoms include 3 to 6 carbon atoms.
  • Such heterocycles include, for example, pyrrolidine, piperidine, piperazine, and morpholine.
  • Heterocycles include heteroaryls as defined below.
  • heterocycles also include morpholinyl, pyrrolidinonyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, piperizynyl, hydantoinyl, valerolactamyl, oxiranyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydropyridinyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl, tetrahydropyrimidinyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl, and the like.
  • Heteroaryl means an aromatic heterocycle ring of 5- to 10 members and having at least one heteroatom selected from nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur, and containing at least 1 carbon atom, including both mono- and bicyclic ring systems.
  • Representative heteroaryls are pyridyl, furyl, benzofuranyl, thiophenyl, benzothiophenyl, quinolinyl, pyrrolyl, indolyl, oxazolyl, benzoxazolyl, imidazolyl, benzimidazolyl, thiazolyl, benzothiazolyl, isoxazolyl, pyrazolyl, isothiazolyl, pyridazinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, triazinyl, cinnolinyl, phthalazinyl, and quinazolinyl.
  • substituted refers to replacement of a hydrogen atom with a heteroatom-containing substituent, such as, for example, halogen, hydroxy, alkoxy, thiol, alkylthio, amino, alkylamino, imino, oxo (keto), nitro, cyano, or various acids or esters such as carboxylic, sulfonic, or phosphonic.
  • a heteroatom-containing substituent such as, for example, halogen, hydroxy, alkoxy, thiol, alkylthio, amino, alkylamino, imino, oxo (keto), nitro, cyano, or various acids or esters such as carboxylic, sulfonic, or phosphonic.
  • substituted refers to replacement of a hydrogen atom on carbon with a heteroatom-containing substituent, such as, for example, halogen, hydroxy, alkoxy, thiol, alkylthio, amino, alkylamino, imino, oxo (keto), nitro, cyano, or various acids or esters such as carboxylic, sulfonic, or phosphonic. It may also refer to replacement of a hydrogen atom on a heteroatom (such as an amine hydrogen) with an alkyl, carbonyl or other carbon containing group.
  • a heteroatom-containing substituent such as, for example, halogen, hydroxy, alkoxy, thiol, alkylthio, amino, alkylamino, imino, oxo (keto), nitro, cyano, or various acids or esters such as carboxylic, sulfonic, or phosphonic. It may also refer to replacement of a hydrogen atom on a heteroatom (such as an amine
  • the terms “optionally substituted alkyl”, “optionally substituted alkenyl”, “optionally substituted alkoxy”, “optionally substituted thioalkoxy”, “optionally substituted alkyl amino”, “optionally substituted lower alkyl”, “optionally substituted lower alkenyl”, “optionally substituted lower alkoxy”, “optionally substituted lower thioalkoxy”, “optionally substituted lower alkyl amino” and “optionally substituted heterocyclyl” mean that, when substituted, at least one hydrogen atom is replaced with a substituent. In the case of an oxo substituent ( ⁇ O) two hydrogen atoms are replaced.
  • substituents include: deuterium, optionally substituted alkyl, optionally substituted alkenyl, optionally substituted alkynyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted heterocycle, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, oxo, halogen, —CN, —ORx, NRxRy, NRxC( ⁇ O)Ry, NRxSO2Ry, —NRxC( ⁇ O)NRxRy, C( ⁇ O)Rx, C( ⁇ O)ORx, C( ⁇ O)NRxRy, —SOmRx and —SOmNRxRy, wherein m is 0, 1 or 2, Rx and Ry are the same or different and independently hydrogen, optionally substituted alkyl, optionally substituted alkenyl, optionally substituted alkynyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted heterocycle or optionally substituted cycloalkyl and each of said optionally substituted alkyl, optionally substituted
  • targeting sequences capable of inducing exon skipping of those exons that encode all or part of an NHR ligand-binding domain are discussed below.
  • Embodiments of the present invention are based, in part, on the discovery that antisense oligomer-induced exon skipping of either of the two exons that encode the ligand-binding domain of the glucocorticoid receptor (GR) result in the induction of an activated, ligand-independent GR (liGR). It is fully contemplated that similar exon skipping strategies can be employed to induce ligand-independent steroid receptors other than GR and, more generally, ligand-independent NHRs as a whole.
  • a list of human NHRSF targets and their known ligands that are considered targets for the compositions and methods of this invention are shown below in Table 1 (see Gronemeyer, Gustafsson et al. 2004). The sequences of these NHRSF targets are known in the art.
  • GR Glucocorticoid Receptor
  • the GR is a ligand-activated transcription factor belonging to the NHRSF. It binds with high affinity to cortisol and other glucocorticoids. GR is expressed in almost every cell in the body and regulates genes controlling a wide variety of processes including the development, metabolism, and immune response of the organism. In the absence of hormone, GR is complexed with a variety of heat shock proteins in the cytosol. The binding of the glucocorticoids results in release of the heat shock proteins and transforms it to its active state.
  • One mechanism of action of GR is by direct activation of gene transcription. The activated form of GR forms dimers, translocates into the nucleus, and binds to specific glucocorticoid responsive elements (GRE), activating gene transcription.
  • GRE glucocorticoid responsive elements
  • transactivation typically requires dimerization of GR and binding to a glucocorticoid response element (GRE).
  • GRE glucocorticoid response element
  • GR can also function as a repressor of other gene transcription activators, such as NF- ⁇ B and AF-1 by directly binding to them, and blocking the expression of their activated genes. It has been shown that glucocorticoids exert their anti-inflammatory activity via the inhibition by GR of the transcription factors NF- ⁇ B and AP-1. This inhibition is termed transrepression. By this mechanism, GR is able to prevent the transcription of pro-inflammatory genes, including interleukins IL-1B, IL-4, IL-5, and IL-8, chemokines, cytokines, GM-CSF, and TNF genes, among others.
  • pro-inflammatory genes including interleukins IL-1B, IL-4, IL-5, and IL-8, chemokines, cytokines, GM-CSF, and TNF genes, among others.
  • NF- ⁇ B and AP-1 play key roles in the initiation and perpetuation of inflammatory and immunological disorders and are involved in regulating the expression of a number of important inflammatory and immunomodulatory genes including cytokines, chemokines, adhesion molecules, inflammatory proteins and many others (e.g., TNF-alpha, IL-1, IL-2, IL-5, adhesion molecules, Cox-2, and others (Gronemeyer, Gustafsson et al. 2004; Newton, Leigh et al. 2010).
  • GR has a central well conserved DNA binding domain (DBD), a variable N-terminal domain, a flexible hinge and a C-terminal ligand binding domain (LBD).
  • the LBD also functions for dimerization and chaperone protein association.
  • certain embodiments of the present invention therefore relate to methods of modulating the splicing of GR to produce an altered GR transcript that encodes a GR protein with reduced transactivation activity, normal or increased transrepression activity, or both. These and related embodiments would reduce inflammation without the side effects of typical glucocorticoid therapy.
  • the PR is a member of the NHRSF of ligand dependent transcription factors, mediating the biological actions of progesterone.
  • PR functions in a variety of biological processes including development of the mammary gland, regulating cell cycle progression, protein processing, and metabolism. When no binding hormone is present the carboxyl terminal inhibits transcription. Binding to a hormone induces a structural change that removes the inhibitory action. After progesterone binds to the receptor, PR forms a dimer and the complex enters the nucleus where it interacts with the hormone response element (HRE) in the promoters of progesterone responsive genes and alters their transcription.
  • HRE hormone response element
  • rapid actions of PR that occur independent of transcription have also been observed in several tissues like brain, liver, mammary gland and spermatozoa.
  • PR-A There are two natural PR isoforms called PR-A and PR-B.
  • PR-B has an additional stretch of 164 amino acids at the N terminus.
  • the extra domain in PR-B performs activation functions by recruiting coactivators that could not be recruited by PR-A.
  • PR has a central well conserved DNA binding domain (DBD), a variable N-terminal domain, a flexible hinge and a C-terminal ligand-binding domain (LBD).
  • DBD DNA binding domain
  • LBD C-terminal ligand-binding domain
  • the AR is activated by binding either of the androgenic hormones, testosterone or dihydrotestosterone, which are responsible for male primary sexual characteristics and for secondary male characteristics, respectively.
  • the primary mechanism of action of ARs is by direct regulation of gene transcription.
  • the binding of an androgen results in a conformational change in AR which causes its transport from the cytosol into the cell nucleus, and dimerization.
  • the receptor dimer binds to a hormone response element of AR-regulated genes and modulates their expression.
  • Another mode of action is independent on interactions with DNA.
  • the receptors interact directly with signal transduction proteins in the cytoplasm, causing rapid changes in cell function, such as ion transport.
  • AR has a central well conserved DNA binding domain (DBD), a variable N-terminal domain, a flexible hinge and a C-terminal ligand binding domain (LBD).
  • DBD DNA binding domain
  • LBD variable N-terminal domain
  • LBD C-terminal ligand binding domain
  • a ligand dependent nuclear export signal is also present at the ligand binding domain.
  • the exons encoding ligand binding domains of the NHRs are the antisense or RNAi targets of the present invention; however, other exons can also be targeted.
  • antisense agents can be targeted against, or be complementary to, a variety of regions in a pre-processed mRNA.
  • certain antisense or RNAi agents may comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to a region that overlaps the splice junction of a splice donor (SD) or splice acceptor (SA) site of exon 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, or 12 of a NHR in Table 1, and is complementary to a portion of an exonic region (e.g., 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, or 30 nucleotides) and a portion of an intronic region (e.g., 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, nucleotides) of the pre-processed mRNA.
  • SD splice donor
  • SA splice acceptor
  • Certain exemplary antisense or RNAi agents may comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to an exonic region defined by the first 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, or 100 nucleotides (or ranges such as the first 10-30, 20-40, 30-50, 40-60, 50-70, 60-80, 80-100 nucleotides) immediately downstream of the splice acceptor site of exon 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, or 12 of a NHR in Table 1, but either does not overlap with the splice junction, or overlaps with the splice junction and is complementary to about 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 nucleotides of the proximal (upstream) intron.
  • Some exemplary antisense or RNAi agents may comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to an exonic region defined by the first 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, or 100 nucleotides (or ranges such as the first 10-30, 20-40, 30-50, 40-60, 50-70, 60-80, 80-100 nucleotides) immediately upstream of the splice donor site of exon 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, or 12 of a selected NHR in Table 1, but either does not overlap with the splice junction, or overlaps with the splice junction and is complementary to about 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 nucleotides of the proximal (downstream) intron.
  • Certain antisense or RNAi agents are complementary to at least about 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30 or more contiguous or non-contiguous nucleotides within these regions. These targeting strategies can be applied to any of the NHR genes described herein (see, e.g., Table 1).
  • glucocorticoid receptor GR
  • the exon structure of the murine and human GR genes is shown in FIG. 2 along with the structure of the human progesterone receptor gene.
  • Human GR contains about 9 coding exons.
  • the exons encoding the ligand binding domains of each of the genes in FIG. 2 are indicated with arrows.
  • Certain experiments described herein were conducted in rats, using antisense oligonucleotides targeted against either the murine GR exons 6 or 7 (the murine and rat target sequences are identical) (see, e.g., SEQ ID NOs: 16 and 13, respectively).
  • the target sequence for the muSA7 compound is identical in mice, rats and humans.
  • Exemplary sequences for targeting the human GR exons 5 and 6 are listed herein as SEQ ID NOs: 2-9 (exon 5) and SEQ ID NOs: 10-14 (exon 6).
  • SA splice acceptor
  • FIG. 3 The location of these targeting sequences relative to the human GR exon 5 and 6 splice acceptor (SA) or splice donor sites is shown in FIG. 3 .
  • SA splice acceptor
  • certain antisense or RNAi agents comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to a region of exons 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 of human GR, as described herein.
  • Certain preferred targets include exons 5, 6, or 7.
  • the exons in the carboxy-terminal domain of the receptor gene are candidates for selection as targets of the invention.
  • the exemplary target exons shown in FIG. 2 for GR and PR are instructive in the selection of target sequences and the design of targeting oligomers for other NHR genes.
  • the two or three exons immediately upstream of the 3′ terminal exon are preferred.
  • SEQ ID NO: 1 in the Sequence Listing is a region of human GR pre-mRNA extending 70 bases upstream of exon 5 through intron 5 and exon 6 and extending 70 bases into intron 6. This sequence illustrates a preferred target sequence or region for inducing exon skipping of the two exons encoding the GR ligand-binding domain.
  • RNAi agents may thus comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to a defined region of exons 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8 of human PR or AR, or that is complementary to a defined region of exons 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 of human TR, as described herein.
  • antisense targeting sequences are designed to hybridize to a region of one or more of the target sequences listed in Table 1, such as an exon, an intron, an exon-intron junction, or a splice junction.
  • the pre-mRNA sequences of these target genes are known in the art.
  • the antisense sequences are designed to skip selected exons of a NHR such as GR, and produce an altered (typically by deletion) but functional protein.
  • Exemplary targets for exon-skipping include exons that encode at least a portion of an N-terminal activation or regulatory domain, a DNA-binding domain, a ligand binding domain, and/or a C-terminal domain. Also contemplated is the targeting of any combination of such exons or domains.
  • a particular function of the NHR can be modulated by such an approach.
  • certain embodiments include the targeting of selected exons of an NHR such as GR to alter (e.g., delete) at least a portion of a domain associated with its transactivation-related activities (i.e., transcriptional activation), its transrepression-related activities, or both, and thereby modulate one or both of these activities.
  • Certain exemplary embodiments increase or agonize the transactivation activities of an NHR such as GR.
  • Other embodiments decrease or antagonize the transactivation activities of an NHR such as GR.
  • Certain embodiments increase or agonize the transrepression activities of an NHR such as GR.
  • inventions decrease or antagonize the transrepression activities of an NHR such as GR.
  • Specific embodiments agonize the transactivation activities of an NHR such as GR, and also antagonize the transrepression activities of the same NHR.
  • Preferred embodiments antagonize the transactivation activities of an NHR such as GR, and also agonize the transrepression activities of the same NHR.
  • Selected antisense targeting sequences can be made shorter, e.g., about 12 bases, or longer, e.g., about 40 bases, and include a small number of mismatches, as long as the sequence is sufficiently complementary to effect translation, splicing, and/or other form of inhibition upon hybridization with the target, and forms with the target RNA, a heteroduplex having a Tm of 45° C. or greater.
  • the degree of complementarity between the target and antisense targeting sequence is sufficient to form a stable duplex.
  • the region of complementarity of the antisense oligomers with the target RNA sequence may be as short as 8-11 bases, but is preferably 12-15 bases or more, e.g., 12-20 bases, 12-25, or 15-25 bases, including all integers in between these ranges.
  • An antisense oligomer of about 14-15 bases is generally long enough to have a unique complementary sequence in the target mRNA. In certain embodiments, a minimum length of complementary bases may be required to achieve the requisite binding Tm, as discussed below.
  • oligomers as long as 40 bases may be suitable, where at least a minimum number of bases, e.g., 10-12 bases, are complementary to the target sequence.
  • facilitated or active uptake in cells is optimized at oligomer lengths less than about 30.
  • an optimum balance of binding stability and uptake generally occurs at lengths of 18-25 bases.
  • antisense oligomers e.g., PNAs, LNAs, 2′-OMe, MOE
  • PMO oligomers that consist of about 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, or 40 bases, in which at least about 6, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, or 40 contiguous or non-contiguous bases are complementary to a target sequence of Table 1 or set forth in SEQ ID NO:1, or variants thereof.
  • antisense oligomers may be 100% complementary to the NHR nucleic acid target sequence, or they may include mismatches, e.g., to accommodate variants, as long as a heteroduplex formed between the oligomer and the target sequence is sufficiently stable to withstand the action of cellular nucleases and other modes of degradation which may occur in vivo. Oligomer backbones which are less susceptible to cleavage by nucleases are discussed below. Mismatches, if present, are less destabilizing toward the end regions of the hybrid duplex than in the middle.
  • the number of mismatches allowed will depend on the length of the oligomer, the percentage of G:C base pairs in the duplex, and the position of the mismatch(es) in the duplex, according to well understood principles of duplex stability.
  • an antisense oligomer is not necessarily 100% complementary to the target sequence, it is effective to stably and specifically bind to the target sequence, such that a biological activity of the nucleic acid target, e.g., expression of NHR protein(s), is modulated.
  • the stability of the duplex formed between an oligomer and a target sequence is a function of the binding Tm and the susceptibility of the duplex to cellular enzymatic cleavage.
  • the Tm of an antisense compound with respect to complementary-sequence RNA may be measured by conventional methods, such as those described by Hames et al., Nucleic Acid Hybridization, IRL Press, 1985, pp. 107-108 or as described in Miyada C. G. and Wallace R. B., 1987, Oligonucleotide hybridization techniques, Methods Enzymol . Vol. 154 pp. 94-107.
  • antisense oligomer may have a binding Tm, with respect to a complementary-sequence RNA, of greater than body temperature and preferably greater than 50° C. Tm's in the range 60-80° C. or greater are preferred.
  • Tm the Tm of an oligomer compound, with respect to a complementary-based RNA hybrid, can be increased by increasing the ratio of C:G paired bases in the duplex, and/or by increasing the length (in base pairs) of the heteroduplex.
  • the antisense activity of an oligomer may be enhanced by using a mixture of uncharged and cationic phosphorodiamidate linkages, as exemplified in FIG. 1B .
  • the total number of cationic linkages in the oligomer can vary from 1 to 10 (including all integers in between), and be interspersed throughout the oligomer.
  • the number of charged linkages is at least 2 and no more than half the total backbone linkages, e.g., between 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8 positively charged linkages, and preferably each charged linkages is separated along the backbone by at least 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5 uncharged linkages.
  • the antisense activity of various oligomers can be measured in vitro by fusing the oligomer target region to the 5′ end a reporter gene (e.g., firefly luciferase) and then measuring the inhibition of translation of the fusion gene mRNA transcripts in cell free translation assays.
  • a reporter gene e.g., firefly luciferase
  • the inhibitory properties of oligomers containing a mixture of uncharged and cationic linkages can be enhanced between, approximately, five to 100 fold in cell free translation assays.
  • the antisense oligonucleotides of the present invention typically (a) have the ability to be actively taken up by mammalian cells, and (b) once taken up, form a duplex with the target RNA with a Tm greater than about 45° C.
  • the oligomer backbone may be substantially uncharged, and, preferably, may be recognized as a substrate for active or facilitated transport across the cell membrane.
  • the ability of the oligomer to form a stable duplex with the target RNA may also relate to other features of the oligomer backbone, including the length and degree of complementarity of the antisense oligomer with respect to the target, the ratio of G:C to A:T base matches, and the positions of any mismatched bases.
  • antisense oligomer targeting sequences of the invention using the PMO backbone chemistry are listed above in Table 2.
  • PNA and LNA chemistries utilize shorter targeting oligomers due to their relatively high target binding strength compared to PMO and 2′O-Me oligomers.
  • PNAs Peptide nucleic acids
  • the backbone of PNAs is formed by peptide bonds rather than phosphodiester bonds, making them well-suited for antisense applications (see structure below).
  • the backbone is uncharged, resulting in PNA/DNA or PNA/RNA duplexes that exhibit greater than normal thermal stability. PNAs are not recognized by nucleases or proteases.
  • PNAs are produced synthetically using any technique known in the art.
  • PNA is a DNA analog in which a polyamide backbone replaces the traditional phosphate ribose ring of DNA as shown below.
  • PNA is capable of sequence-specific binding in a helix form to DNA or RNA.
  • Characteristics of PNA include a high binding affinity to complementary DNA or RNA, a destabilizing effect caused by single-base mismatch, resistance to nucleases and proteases, hybridization with DNA or RNA independent of salt concentration and triplex formation with homopurine DNA.
  • PanageneTM has developed its proprietary Bts PNA monomers (Bts; benzothiazole-2-sulfonyl group) and proprietary oligomerisation process. The PNA oligomerisation using Bts PNA monomers is composed of repetitive cycles of deprotection, coupling and capping.
  • Panagene's patents to this technology include U.S. Pat. No. 6,969,766, U.S. Pat. No. 7,211,668, U.S. Pat. No. 7,022,851, U.S. Pat. No. 7,125,994, U.S. Pat. No. 7,145,006 and U.S. Pat. No. 7,179,896.
  • Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of PNA compounds include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,539,082; 5,714,331; and 5,719,262, each of which is herein incorporated by reference. Further teaching of PNA compounds can be found in Nielsen et al., Science, 1991, 254, 1497.
  • Oligonucleotide compounds of the present invention may also contain “locked nucleic acid” subunits (LNAs).
  • LNAs locked nucleic acid subunits
  • the structures of LNAs are known in the art: for example, Wengel, et al., Chemical Communications (1998) 455; Tetrahedron (1998) 54, 3607, and Accounts of Chem. Research (1999) 32, 301); Obika, et al., Tetrahedron Letters (1997) 38, 8735; (1998) 39, 5401, and Bioorganic Medicinal Chemistry (2008)16, 9230. Exemplary, non-limiting LNA structures are illustrated below:
  • Compounds of the invention may incorporate one or more LNAs; in some cases, the compounds may be entirely composed of LNAs.
  • Methods for the synthesis of individual LNA nucleoside subunits and their incorporation into oligonucleotides are known in the art: U.S. Pat. Nos. 7,572,582; 7,569,575; 7,084,125; 7,060,809; 7,053,207; 7,034,133; 6,794,499; and 6,670,461.
  • Typical intersubunit linkers include phosphodiester and phosphorothioate moieties; alternatively, non-phosphorous containing linkers may be employed.
  • a preferred embodiment is an LNA containing compound where each LNA subunit is separated by a DNA subunit (i.e., a deoxyribose nucleotide). Further preferred compounds are composed of alternating LNA and DNA subunits where the intersubunit linker is phosphorothioate.
  • a preferred oligomer structure employs morpholino-based subunits bearing base-pairing moieties, joined by uncharged linkages, as described above. Especially preferred is a substantially uncharged phosphorodiamidate-linked morpholino oligomer.
  • Morpholino oligonucleotides, including antisense oligomers are detailed, for example, in co-owned U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,698,685, 5,217,866, 5,142,047, 5,034,506, 5,166,315, 5,185, 444, 5,521,063, and 5,506,337, and in PCT application No. U.S. Ser. No. 08/088,339, all of which are expressly incorporated by reference herein.
  • Certain properties of the morpholino-based subunits include: the ability to be linked in a oligomeric form by stable, uncharged backbone linkages; the ability to support a nucleotide base (e.g., adenine, cytosine, guanine or uracil) such that the polymer formed can hybridize with a complementary-base target nucleic acid, including target RNA, with high Tm, even with oligomers as short as 10-14 bases; the ability of the oligomer to be actively transported into mammalian cells; and the ability of the oligomer:RNA heteroduplex to resist RNase degradation.
  • a nucleotide base e.g., adenine, cytosine, guanine or uracil
  • FIGS. 1A-1C Examples of morpholino oligonucleotides having phosphorus-containing backbone linkages are illustrated in FIGS. 1A-1C .
  • a phosphorodiamidate-linked morpholino oligonucleotide as shown in FIG. 1B , which is modified, in accordance with one aspect of the present invention, to contain positively charged groups at preferably 10%-50% of its backbone linkages.
  • Morpholino oligonucleotides with uncharged backbone linkages, including antisense oligonucleotides, are detailed, for example, in (Summerton and Weller, 1997) and in co-owned U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • Properties of the morpholino-based subunits include: 1) the ability to be linked in a oligomeric form by stable, uncharged or positively charged backbone linkages; 2) the ability to support a nucleotide base (e.g., adenine, cytosine, guanine, thymidine, uracil and hypoxanthine) such that the polymer formed can hybridize with a complementary-base target nucleic acid, including target RNA, Tm values above about 45° C.
  • a nucleotide base e.g., adenine, cytosine, guanine, thymidine, uracil and hypoxanthine
  • oligonucleotide in relatively short oligonucleotides (e.g., 10-15 bases); 3) the ability of the oligonucleotide to be actively or passively transported into mammalian cells; and 4) the ability of the antisense oligonucleotide:RNA heteroduplex to resist RNase and RNaseH degradation, respectively.
  • Exemplary backbone structures for antisense oligonucleotides of the claimed subject matter include the morpholino subunit types shown in FIGS. 1D-1G , each linked by an uncharged or positively charged, phosphorus-containing subunit linkage.
  • FIG. 1D shows a phosphorus-containing linkage which forms the five atom repeating-unit backbone, where the morpholino rings are linked by a 1-atom phosphoamide linkage.
  • FIG. 1E shows a linkage which produces a 6-atom repeating-unit backbone.
  • the atom Y linking the 5′ morpholino carbon to the phosphorus group may be sulfur, nitrogen, carbon or, preferably, oxygen.
  • the X moiety pendant from the phosphorus may be fluorine, an alkyl or substituted alkyl, an alkoxy or substituted alkoxy, a thioalkoxy or substituted thioalkoxy, or unsubstituted, monosubstituted, or disubstituted nitrogen, including cyclic structures, such as morpholines or piperidines.
  • Alkyl, alkoxy and thioalkoxy preferably include 1-6 carbon atoms.
  • the Z moieties are sulfur or oxygen, and are preferably oxygen.
  • the linkages shown in FIGS. 1F and 1G are designed for 7-atom unit-length backbones.
  • the X moiety is as in Structure 1E
  • the Y moiety may be methylene, sulfur, or, preferably, oxygen.
  • the X and Y moieties are as in Structure 1E.
  • Particularly preferred morpholino oligonucleotides include those composed of morpholino subunit structures of the form shown in FIG. 1E , where X ⁇ NH 2 , N(CH 3 ) 2 , or 1-piperazine or other charged group, Y ⁇ O, and Z ⁇ O.
  • the substantially uncharged oligonucleotide may be modified, in accordance with an aspect of the invention, to include charged linkages, e.g., up to about 1 per every 2-5 uncharged linkages, such as about 4-5 per every 10 uncharged linkages.
  • optimal improvement in antisense activity may be seen when about 25% of the backbone linkages are cationic.
  • enhancement may be seen with a small number e.g., 10-20% cationic linkages, or where the number of cationic linkages are in the range 50-80%, such as about 60%.
  • the antisense compounds can be prepared by stepwise solid-phase synthesis, employing methods detailed in the references cited above, and below with respect to the synthesis of oligonucleotides having a mixture or uncharged and cationic backbone linkages.
  • additional chemical moieties to the antisense compound, e.g., to enhance pharmacokinetics or to facilitate capture or detection of the compound.
  • Such a moiety may be covalently attached, typically to a terminus of the oligomer, according to standard synthetic methods.
  • addition of a polyethyleneglycol moiety or other hydrophilic polymer e.g., one having 10-100 monomeric subunits, may be useful in enhancing solubility.
  • One or more charged groups e.g., anionic charged groups such as an organic acid, may enhance cell uptake.
  • a reporter moiety such as fluorescein or a radiolabeled group
  • the reporter label attached to the oligomer may be a ligand, such as an antigen or biotin, capable of binding a labeled antibody or streptavidin.
  • a moiety for attachment or modification of an antisense compound it is generally of course desirable to select chemical compounds of groups that are biocompatible and likely to be tolerated by a subject without undesirable side effects.
  • certain of the antisense compounds can be constructed to contain a selected number of cationic linkages interspersed with uncharged linkages of the type described above.
  • the intersubunit linkages, both uncharged and cationic preferably are phosphorus-containing linkages, having the structure:
  • W is S or O, and is preferably O
  • each said linkage in the oligomer is selected from:
  • each R is independently H or CH 3 ,
  • R 4 is H, CH 3 , or an electron pair
  • R 3 is selected from H, lower alkyl, e.g., CH 3 , C( ⁇ NH)NH 2 , Z-L-NHC( ⁇ NH)NH 2 , and [C(O)CHR′NH] m H, where: Z is C(O) or a direct bond, L is an optional linker up to 18 atoms in length, preferably up to 12 atoms, and more preferably up to 8 atoms in length, having bonds selected from alkyl, alkoxy, and alkylamino, R′ is a side chain of a naturally occurring amino acid or a one- or two-carbon homolog thereof, and m is 1 to 6, preferably 1 to 4;
  • At least one said linkage is selected from cationic linkages (b1), (b2), and (b3).
  • an oligomer may include at least two consecutive linkages of type (a) (i.e. uncharged linkages).
  • at least 5% of the linkages in the oligomer are cationic linkages (i.e. type (b1), (b2), or (b3)); for example, 10% to 60%, and preferably 20-50% linkages may be cationic linkages.
  • At least one linkage is of type (b1), where, preferably, each R is H, R 4 is H, CH 3 , or an electron pair, and R 3 is selected from H, lower alkyl, e.g., CH 3 , C( ⁇ NH)NH 2 , and C(O)-L-NHC( ⁇ NH)NH 2 .
  • R 3 is selected from H, lower alkyl, e.g., CH 3 , C( ⁇ NH)NH 2 , and C(O)-L-NHC( ⁇ NH)NH 2 .
  • the latter two embodiments of R 3 provide a guanidino moiety, either attached directly to the piperazine ring, or pendant to a linker group L, respectively.
  • the variable Z in R 3 is preferably C(O) (carbonyl), as shown.
  • the linker group L contains bonds in its backbone selected from alkyl (e.g., —CH 2 —CH 2 —), alkoxy (—C—O—), and alkylamino (e.g., —CH 2 —NH—), with the proviso that the terminal atoms in L (e.g., those adjacent to carbonyl or nitrogen) are carbon atoms.
  • alkyl e.g., —CH 2 —CH 2 —
  • alkoxy —C—O—
  • alkylamino e.g., —CH 2 —NH—
  • the linker is preferably unbranched.
  • the linker is a hydrocarbon linker
  • Such a linker may have the structure —(CH 2 ) n —, where n is 1-12, preferably 2-8, and more preferably 2-6.
  • the morpholino subunits have the structure:
  • Pi is a base-pairing moiety
  • linkages depicted above connect the nitrogen atom of (i) to the 5′ carbon of an adjacent subunit.
  • the base-pairing moieties Pi may be the same or different, and are generally designed to provide a sequence which binds to a target nucleic acid.
  • linkage types (b1), (b2) and (b3) above may be illustrated graphically as follows:
  • all cationic linkages in the oligomer are of the same type; i.e. all of type (b1), all of type (b2), or all of type (b3).
  • the cationic linkages are selected from linkages (b1′) and (b1′′) as shown below, where (b1′′) is referred to herein as a “Pip” linkage and (b1′′) is referred to herein as a “GuX” linkage:
  • W is S or O, and is preferably O; each of R 1 and R 2 is independently selected from hydrogen and lower alkyl, and is preferably methyl; and A represents hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent on one or more carbon atoms in (b1′) and (b1′′).
  • the ring carbons in the piperazine ring are unsubstituted; however, they may include non-interfering substituents, such as methyl or fluorine.
  • at most one or two carbon atoms is so substituted.
  • at least 10% of the linkages are of type (b1′) or (b1′′); for example, 10%-60% and preferably 20% to 50%, of the linkages may be of type (b1′) or (b1′′).
  • the oligomer contains no linkages of the type (b1′) above.
  • the oligomer contains no linkages of type (b1) where each R is H, R 3 is H or CH 3 , and R 4 is H, CH 3 , or an electron pair.
  • the morpholino subunits may also be linked by non-phosphorus-based intersubunit linkages, as described further below, where at least one linkage is modified with a pendant cationic group as described above.
  • oligonucleotide analog linkages which are uncharged in their unmodified state but which could also bear a pendant amine substituent could be used.
  • a 5′nitrogen atom on a morpholino ring could be employed in a sulfamide linkage or a urea linkage (where phosphorus is replaced with carbon or sulfur, respectively) and modified in a manner analogous to the 5′-nitrogen atom in structure (b3) above.
  • Oligomers having any number of cationic linkages are provided, including fully cationic-linked oligomers. Preferably, however, the oligomers are partially charged, having, for example, 10%-80%. In preferred embodiments, about 10% to 60%, and preferably 20% to 50% of the linkages are cationic.
  • the cationic linkages are interspersed along the backbone.
  • the partially charged oligomers preferably contain at least two consecutive uncharged linkages; that is, the oligomer preferably does not have a strictly alternating pattern along its entire length.
  • oligomers having blocks of cationic linkages and blocks of uncharged linkages; for example, a central block of uncharged linkages may be flanked by blocks of cationic linkages, or vice versa.
  • the oligomer has approximately equal-length 5′, 3′ and center regions, and the percentage of cationic linkages in the center region is greater than about 50%, preferably greater than about 70%.
  • Oligomers for use in antisense applications generally range in length from about 10 to about 40 subunits, more preferably about 10 to 30 subunits, and typically 15-25 bases.
  • an oligomer of the invention having 19-20 subunits, a useful length for an antisense compound may ideally have two to ten, e.g., four to eight, cationic linkages, and the remainder uncharged linkages.
  • An oligomer having 14-15 subunits may ideally have two to seven, e.g., 3, 4, or 5, cationic linkages and the remainder uncharged linkages.
  • Each morpholino ring structure supports a base pairing moiety, to form a sequence of base pairing moieties which is typically designed to hybridize to a selected antisense target in a cell or in a subject being treated.
  • the base pairing moiety may be a purine or pyrimidine found in native DNA or RNA (e.g., A, G, C, T or U) or an analog, such as hypoxanthine (the base component of the nucleoside inosine) or 5-methyl cytosine.
  • the antisense compounds of the invention may include an oligonucleotide moiety conjugated to an arginine-rich peptide transport moiety effective to enhance transport of the compound into cells.
  • the transport moiety may be attached to a terminus of the oligomer, as shown, for example, in FIG. 1C .
  • the peptide transport moiety preferably comprises 6 to 16 subunits selected from X′ subunits, Y′ subunits, and Z′ subunits, where
  • each X′ subunit independently represents lysine, arginine or an arginine analog, said analog being a cationic ⁇ -amino acid comprising a side chain of the structure R 1 N ⁇ C(NH 2 )R 2 , where R 1 is H or R; R 2 is R, NH 2 , NHR, or NR 2 , where R is lower alkyl or lower alkenyl and may further include oxygen or nitrogen; R 1 and R 2 may together form a ring; and the side chain is linked to said amino acid via R 1 or R 2 ;
  • each Y′ subunit independently represents a neutral amino acid —C(O)—(CHR) n —NH—, where n is 2 to 7 and each R is independently H or methyl;
  • each Z′ subunit independently represents an ⁇ -amino acid having a neutral aralkyl side chain
  • the peptide comprises a sequence represented by one of (X′Y′X′) p , (X′Y′) m , and (X′Z′Z′) p , where p is 2 to 5 and m is 2 to 8.
  • Certain embodiments include various combinations selected independently from (X′Y′X′) p , (X′Y′) m , and/or (X′Z′Z′) p , including, for example, peptides having the sequence (X′Y′X′)(X′Z′Z′)(X′Y′X′)(X′Z′Z′) (SEQ ID NO:31).
  • each Y′ is —CO—(CH 2 ) n —CHR—NH—, where n is 2 to 7 and R is H.
  • Y′ is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit, abbreviated herein as Ahx; when n is 2 and R is H, Y′ is a ⁇ -alanine subunit, abbreviated herein as B.
  • Certain embodiments relate to carrier peptides having a combination of different neutral amino acids, including, for example, peptides comprising the sequence -RAhxRRBRRAhxRRBRAhxB- (SEQ ID NO:26), which contains both ⁇ -alanine and 6-aminohexanoic acid.
  • Preferred peptides of this type include those comprising arginine dimers alternating with single Y′ subunits, where Y′ is preferably Ahx.
  • Examples include peptides having the formula (RY′R) p or the formula (RRY′) p , where Y′ is preferably Ahx.
  • Y′ is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit
  • R is arginine
  • p is 4.
  • Certain embodiments include various linear combinations of at least two of (RY′R) p and (RRY′) p , including, for example, illustrative peptides having the sequence (RY′R)(RRY′)(RY′R)(RRY′) (SEQ ID NO:32), or (RRY′)(RY′R)(RRY′) (SEQ ID NO:33). Other combinations are contemplated.
  • each Z′ is phenylalanine, and m is 3 or 4.
  • the conjugated peptide is preferably linked to a terminus of the oligomer via a linker Ahx-B, where Ahx is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit and B is a ⁇ -alanine subunit, as shown, for example, in FIG. 1C .
  • the side chain moiety is independently selected from the group consisting of guanidyl (HN ⁇ C(NH 2 )NH—), amidinyl (HN ⁇ C(NH 2 )C ⁇ ), 2-aminodihydropyrimidyl, 2-aminotetrahydropyrimidyl, 2-aminopyridinyl, and 2-aminopyrimidonyl, and it is preferably selected from guanidyl and amidinyl.
  • the side chain moiety is guanidyl, as in the amino acid subunit arginine (Arg).
  • the Y′ subunits may be either contiguous, in that no X′ subunits intervene between Y′ subunits, or interspersed singly between X′ subunits.
  • the linking subunit may be between Y′ subunits.
  • the Y′ subunits are at a terminus of the transporter; in other embodiments, they are flanked by X′ subunits.
  • each Y′ is —CO—(CH 2 ) n —CHR—NH—, where n is 2 to 7 and R is H.
  • Y′ is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit, abbreviated herein as Ahx.
  • each X′ comprises a guanidyl side chain moiety, as in an arginine subunit.
  • Preferred peptides of this type include those comprising arginine dimers alternating with single Y′ subunits, where Y′ is preferably Ahx. Examples include peptides having the formula (RY′R) 4 or the formula (RRY′) 4 , where Y′ is preferably Ahx.
  • the nucleic acid analog is preferably linked to a terminal Y′ subunit, preferably at the C-terminus, as shown, for example, in FIG. 1C .
  • the preferred linker is of the structure AhxB, where Ahx is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit and B is a ⁇ -alanine subunit.
  • the transport moieties as described herein have been shown to greatly enhance cell entry of attached oligomers, relative to uptake of the oligomer in the absence of the attached transport moiety, and relative to uptake by an attached transport moiety lacking the hydrophobic subunits Y′.
  • Such enhanced uptake is preferably evidenced by at least a two-fold increase, and preferably a four-fold increase, in the uptake of the compound into mammalian cells relative to uptake of the agent by an attached transport moiety lacking the hydrophobic subunits Y′.
  • Uptake is preferably enhanced at least twenty fold, and more preferably forty fold, relative to the unconjugated compound.
  • a further benefit of the transport moiety is its expected ability to stabilize a duplex between an antisense compound and its target nucleic acid sequence, presumably by virtue of electrostatic interaction between the positively charged transport moiety and the negatively charged nucleic acid.
  • the number of charged subunits in the transporter is less than 14, as noted above, and preferably between 8 and 11.
  • arginine-rich peptide transporters i.e., cell-penetrating peptides
  • Certain peptide transporters have been shown to be highly effective at delivery of antisense compounds into primary cells including hematopoietic and muscle cells (Marshall, Oda et al. 2007; Jearawiriyapaisarn, Moulton et al. 2008; Wu, Moulton et al. 2008).
  • the peptide transporters described herein when conjugated to an antisense PMO, demonstrate an enhanced ability to alter splicing of several gene transcripts (Marshall, Oda et al. 2007).
  • Exemplary peptide transporters, including linkers (B or AhxB) are shown in Table 3 below.
  • linkers B or AhxB
  • P007, CP04057, and CP06062 transport peptides (SEQ ID NOS:21, 25, and 26, respectively).
  • Peptide Transporters SEQ Sequence ID Peptide (N-terminal to C-terminal) NO: rTAT RRRQRRKKRC 18 R 9 F 2 RRRRRRRRRFFC 19 (RRAhx) 4 B RRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxB 20 (RAhxR) 4 AhxB; RAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRAhxB 21 (P007) (AhxRR) 4 AhxB AhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxB 22 (RAhx) 6 B RAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxB 23 (RAhx) 8 B RAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhx 24 RAhxRahxB (RAhxR) 5 AhxB RAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhx 25 (CP04057) RAhxB (RAhxR) 5 Ah
  • RNA interference is an evolutionarily conserved gene-silencing mechanism, originally discovered in studies of the nematode Caenorhabditis elegans (Lee et al, Cell 75:843, 1993; Reinhart et al., Nature 403:901, 2000). It may be triggered by introducing dsRNA into cells expressing the appropriate molecular machinery, which then degrades the corresponding endogenous mRNA. The mechanism involves conversion of dsRNA into short RNAs that direct ribonucleases to homologous mRNA targets (summarized, Ruvkun, Science 2294:797, 2001).
  • dsRNAs generally comprise two single strands.
  • One strand of the dsRNA comprises a nucleotide sequence that is substantially identical to a portion of the target gene or target region (the “sense” strand), and the other strand (the “complementary” or “antisense” strand) comprises a sequence that is substantially complementary to a portion of the target region.
  • the strands are sufficiently complementary to hybridize to form a duplex structure.
  • the complementary RNA strand may be less than 30 nucleotides, less than 25 nucleotides in length, or even 19 to 24 nucleotides in length. In certain aspects, the complementary nucleotide sequence may be 20-23 nucleotides in length, or 22 nucleotides in length.
  • RNA strands comprises a nucleotide overhang of 1 to 4 nucleotides in length.
  • the dsRNA may further comprise at least one chemically modified nucleotide.
  • a dsRNA comprising a single-stranded overhang of 1 to 4 nucleotides may comprise a molecule wherein the unpaired nucleotide of the single-stranded overhang that is directly adjacent to the terminal nucleotide pair contains a purine base.
  • the last complementary nucleotide pairs on both ends of a dsRNA are a G-C pair, or, at least two of the last four terminal nucleotide pairs are G-C pairs.
  • Micro-RNAs represent a large group of small RNAs produced naturally in organisms, some of which regulate the expression of target genes. Micro-RNAs are formed from an approximately 70 nucleotide single-stranded hairpin precursor transcript by Dicer. (V. Ambros et al. Current Biology 13:807, 2003). Micro-RNAs are not translated into proteins, but instead bind to specific messenger RNAs, thereby blocking translation. It is thought that micro-RNAs base-pair imprecisely with their targets to inhibit translation. Certain micro-RNAs may be transcribed as hairpin RNA precursors, which are then processed to their mature forms by Dicer enzyme.
  • the modulating agent, or RNAi oligonucleotide is single stranded. In other embodiments, the modulating agent, or RNAi oligonucleotide, is double stranded. Certain embodiments may also employ short-interfering RNAs (siRNA).
  • the first strand of the double-stranded oligonucleotide contains two more nucleoside residues than the second strand. In other embodiments, the first strand and the second strand have the same number of nucleosides; however, the first and second strands are offset such that the two terminal nucleosides on the first and second strands are not paired with a residue on the complimentary strand. In certain instances, the two nucleosides that are not paired are thymidine resides.
  • the agent should include a region of sufficient homology to the target region, and be of sufficient length in terms of nucleotides, such that the siRNA agent, or a fragment thereof, can mediate down regulation of the target RNA.
  • the term “ribonucleotide” or “nucleotide” can, in the case of a modified RNA or nucleotide surrogate, also refer to a modified nucleotide, or surrogate replacement moiety at one or more positions.
  • an siRNA agent is or includes a region which is at least partially complementary to the target RNA.
  • siRNA agent it is not necessary that there be perfect complementarity between the siRNA agent and the target, but the correspondence must be sufficient to enable the siRNA agent, or a cleavage product thereof, to direct sequence specific silencing, such as by RNAi cleavage of the target RNA.
  • Complementarity, or degree of homology with the target strand is most critical in the antisense strand. While perfect complementarity, particularly in the antisense strand, is often desired some embodiments include one or more but preferably 10, 8, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, or fewer mismatches with respect to the target RNA.
  • the mismatches are most tolerated in the terminal regions, and if present are preferably in a terminal region or regions, e.g., within 6, 5, 4, or 3 nucleotides of the 5′ and/or 3′ terminus.
  • the sense strand need only be sufficiently complementary with the antisense strand to maintain the over all double-strand character of the molecule.
  • an siRNA modulating agent may be modified or include nucleoside surrogates.
  • Single stranded regions of an siRNA agent may be modified or include nucleoside surrogates, e.g., the unpaired region or regions of a hairpin structure, e.g., a region which links two complementary regions, can have modifications or nucleoside surrogates. Modification to stabilize one or more 3′- or 5′-terminus of an siRNA agent, e.g., against exonucleases, or to favor the antisense siRNA agent to enter into RISC are also useful.
  • Modifications can include C3 (or C6, C7, C12) amino linkers, thiol linkers, carboxyl linkers, non-nucleotidic spacers (C3, C6, C9, C12, abasic, triethylene glycol, hexaethylene glycol), special biotin or fluorescein reagents that come as phosphoramidites and that have another DMT-protected hydroxyl group, allowing multiple couplings during RNA synthesis.
  • siRNA agents may include, for example, molecules that are long enough to trigger the interferon response (which can be cleaved by Dicer (Bernstein et al. 2001. Nature, 409:363-366) and enter a RISC (RNAi-induced silencing complex)), in addition to molecules which are sufficiently short that they do not trigger the interferon response (which molecules can also be cleaved by Dicer and/or enter a RISC), e.g., molecules which are of a size which allows entry into a RISC, e.g., molecules which resemble Dicer-cleavage products. Molecules that are short enough that they do not trigger an interferon response are termed siRNA agents or shorter RNAi agents herein.
  • siRNA agent or shorter RNAi agent refers to an siRNA agent that is sufficiently short that it does not induce a deleterious interferon response in a human cell, e.g., it has a duplexed region of less than 60 but preferably less than 50, 40, or 30 nucleotide pairs.
  • An siRNA modulating agent, or a cleavage product thereof can down regulate a target gene, e.g., by inducing RNAi with respect to a target RNA.
  • Each strand of an siRNA modulating agent can be equal to or less than 35, 30, 25, 24, 23, 22, 21, or 20 nucleotides in length.
  • the strand is preferably at least 19 nucleotides in length.
  • each strand can be between 21 and 25 nucleotides in length.
  • Preferred siRNA agents have a duplex region of 17, 18, 19, 29, 21, 22, 23, 24, or 25 nucleotide pairs, and one or more overhangs, preferably one or two 3′ overhangs, of 2-3 nucleotides.
  • an siRNA modulating agent may have one or more of the following properties: it may, despite modifications, even to a very large number, or all of the nucleosides, have an antisense strand that can present bases (or modified bases) in the proper three dimensional framework so as to be able to form correct base pairing and form a duplex structure with a homologous target RNA which is sufficient to allow down regulation of the target, e.g., by cleavage of the target RNA; it may, despite modifications, even to a very large number, or all of the nucleosides, still have “RNA-like” properties, i.e., it may possess the overall structural, chemical and physical properties of an RNA molecule, even though not exclusively, or even partly, of ribonucleotide-based content.
  • an siRNA agent can contain, e.g., a sense and/or an antisense strand in which all of the nucleotide sugars contain e.g., 2′ fluoro in place of 2′ hydroxyl.
  • This deoxyribonucleotide-containing agent can still be expected to exhibit RNA-like properties.
  • the electronegative fluorine prefers an axial orientation when attached to the C2′ position of ribose. This spatial preference of fluorine can, in turn, force the sugars to adopt a C 3 ′-endo pucker. This is the same puckering mode as observed in RNA molecules and gives rise to the RNA-characteristic A-family-type helix.
  • fluorine is a good hydrogen bond acceptor, it can participate in the same hydrogen bonding interactions with water molecules that are known to stabilize RNA structures. Generally, it is preferred that a modified moiety at the 2′ sugar position will be able to enter into H-bonding which is more characteristic of the OH moiety of a ribonucleotide than the H moiety of a deoxyribonucleotide.
  • a “single strand RNAi agent” as used herein, is an RNAi agent which is made up of a single molecule. It may include a duplexed region, formed by intra-strand pairing, e.g., it may be, or include, a hairpin or pan-handle structure.
  • Single strand RNAi modulating agents are preferably antisense with regard to the target molecule.
  • a single strand RNAi agent should be sufficiently long that it can enter the RISC and participate in RISC mediated cleavage of a target mRNA.
  • a single strand RNAi agent is at least 14, and more preferably at least 15, 20, 25, 29, 35, 40, or 50 nucleotides in length. It is preferably less than 200, 100, or 60 nucleotides in length.
  • Hairpin RNAi modulating agents may have a duplex region equal to or at least 17, 18, 19, 29, 21, 22, 23, 24, or 25 nucleotide pairs.
  • the duplex region may preferably be equal to or less than 200, 100, or 50, in length. Certain ranges for the duplex region are 15-30, 17 to 23, 19 to 23, and 19 to 21 nucleotides pairs in length.
  • the hairpin may have a single strand overhang or terminal unpaired region, preferably the 3′, and preferably of the antisense side of the hairpin. In certain embodiments, overhangs are 2-3 nucleotides in length.
  • RNAi oligonucleotides such as chimeric oligonucleotides, or “chimeras,” which contain two or more chemically distinct regions, each made up of at least one monomer unit, i.e., a nucleotide in the case of an oligonucleotide compound.
  • oligonucleotides typically contain at least one region wherein the oligonucleotide is modified so as to confer upon the oligonucleotide increased resistance to nuclease degradation, increased cellular uptake, and/or increased binding affinity for the target nucleic acid.
  • Chimeric oligonucleotides may be formed as composite structures of two or more oligonucleotides, modified oligonucleotides, oligonucleotides and/or oligonucleotide mimetics as described above. Such oligonucleotides have also been referred to in the art as hybrids or gapmers. Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of such hybrid structures include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • the chimeric oligonucleotide is RNA-DNA, DNA-RNA, RNA-DNA-RNA, DNA-RNA-DNA, or RNA-DNA-RNA-DNA, wherein the oligonucleotide is between 5 and 60 nucleotides in length.
  • modulating agents such as RNAi agents
  • modulating agents relate to an oligonucleotide comprising at least one ligand tethered to an altered or non-natural nucleobase.
  • a large number of compounds can function as the altered base.
  • the structure of the altered base is important to the extent that the altered base should not substantially prevent binding of the oligonucleotide to its target, e.g., mRNA.
  • the altered base is difluorotolyl, nitropyrrolyl, nitroimidazolyl, nitroindolyl, napthalenyl, anthrancenyl, pyridinyl, quinolinyl, pyrenyl, or the divalent radical of any one of the non-natural nucleobases described herein.
  • the non-natural nucleobase is difluorotolyl, nitropyrrolyl, or nitroimidazolyl.
  • the non-natural nucleobase is difluorotolyl.
  • a wide variety of ligands are known in the art and are amenable to the present invention.
  • the ligand can be a steroid, bile acid, lipid, folic acid, pyridoxal, B12, riboflavin, biotin, aromatic compound, polycyclic compound, crown ether, intercalator, cleaver molecule, protein-binding agent, or carbohydrate.
  • the ligand is a steroid or aromatic compound.
  • the ligand is cholesteryl.
  • the RNAi agent is an oligonucleotide tethered to a ligand for the purposes of improving cellular targeting and uptake.
  • a ligand for the purposes of improving cellular targeting and uptake.
  • an RNAi agent may be tethered to an antibody, or antigen binding fragment thereof.
  • an RNAi agent may be tethered to a specific ligand binding molecule, such as a polypeptide or polypeptide fragment that specifically binds a particular cell-surface receptor.
  • the modulating agent comprises a non-natural nucleobase.
  • the non-natural nucleobase is difluorotolyl, nitroimidazolyl, nitroindolyl, or nitropyrrolyl.
  • the modulating agents provided herein relate to a double-stranded oligonucleotide sequence, wherein only one of the two strands contains a non-natural nucleobase.
  • the modulating agents as used herein relate to a double-stranded oligonucleotide sequence, wherein both of the strands independently comprise at least one non-natural nucleobase.
  • the ribose sugar moiety that naturally occurs in nucleosides is replaced with a hexose sugar.
  • the hexose sugar is an allose, altrose, glucose, mannose, gulose, idose, galactose, talose, or a derivative thereof.
  • the hexose is a D-hexose.
  • the ribose sugar moiety that naturally occurs in nucleosides is replaced with a polycyclic heteroalkyl ring or cyclohexenyl group.
  • the polycyclic heteroalkyl group is a bicyclic ring containing one oxygen atom in the ring.
  • the polycyclic heteroalkyl group is a bicyclo[2.2.1]heptane, a bicyclo[3.2.1]octane, or a bicyclo[3.3.1]nonane.
  • the backbone of the oligonucleotide has been modified to improve the therapeutic or diagnostic properties of the oligonucleotide compound.
  • at least one of the bases or at least one of the sugars of the oligonucleotide has been modified to improve the therapeutic or diagnostic properties of the oligonucleotide compound.
  • the two strands are complementary, partially complementary, or chimeric oligonucleotides.
  • modified RNAi agents envisioned for use in the methods of the present invention include oligonucleotides containing modified backbones or non-natural internucleoside linkages.
  • oligonucleotides having modified backbones or internucleoside linkages include those that retain a phosphorus atom in the backbone and those that do not have a phosphorus atom in the backbone.
  • Modified oligonucleotides that do not have a phosphorus atom in their intersugar backbone can also be considered to be oligonucleotides.
  • Specific oligonucleotide chemical modifications are described below. It is not necessary for all positions in a given compound to be uniformly modified, and in fact more than one of the following modifications may be incorporated in a single oligonucleotide compound or even in a single nucleotide thereof
  • modified internucleoside linkages or backbones include, for example, phosphorothioates, chiral phosphorothioates, phosphorodithioates, phosphotriesters, aminoalkylphosphotriesters, methyl and other alkyl phosphonates including 3′-alkylene phosphonates and chiral phosphonates, phosphinates, phosphoramidates including 3′-amino phosphoramidate and aminoalkylphosphoramidates, thionophosphoramidates, thionoalkylphosphonates, thionoalklyphosphotriesters, and boranophosphates having normal 3′-5′ linkages, 2′-5′ linked analogs of these, and those having inverted polarity wherein the adjacent pairs of nucleoside units are linked 3′-5′ to 5′-3′ or 2′-5′ to 5′-2′.
  • Various salts, mixed salts and free-acid forms are also included.
  • modified internucleoside linkages or backbones that do not include a phosphorus atom therein i.e., oligonucleotides
  • backbones that are formed by short chain alkyl or cycloalkyl intersugar linkages, mixed heteroatom and alkyl or cycloalkyl intersugar linkages, or one or more short chain heteroatomic or heterocyclic intersugar linkages.
  • morpholino linkages formed in part from the sugar portion of a nucleoside
  • siloxane backbones sulfide, sulfoxide and sulfone backbones
  • formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones methylene formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones
  • alkene containing backbones sulfamate backbones
  • sulfonate and sulfonamide backbones amide backbones; and others having mixed N, O, S and CH 2 component parts.
  • both the sugar and the internucleoside linkage, i.e., the backbone, of the nucleoside units may be replaced with novel groups.
  • the nucleobase units are maintained for hybridization with an appropriate nucleic acid target compound.
  • a peptide nucleic acid PNA
  • the sugar-backbone of an oligonucleotide is replaced with an amide-containing backbone, in particular an aminoethylglycine backbone.
  • nucleobases are retained and are bound directly or indirectly to atoms of the amide portion of the backbone.
  • Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of PNA compounds include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,539,082; 5,714,331; and 5,719,262, each of which is herein incorporated by reference. Further teaching of PNA compounds can be found in Nielsen et al., Science, 1991, 254, 1497.
  • the present invention further encompasses oligonucleotides employing ribozymes.
  • Synthetic RNA molecules and derivatives thereof that catalyze highly specific endoribonuclease activities are known as ribozymes.
  • the cleavage reactions are catalyzed by the RNA molecules themselves.
  • the sites of self-catalyzed cleavage are located within highly conserved regions of RNA secondary structure (Buzayan et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci.
  • RNA molecules Naturally occurring autocatalytic RNA molecules have been modified to generate ribozymes which can be targeted to a particular cellular or pathogenic RNA molecule with a high degree of specificity.
  • ribozymes serve the same general purpose as antisense oligonucleotides (i.e., modulation of expression of a specific gene) and, like oligonucleotides, are nucleic acids possessing significant portions of single-strandedness. That is, ribozymes have substantial chemical and functional identity with oligonucleotides and are thus considered to be equivalents for purposes of the present invention.
  • RNAi agents for use with the methods provided herein may be modified by non-ligand group.
  • non-ligand molecules have been conjugated to oligonucleotides in order to enhance the activity, cellular distribution, cellular targeting, or cellular uptake of the oligonucleotide, and procedures for performing such conjugations are available in the scientific literature.
  • Such non-ligand moieties have included lipid moieties, such as cholesterol (Letsinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 1989, 86:6553), cholic acid (Manoharan et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem.
  • a thioether e.g., hexyl-5-tritylthiol (Manoharan et al., Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci., 1992, 660:306; Manoharan et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Let., 1993, 3:2765), a thiocholesterol (Oberhauser et al., Nucl.
  • Acids Res., 1990, 18:3777 a polyamine or a polyethylene glycol chain (Manoharan et al., Nucleosides & Nucleotides, 1995, 14:969), or adamantane acetic acid (Manoharan et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36:3651), a palmityl moiety (Mishra et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 1995, 1264:229), or an octadecylamine or hexylamino-carbonyl-oxycholesterol moiety (Crooke et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 1996, 277:923).
  • Typical conjugation protocols involve the synthesis of oligonucleotides bearing an aminolinker at one or more positions of the sequence. The amino group is then reacted with the molecule being conjugated using appropriate coupling or activating reagents. The conjugation reaction may be performed either with the oligonucleotide still bound to the solid support or following cleavage of the oligonucleotide in solution phase. Purification of the oligonucleotide conjugate by HPLC typically affords the pure conjugate.
  • RNAi oligonucleotides may be found in U.S. Application Publication Nos. 2007/0275465, 2007/0054279, 2006/0287260, 2006/0035254, 2006/0008822, which are incorporated by reference.
  • the present invention relates to methods of using the NHR-targeted antisense or RNAi agents described herein for treating a cell, tissue or subject, typically to modulate the activity of an NHR in a therapeutically beneficial manner.
  • the cells or tissue that may be modulated by the present invention are preferably mammalian cells, or more preferably human cells. Such cells can be of a healthy state or of a diseased state.
  • methods for modulating therapeutically relevant cellular activities including, but not limited to, cellular metabolism, cell differentiation, cell proliferation, cell death, cell mobilization, cell migration, immune system function (e.g., inflammation, auto-immunity), gene transcription, mRNA translation, cell impedance, cytokine production, and the like, comprising contacting a cell with an NHR-targeted antisense or RNAi agent as described herein.
  • Specific embodiments relate to modulating the activity of the glucocorticoid receptor (GR).
  • GR glucocorticoid receptor
  • certain GR-targeted antisense or RNAi agents may be employed to treat metabolic diseases associated with increased levels of glucocorticoid, such as diabetes, osteoporosis and glaucoma, among others.
  • Preferred embodiments agonize transrepression, and optionally antagonize transactivation. These and related embodiments may be useful in the treatment of inflammatory conditions.
  • certain GR-targeted antisense or RNAi agents may be employed to treated metabolic diseases associated with a deficiency in glucocorticoid, such as Addison's disease and others.
  • Such embodiments may also be used as pro-inflammatory agents, to increase inflammatory responses in a subject in need thereof, as exemplified herein.
  • inflammation refers generally to the biological response of tissues to harmful stimuli, such as pathogens, damaged cells (e.g., wounds), and irritants.
  • inflammatory response refers to the specific mechanisms by which inflammation is achieved and regulated, including, merely by way of illustration, immune cell activation or migration, cytokine production, vasodilation, including kinin release, fibrinolysis, and coagulation, among others described herein and known in the art.
  • inflammation is a protective attempt by the body to both remove the injurious stimuli and initiate the healing process for the affected tissue or tissues.
  • wounds and infections would never heal, creating a situation in which progressive destruction of the tissue would threaten survival.
  • excessive or chronic inflammation may associate with a variety of diseases, such as hay fever, atherosclerosis, and rheumatoid arthritis, among others described herein and known in the art.
  • the NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents of the invention may modulate acute inflammation, chronic inflammation, or both. Certain embodiments relate to increasing acute inflammation or acute inflammatory responses, and certain embodiments relate to increasing chronic inflammation or chronic inflammatory responses. Depending on the needs of the subject, certain embodiments relate to reducing acute inflammation or inflammatory responses, and certain embodiments relate to reducing chronic inflammation or chronic inflammatory responses.
  • Acute inflammation relates to the initial response of the body to presumably harmful stimuli and involves increased movement of plasma and leukocytes from the blood into the injured tissues. It is a short-term process, typically beginning within minutes or hours and ending upon the removal of the injurious stimulus.
  • Acute inflammation may be characterized by any one or more of redness, increased heat, swelling, pain, and loss of function. Redness and heat are due mainly to increased blood flow at body core temperature to the inflamed site, swelling is caused by accumulation of fluid, pain is typically due to release of chemicals that stimulate nerve endings, and loss of function has multiple causes.
  • Acute inflammatory responses are initiated mainly by local immune cells, such as resident macrophages, dendritic cells, histiocytes, Kuppfer cells and mastocytes.
  • local immune cells such as resident macrophages, dendritic cells, histiocytes, Kuppfer cells and mastocytes.
  • these cells undergo activation and release inflammatory mediators responsible for the clinical signs of inflammation, such as vasoactive amines and eicosanoids.
  • Vasodilation and its resulting increased blood flow cause the redness and increased heat.
  • Increased permeability of the blood vessels results in an exudation or leakage of plasma proteins and fluid into the tissue, which creates swelling.
  • Certain released mediators such as bradykinin increase sensitivity to pain, and alter the blood vessels to permit the migration or extravasation of leukocytes, such as neutrophils, which typically migrate along a chemotactic gradient created by the local immune cells.
  • Acute inflammatory responses also includes one or more acellular biochemical cascade systems, consisting of preformed plasma proteins modulate, which act in parallel to initiate and propagate the inflammatory response.
  • acellular biochemical cascade systems consisting of preformed plasma proteins modulate, which act in parallel to initiate and propagate the inflammatory response.
  • These systems include the complement system, which is mainly activated by bacteria, and the coagulation and fibrinolysis systems, which are mainly activated by necrosis, such as the type of tissue damage that is caused by certain infections, burns, or other trauma.
  • antisense and RNAi agents may be used to modulate acute inflammation, or any of one or more of the individual acute inflammatory responses.
  • Chronic inflammation a prolonged and delayed inflammatory response, is characterized by a progressive shift in the type of cells that are present at the site of inflammation, and often leads to simultaneous or near simultaneous destruction and healing of the tissue from the inflammatory process.
  • chronic inflammatory responses involve a variety of immune cells such as monocytes, macrophages, lymphocytes, plasma cells, and fibroblasts, though in contrast to acute inflammation, which is mediated mainly by granulocytes, chronic inflammation is mainly mediated by mononuclear cells such as monocytes and lymphocytes.
  • Chronic inflammation also involves a variety of inflammatory mediators, such as IFN- ⁇ and other cytokines, growth factors, reactive oxygen species, and hydrolytic enzymes. Chronic inflammation may last for many months or years, and may result in undesired tissue destruction and fibrosis.
  • Chronic inflammation is associated with a variety of pathological conditions or diseases, including, for example, allergies, Alzheimer's disease, anemia, aortic valve stenosis, arthritis such as rheumatoid arthritis and osteoarthritis, cancer, congestive heart failure, fibromyalgia, fibrosis, heart attack, kidney failure, lupus, pancreatitis, stroke, surgical complications, inflammatory lung disease, inflammatory bowel disease, atherosclerosis, and psoriasis, among others described herein and known in the art.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to treat or manage chronic inflammation, modulate any of one or more of the individual chronic inflammatory responses, or treat any one or more diseases or conditions associated with chronic inflammation.
  • Antisense and RNAi agents may also modulate proliferative inflammation, an inflammatory process characterized by an increase in the number of tissue cells. These can encompass skin conditions such as psoriasis, seborrhea or eczema, or can also be thought of in terms of cancers and abnormal growths especially in light of accumulating evidence based on more efficient molecular methods to document even low grade chronic inflammation.
  • antisense and RNAi agents may modulate inflammatory responses at the cellular level, such as by modulating the activation, inflammatory molecule secretion (e.g., cytokine or kinin secretion), proliferation, activity, migration, or adhesion of various cells involved in inflammation. Examples of such cells include immune cells and vascular cells.
  • inflammatory molecule secretion e.g., cytokine or kinin secretion
  • proliferation e.g., proliferation, activity, migration, or adhesion of various cells involved in inflammation. Examples of such cells include immune cells and vascular cells.
  • Immune cells include, for example, granulocytes such as neutrophils, eosinophils and basophils, macrophages/monocytes, lymphocytes such as B-cells, killer T-cells (i.e., CD8+ T-cells), helper T-cells (i.e., CD4+ T-cells, including T h 1 and T h 2 cells), natural killer cells, ⁇ T-cells, dendritic cells, and mast cells.
  • vascular cells include smooth muscle cells, endothelial cells, and fibroblasts. Also included are methods of modulating an inflammatory condition associated with one or more immune cells or vascular cells, including neutrophil-mediated, macrophage-mediated, and lymphocyte-mediated inflammatory conditions.
  • antisense and RNAi agents may modulate the levels or activity of inflammatory molecules, including plasma-derived inflammatory molecules and cell-derived inflammatory molecules (e.g., TNF-alpha, IL-1, IL-2, IL-5, adhesion molecules, Cox-2, and others). Included are pro-inflammatory molecules and anti-inflammatory molecules.
  • plasma-derived inflammatory molecules include, without limitation, proteins or molecules of any one or more of the complement system, kinin system, coagulation system, and the fibrinolysis system.
  • members of the complement system include C1, which exists in blood serum as a molecular complex containing about 6 molecules of C1q, 2 molecules of C1r, and 2 molecules of C1s, C2 (a and b), C3(a and B), C4 (a and b), C5, and the membrane attack complex of C5a, C5b, C6, C7, C8, and C9.
  • members of the kinin system include bradykinin, kallidin, kallidreins, carboxypeptidases, angiotensin-converting enzyme, and neutral endopeptidase.
  • cell-derived inflammatory molecules include, without limitation, enzymes contained within lysosome granules, vasoactive amines, eicosanoids, cytokines, acute-phase proteins, and soluble gases such as nitric oxide.
  • Vasoactive amines contain at least one amino group, and target blood vessels to alter their permeability or cause vasodilation. Examples of vasoactive amines include histamine and serotonin.
  • Eicosanoids refer to signaling molecules made by oxidation of twenty-carbon essential fatty acids, and include prostaglandins, prostacyclins, thromboxanes, and leukotrienes.
  • Cytokines refer to a variety of substances that are secreted by immune cells, and include polypeptides and glycoproteins. Typically, cytokines are categorized as either autocrine cytokines, which act on the same type of cell from which the cytokine is secreted, or paracrine cytokines, which are restricted to acting on a different cell type from which the cytokine is secreted.
  • cytokines examples include GM-CSF, IL-1a, IL1b, IL-2, IL-3, IL-4, IL-5, IL-6, IL-7, IL-8, IL-9, IL-10, IL-12, IFN- ⁇ , IFN- ⁇ , IFN-gamma, MIP-1 ⁇ , MIP-1 ⁇ , TGF- ⁇ , TNF- ⁇ , TNF- ⁇ , CXCL1-5, CXCL9-14, and CXCL16, among others known in the art.
  • Each cytokine typically has a corresponding cytokine receptor.
  • cytokine receptors include, without limitation, receptors from the immunoglobulin (Ig) superfamily, such as the IL-1 receptor types, which share structural homology with immunoglobulins (antibodies), cell adhesion molecules, and even some cytokines, and receptors from the hematopoietic growth factor family, such as the IL-2 receptor family and the receptors for GM-CSF, IL-3, and IL-5, receptors from the interferon (type 2) family, including receptors for IFN ⁇ and ⁇ .
  • Ig immunoglobulin
  • NHR-targeted antisense or RNAi agents may modulate the levels or activity of one or more selected cytokines, the levels or activity of one or more selected cytokine receptors, the interaction between cytokines and their receptors, or any combination thereof.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also modulate levels or activity of acute-phase proteins.
  • acute-phase proteins include C-reactive protein, serum amyloid A, serum amyloid P, and vasopressin.
  • expression of acute-phase proteins can cause a range of undesired systemic effects including amyloidosis, fever, increased blood pressure, decreased sweating, malaise, loss of appetite, and somnolence.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may modulate the levels or activity of acute-phase proteins, their systemic effects, or both.
  • antisense and RNAi agents may modulate local inflammation, systemic inflammation, or both. In certain embodiments, they may reduce or maintain (i.e., prevent further increases) local inflammation or local inflammatory responses. In certain embodiments, depending on the needs of the subject, antisense and RNAi agents may increase local inflammation or local inflammatory responses. In certain embodiments, they may reduce or maintain (i.e., prevent further increases) systemic inflammation or systemic inflammatory responses. In certain embodiments, depending on the needs of the subject, antisense and RNAi agents may increase systemic inflammation or systemic inflammatory responses.
  • the modulation of inflammation or inflammatory responses can be associated with one or more tissues or organs.
  • tissues or organs include skin (e.g., dermis, epidermis, subcutaneous layer), hair follicles, nervous system (e.g., brain, spinal cord, peripheral nerves), auditory system or balance organs (e.g., inner ear, middle ear, outer ear), respiratory system (e.g., nose, trachea, lungs), gastroesophogeal tissues, the gastrointestinal system (e.g., mouth, esophagus, stomach, small intestines, large intestines, rectum), vascular system (e.g., heart, blood vessels and arteries), liver, gallbladder, lymphatic/immune system (e.g., lymph nodes, lymphoid follicles, spleen, thymus, bone marrow), uro-genital system (e.g., kidneys, ureter
  • certain embodiments may employ the antisense and RNAi agents described herein to reduce or manage (i.e., prevent further increases) inflammation or inflammatory responses associated with particular tissues or organs. Included are inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the skin, including inflammation, infections, and cancers associated with the dermal, epidermal, and subcutaneous layers of the skin.
  • Examples of skin-associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, dermatitis, such as psoriasis, irritant dermatitis, seborrheic dermatitis, atopic dermatitis (eczema), allergic contact dermatitis, thermal-induced dermatitis, drug-induced dermatitis, dyshidrotic dermatitis, urticaria, autoimmune dermatitis, skin cancer such as melanoma, and bullous dermatitis. Also included are bacterial, viral and parasitic infections, erythema multiforme, erythema nodosum, granuloma annulare, poison oak/poison ivy, and toxic epidermal necrolysis.
  • dermatitis such as psoriasis, irritant dermatitis, seborrheic dermatitis, atopic dermatitis (eczema), allergic contact dermatitis, thermal-induced dermatitis, drug-induced dermatitis
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the nervous system, including inflammation, infections, and cancer associated with the brain and spinal cord of the central nervous system, the peripheral nervous system, and the meninges.
  • inflammatory mediators including complement, adhesion molecules, cyclooxygenase enzymes and their products and cytokines
  • cytokines include interleukin-1 (IL-1), have been implicated heavily in acute neurodegeneration, such as stroke and head injury.
  • IL-1 interleukin-1
  • nervous system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, meningitis (i.e., inflammation of the protective membranes covering the brain and spinal cord), myelitis, encaphaloymyelitis (e.g., myalgic encephalomyelitis, acute disseminated encephalomyelitis, encephalomyelitis disseminata or multiple sclerosis, autoimmune encephalomyelitis), arachnoiditis (i.e., inflammation of the arachnoid, one of the membranes that surround and protect the nerves of the central nervous system), granuloma, drug-induced inflammation or meningitis, neurodegenerative diseases such as Alzheimer's disease, stroke, HIV-dementia, encephalitis such viral encephalitis and bacterial encephalitis, parasitic infections, inflammatory demyeleniating disorders, and auto-immune disorders such as CD8+ T Cell-mediated autoimmune diseases of the CNS.
  • meningitis i.e., inflammation of
  • Parkinson's disease myasthenia gravis, motor neuropathy, Guillain-Barre syndrome, autoimmune neuropathy, Lambert-Eaton myasthenic syndrome, paraneoplastic neurological disease, paraneoplastic cerebellar atrophy, non-paraneoplastic stiff man syndrome, progressive cerebellar atrophy, Rasmussen's encephalitis, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, Sydeham chorea, Gilles de la Tourette syndrome, autoimmune polyendocrinopathy, dysimmune neuropathy, acquired neuromyotonia, arthrogryposis multiplex, optic neuritis, and stiff-man syndrome.
  • inflammation associated with infections of the nervous system includes, without limitation, streptococcal infection such as group B streptococci (e.g., subtypes III) and Streptococcus pneumoniae (e.g., serotypes 6, 9, 14, 18 and 23), Escherichia coli (e.g., carrying K1 antigen), Listeria monocytogenes (e.g., serotype IVb), neisserial infection such as Neisseria meningitidis (meningococcus), staphylococcal infection, heamophilus infection such as Haemophilus influenzae type B, Klebsiella , and Mycobacterium tuberculosis .
  • streptococcal infection such as group B streptococci (e.g., subtypes III) and Streptococcus pneumoniae (e.g., serotypes 6, 9, 14, 18 and 23)
  • Escherichia coli e.g., carrying K1 antigen
  • infections by staphylococci and pseudomonas and other Gram-negative bacilli mainly with respect to trauma to the skull, which gives bacteria in the nasal cavity the potential to enter the meningeal space, or in persons with cerebral shunt or related device (e.g., extraventricular drain, Ommaya reservoir).
  • viral infections associated with inflammation of the nervous system include, without limitation, enteroviruses, herpes simplex virus type 1 and 2, human T-lymphotrophic virus, varicella zoster virus (chickenpox and shingles), mumps virus, human immunodeficiency virus (HIV), and lymphocytic choriomeningitis virus (LCMV).
  • Meningitis may also result from infection by spirochetes such as Treponema pallidum (syphilis) and Borrelia burgdorferi (Lyme disease), parasites such as malaria (e.g., cerebral malaria), fungi such as Cryptococcus neoformans , and ameoba such as Naegleria fowleri.
  • spirochetes such as Treponema pallidum (syphilis) and Borrelia burgdorferi (Lyme disease)
  • parasites such as malaria (e.g., cerebral malaria)
  • fungi such as Cryptococcus neoformans
  • ameoba such as Naegleria fowleri.
  • Meningitis or other forms of nervous system inflammation may also associate with the spread of cancer to the meninges (malignant meningitis), certain drugs such as non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs, antibiotics and intravenous immunoglobulins, sarcoidosis (or neurosarcoidosis), connective tissue disorders such as systemic lupus erythematosus, and certain forms of vasculitis (inflammatory conditions of the blood vessel wall) such as Behçet's disease.
  • Epidermoid cysts and dermoid cysts may cause meningitis by releasing irritant matter into the subarachnoid space. Accordingly, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to treat or manage any one or more of these conditions.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the auditory system or balance organs, such as the inner ear, middle ear, and the outer ear.
  • auditory system or balance organ associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, outer ear inflammation (e.g., ear infections), middle ear inflammation, which may lead to fluid build-up in the normally air-filled space and associated conductive hearing loss, labyrinthitis, an inner ear infection or inflammation causing both dizziness (vertigo) and hearing loss, vestibular neuronitis, an infection of the vestibular nerve, generally viral, causing vertigo, and cochlear neuronitis, an infection of the cochlear nerve, generally viral, causing sudden deafness but no vertigo.
  • Recipients of cochlear implants for hearing loss are at an increased risk of pneumococcal meningitis and its associated inflammation.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the respiratory system, including inflammation, infections, and cancer associated with the nose, trachea, and lungs.
  • respiratory system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, atopic asthma, non-atopic asthma, allergic asthma, atopic bronchial IgE-mediated asthma, bronchial asthma, essential asthma, true asthma, intrinsic asthma caused by pathophysiologic disturbances, extrinsic asthma caused by environmental factors, essential asthma of unknown or inapparent cause, non-atopic asthma, bronchitic asthma, emphysematous asthma, exercise-induced asthma, allergen induced asthma, cold air induced asthma, occupational asthma, infective asthma caused by bacterial, fungal, protozoal, or viral infection, non-allergic asthma, incipient asthma, whez infant syndrome and bronchiolytis, chronic or acute bronchoconstriction, chronic bronchitis, small airways obstruction, and emphysema.
  • obstructive or inflammatory airways diseases such as chronic eosinophilic pneumonia, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease (COPD), COPD that includes chronic bronchitis, pulmonary emphysema or dyspnea associated or not associated with COPD, COPD that is characterized by irreversible, progressive airways obstruction, and adult respiratory distress syndrome (ARDS).
  • COPD chronic obstructive pulmonary disease
  • COPD chronic obstructive pulmonary disease
  • COPD chronic obstructive pulmonary disease
  • COPD chronic obstructive pulmonary disease
  • COPD that includes chronic bronchitis, pulmonary emphysema or dyspnea associated or not associated with COPD
  • COPD that is characterized by irreversible, progressive airways obstruction, and adult respiratory distress syndrome (ARDS).
  • ARDS adult respiratory distress syndrome
  • conditions associated with pulmonary inflammation include conditions related to exacerbation of airways hyper-reactivity consequent to other drug therapy, airways disease that is associated with pulmonary hypertension, bronchitis such as acute bronchitis, acute laryngotracheal bronchitis, arachidic bronchitis, catarrhal bronchitis, croupus bronchitis, dry bronchitis, infectious asthmatic bronchitis, productive bronchitis, staphylococcus or streptococcal bronchitis and vesicular bronchitis, acute lung injury, and bronchiectasis such as cylindric bronchiectasis, sacculated bronchiectasis, fusiform bronchiectasis, capillary bronchiectasis, cystic bronchiectasis, dry bronchiectasis and follicular bronchiectasis.
  • COPD in particular refers to a group of lung diseases that block airflow and make it increasingly difficult for affected individuals to breathe normally.
  • Emphysema and chronic bronchitis are the two main conditions within the group of COPD diseases, but COPD can also refer to damage caused by chronic asthmatic bronchitis, among other conditions known in the art.
  • damage to the airways eventually interferes with the exchange of oxygen and carbon dioxide in the lungs.
  • Standard treatments focus mainly on controlling symptoms and minimizing further damage.
  • Emphysema represents one aspect of COPD.
  • Emphysema leads to inflammation within the fragile walls of the alveoli, which may destroy some of the walls and elastic fibers, allowing small airways to collapse upon exhaling, and impairing airflow out of the lungs.
  • Signs and symptoms of emphysema include, for instance, shortness of breath, especially during physical activities, wheezing, and chest tightness.
  • Chronic bronchitis represents another aspect of COPD.
  • Chronic bronchitis is characterized by an ongoing cough, and leads to inflammation and narrowing of the bronchial tubes. This condition also causes increased mucus production, which can further block the narrowed tubes.
  • Chronic bronchitis occurs mainly in smokers, and is typically defined as a cough that lasts for at least three months a year for two consecutive years. Signs and symptoms of chronic bronchitis include, for example, having to clear the throat first thing in the morning, especially for smokers, a chronic cough that produces yellowish sputum, shortness of breath in the later stages, and frequent respiratory infections.
  • COPD refers primarily to obstruction in the lungs resulting from the two above-noted chronic lung conditions. However, many individuals with COPD have both of these conditions.
  • Chronic asthmatic bronchitis represents another aspect of COPD.
  • Chronic asthmatic bronchitis is usually characterized as chronic bronchitis combined with asthma (bronchospasm). Asthma may occur when inflamed and infected secretions irritate the smooth muscles in the airways. Symptoms are similar to those of chronic bronchitis, but also include intermittent, or even daily, episodes of wheezing.
  • COPD is ultimately caused by cigarette smoke and other irritants.
  • the lung damage that leads to COPD is caused by long-term cigarette smoking.
  • other irritants may cause COPD, including cigar smoke, secondhand smoke, pipe smoke, air pollution and certain occupational fumes.
  • Gastroesophageal reflux disease (GERD) which occurs when stomach acids wash back up into the esophagus, can not only aggravate COPD, but may even cause it in some individuals.
  • COPD results from a genetic disorder that causes low levels of a protein called alpha-1-antitrypsin.
  • risk factors for COPD include exposure to tobacco smoke, occupational exposure to dusts and chemicals (long-term exposure to chemical fumes, vapors and dusts irritates and inflames the lungs), gastroesophageal reflux disease (a severe form of acid reflux—the backflow of acid and other stomach contents into the esophagus), age (COPD develops slowly over years, so most people are at least 40 years old when symptoms begin), and genetics (a rare genetic disorder known as alpha-1-antitrypsin deficiency is the source of a few cases of COPD).
  • Complications or associated symptoms of COPD may include increased risk of respiratory infections, high blood pressure, heart problems (e.g., heart attacks, arrhythmias, cor pulmonale), lung cancer (smokers with chronic bronchitis are at a higher risk of developing lung cancer than are smokers who don't have chronic bronchitis), pneumonia, pneumothorax, and depression, among others known in the art.
  • Further examples include cough that produces mucus and may be streaked with blood, fatigue, frequent respiratory infections, headaches, shortness of breath (dyspnea) that worsens with mild activity, swelling of the ankles, feet, or legs, which affects both sides of the body, and wheezing.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to reduce or manage the complications or symptoms associated with COPD or other pulmonary conditions related to inflammation.
  • Subjects with COPD may be identified according to routine diagnostic techniques known in the art. For instance, pulmonary function tests, such as spirometry, measure how much air the lungs can hold and how fast an individual can blow the air out of their lungs. Spirometry can detect COPD before the appearance of symptoms, and can also be used to track disease progression and monitor treatment. In addition, chest X-rays show emphysema, one of the main causes of COPD, and may also rule out other lung problems or heart failure. In addition, arterial blood gas analysis measures how effectively the lungs bring oxygen into the blood and remove carbon dioxide, providing an indication of COPD.
  • pulmonary function tests such as spirometry
  • Spirometry can detect COPD before the appearance of symptoms, and can also be used to track disease progression and monitor treatment.
  • chest X-rays show emphysema, one of the main causes of COPD, and may also rule out other lung problems or heart failure.
  • arterial blood gas analysis measures how effectively the lungs bring oxygen into the blood and
  • Sputum examination i.e., the analysis of the cells in the sputum, can identify the cause of certain lung problems and help rule out certain lung cancers.
  • CT computerized tomography
  • the amount of NHR-targeted antisense or RNAi agent administered to a subject with COPD will depend on the characteristics of that subject, such as general health, age, sex, body weight, and tolerance to drugs, as well as the degree, severity, and type of reaction to the agent. For instance, multiple administrations may be utilized (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, etc), typically at a defined frequency (number of administrations per day, per week, per month, etc).
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents can be utilized in combination with other treatments for pulmonary inflammation or COPD.
  • treatments included, without limitation, lifestyle changes, such as quitting or reducing smoking or other exposure to lung irritants, lung rehabilitation, the use of bronchodilators (e.g., ipratropium, tiotropium, salmeterol, formoterol), steroids such as corticosteroids, antibiotics, metered-dose inhalers (MDIs) and dry powder inhalers (DPIs), nebulizers, replacement gene therapy for alpha-1-antitrypsin deficiency, oxygen therapy, and surgery, including bullectomy, lung volume reduction surgery, and lung transplant.
  • bronchodilators e.g., ipratropium, tiotropium, salmeterol, formoterol
  • steroids such as corticosteroids
  • antibiotics metered-dose inhalers (MDIs) and dry powder inhalers (DPIs)
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated the gastrointestinal system, including inflammation, infections, and cancer associated with the mouth, esophagus, stomach, small intestines, large intestines, and rectum.
  • Gastrointestinal inflammation refers to inflammation of a mucosal layer of the gastrointestinal tract, and encompasses acute and chronic inflammatory conditions. Acute inflammation is generally characterized by a short time of onset and infiltration or influx of neutrophils. Chronic inflammation is generally characterized by a relatively longer period of onset and infiltration or influx of mononuclear cells. Chronic inflammation can also typically characterized by periods of spontaneous remission and spontaneous occurrence.
  • “Mucosal layer of the gastrointestinal tract” is meant to include mucosa of the bowel (including the small intestine and large intestine), rectum, stomach (gastric) lining, oral cavity, and the like.
  • Chronic gastrointestinal inflammation refers to inflammation of the mucosal of the gastrointestinal tract that is characterized by a relatively longer period of onset, is long-lasting (e.g., from several days, weeks, months, or years and up to the life of the subject), and is often associated with infiltration or influx of mononuclear cells, and can be further associated with periods of spontaneous remission and spontaneous occurrence.
  • Chronic gastrointestinal inflammatory conditions (also referred to as “chronic gastrointestinal inflammatory diseases”) having such chronic inflammation include, but are not limited to, inflammatory bowel disease (IBD), colitis induced by environmental insults (e.g., gastrointestinal inflammation associated with a therapeutic regimen, such as chemotherapy, radiation therapy, and the like), colitis in conditions such as chronic granulomatous disease (see, e.g., Schappi et al., Arch Dis Child.
  • IBD inflammatory bowel disease
  • colitis induced by environmental insults e.g., gastrointestinal inflammation associated with a therapeutic regimen, such as chemotherapy, radiation therapy, and the like
  • colitis in conditions such as chronic granulomatous disease (see, e.g., Schappi et al., Arch Dis Child.
  • celiac disease i.e., a heritable disease in which the intestinal lining is inflamed in response to the ingestion of a protein known as gluten
  • celiac sprue i.e., a heritable disease in which the intestinal lining is inflamed in response to the ingestion of a protein known as gluten
  • food allergies gastritis, infectious gastritis or enterocolitis (e.g., Helicobacter pylori -infected chronic active gastritis) and other forms of gastrointestinal inflammation caused by an infectious agent, and other like conditions.
  • IBD inflammatory bowel disease
  • inflammatory bowel disease refers to any of a variety of diseases characterized by inflammation of all or part of the intestines.
  • Examples of inflammatory bowel disease include, but are not limited to, Crohn's disease and ulcerative colitis.
  • the term IBD includes pseudomembranous colitis, hemorrhagic colitis, hemolytic-uremic syndrome colitis, collagenous colitis, ischemic colitis, radiation colitis, drug and chemically induced colitis, diversion colitis, ulcerative colitis, irritable bowel syndrome, irritable colon syndrome and Crohn's disease; and within Crohn's disease all the subtypes including active, refractory, and fistulizing and Crohn's disease.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be employed to treat or manage any one or more of these conditions.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the vascular system, or vascular inflammation, such as inflammation associated with the blood vessels and the heart.
  • vascular system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, myocarditis, pericarditis, occlusive disease, atherosclerosis, myocardial infarction, thrombosis, Wegener's granulomatosis, Takayasu's arteritis, Kawasaki syndrome, anti-factor VIII autoimmune disease, necrotizing small vessel vasculitis, microscopic polyangiitis, Churg and Strauss syndrome, pauci-immune focal necrotizing glomerulonephritis, crescentic glomerulonephritis, antiphospholipid syndrome, antibody induced heart failure, thrombocytopenic purpura, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, cardiac autoimmunity in Chagas' disease, and anti-helper T lymphocyte autoimmunity.
  • thrombophlebitis may occur repeatedly in different locations, and is then referred to as thrombophlebitis migrans, or migrating thrombophlebitis.
  • Phlebitis may associate with a variety of causes, such as bacterial infection, exposure to chemical agents, such as irritating or vesicant solutions, physical trauma from skin puncture such as movement of a cannula into the vein during insertion, medications such as Celebrex, Olanzepine, antidepressants, and others, and alcohol abuse. Certain embodiments may relate to treating or managing heart inflammation caused by any one or more of acute rheumatic fever, congenital toxoplasmosis, enterovirus antenatal infection, lyme disease, and rheumatic fever.
  • liver or gallbladder associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, auto-immune hepatitis, viral hepatitis (e.g., Hepatitis A virus, Hepatitis B virus, Hepatitis C virus, Hepatitis D virus, Hepatitis E virus, mononucleosis, rubella, Epstein-Barr virus, and cytomegalovirus), other causes of hepatitis such as severe bacterial infection, ameobic infections, medicines (e.g., agomelatine, allopurinol, amitryptyline, amiodarone, asathioprine, paracetamol, halothane, ibuprofen, indomethacin, isoniazid, rifampicin, pyrazinamide, ketoconazole, lorata
  • auto-immune hepatitis e.g., Hepatitis A virus, Hepatitis B virus, Hepatitis C virus, Hepatit
  • lymphatic/immune system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, auto-immune diseases, such as Chagas disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disorder (COPD), Crohn's disease, dermatomyositis, diabetes mellitus type I, endometriosis, Goodpasture's syndrome, Graves' disease, Guillain-Barre syndrome, Hachimoto's disease, hidradenitis suppurativa, Kawasaki disease, IgA nephropathy, idiopathic thrombocytopenia purpura, interstitial cystitis, lupus erythematosus, mixed connective tissue disease, morphea, myasthenia gravis, narcolepsy, neuromyotonia, pemphigus vulgaris , pernicous anemia, psoriasis, psoriatic arthritis, poliomyos
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents can be administered to a transplant donor before or during tissue removal.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents can be administered to a transplant recipient before, during, and/or after transplant therapy to reduce inflammation-related complications of transplant therapy.
  • transplant therapies include bone marrow, stem cell, peripheral blood, liver, lung, heart, skin, and kidney, among others known in the art.
  • Additional examples include inflammatory conditions associated with allergies, such as asthma, hives, urticaria, pollen allergy, dust mite allergy, venom allergy, cosmetics allergy, latex allergy, chemical allergy, drug allergy, insect bite allergy, animal dander allergy, stinging plant allergy, poison ivy allergy and food allergy.
  • allergies such as asthma, hives, urticaria, pollen allergy, dust mite allergy, venom allergy, cosmetics allergy, latex allergy, chemical allergy, drug allergy, insect bite allergy, animal dander allergy, stinging plant allergy, poison ivy allergy and food allergy.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the uro-genital system.
  • uro-genital system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, inflammations, infections or cancers of the ureter, bladder, urethra, cervix, Fallopian tubes, ovaries, uterus, womb, vulva, prostate, bulbourethral glands, epidiymis, prostate, seminal vesicles, testicles, or kidneys.
  • kidney abscess intrarenal or extrarenal
  • acute prostatitis hematuria
  • urethritis e.g., Chlamydia and other sexually transmitted diseases
  • pelvic inflammatory disease PID
  • prostatic abscess are also included.
  • nephritis associated with one or more of glomerulonephritis, lupus nephritis, nephropathy, gout, poisons or chemicals (e.g., ether, thallium sulfate), certain medications (e.g., piroxicam, candyl, feldene gel, fensaid, pirox), Herrmann syndrome, yellow fever, immune complex diseases, typhoid fever, urethral stricture, renal tuberculosism, and post-streptococcal glomerulonephritis.
  • piroxicam e.g., piroxicam, candyl, feldene gel, fensaid, pirox
  • Herrmann syndrome yellow fever, immune complex diseases, typhoid fever, urethral stricture, renal tuberculosism, and post-streptococcal glomerulonephritis.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the musculoskeletal system.
  • musculoskeletal system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, arthritis such as rheumatoid arthritis and psoriatic arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, auto-immune myositis, primary Sjogren's syndrome, smooth muscle auto-immune disease, myositis, polymyositis, tendinitis, ligament inflammation, cartilage inflammation, joint inflammation, synovial inflammation, carpal tunnel syndrome, chronic muscle inflammation, and bone inflammation, including bone inflammation associated with osteoporosis and osteoarthritis.
  • Tietze's syndrome a benign, painful, nonsuppurative localized swelling of the costosternal, sternoclavicular, or costochondral joints, costochondritis, sternalis syndrome, xiphoidalgia, spontaneous sternoclavicular subluxation, sternocostoclavicular hyperostosis, fibromyalgia, shoulder tendinitis or bursitis, gouty arthritis, polymyalgia rheumatica, lupus erythematosus, bone spurs, and fractures such as stress fractures.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the endocrine system.
  • endocrine system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, inflammation, infection, or cancer associated with the hypothalamus, pituitary, thyroid, pancreas, or adrenal glands, glandular diseases such as pancreatic disease, diabetes such as Type I diabetes, thyroid disease, Graves' disease, thyroiditis, spontaneous autoimmune thyroiditis, Hashimoto's thyroiditis, idiopathic myxedema, ovarian autoimmunity, autoimmune anti-sperm infertility, autoimmune prostatitis and Type I autoimmune polyglandular syndrome.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with adipose tissues, an active participant in regulating physiologic and pathologic processes, including immunity and inflammation.
  • Macrophages are components of adipose tissue and actively participate in its activities. Furthermore, cross-talk between lymphocytes and adipocytes can lead to immune regulation.
  • Adipose tissue produces and releases a variety of pro-inflammatory and anti-inflammatory factors, including the adipokines leptin, adiponectin, resistin, and visfatin, as well as cytokines and chemokines, such as TNF-alpha, IL-6, monocyte chemoattractant protein 1, and others.
  • Proinflammatory molecules produced by adipose tissue have been implicated as active participants in the development of insulin resistance and the increased risk of cardiovascular disease associated with obesity.
  • reduced leptin levels may predispose to increased susceptibility to infection caused by reduced T-cell responses in malnourished individuals.
  • Altered adipokine levels have been observed in a variety of inflammatory conditions (see, e.g., Fantuzzi, J Allergy Clin Immunol. 115:911-19, 2005; and Berg et al., Circulation Research. 96:939, 2005).
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be employed to treat or manage inflammation associated with hypersensitivity.
  • examples of such conditions include type I hypersensitivity, type II hypersensitivity, type III hypersensitivity, type IV hypersensitivity, immediate hypersensitivity, antibody mediated hypersensitivity, immune complex mediated hypersensitivity, T-lymphocyte mediated hypersensitivity, and delayed type hypersensitivity.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be employed to treat or manage auto-inflammatory conditions.
  • auto-inflammatory conditions include familial Mediterranean fever, TNF receptor associated periodic syndrome (TRAPS), Hyper-IgD syndrome (HIDS), CIAS1-related diseases such as Muckle-Wells syndrome, familial cold auto-inflammatory syndrome, and neonatal onset multisystem inflammatory disease, PAPA syndrome (pyogenic sterile arthritis, pyoderma gangrenosum, acne), and Blau syndrome.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be employed to treat or manage inflammation associated with a variety of cancers.
  • cancers include, without limitation, prostate cancer, breast cancer, colon cancer, rectal cancer, lung cancer, ovarian cancer, testicular cancer, stomach cancer, bladder cancer, pancreatic cancer, liver cancer, kidney cancer, brain cancer, melanoma, non-melanoma skin cancer, bone cancer, lymphoma, leukemia, thyroid cancer, endometrial cancer, multiple myeloma, acute myeloid leukemia, neuroblastoma, glioblastoma, and non-Hodgkin's lymphoma.
  • systemic inflammation may by associated with systemic inflammatory response syndrome (SIRS), a whole-body inflammatory condition with a variety of potential causes.
  • SIRS may be characterized or identified according to routine diagnostic techniques. As one non-limiting example, SIRS may be identified by the presence of two or more of the following: (i) a body temperature that is less than 36° C.
  • a heart rate that is greater than 90 beats per minute, (iii) tachypnea (high respiratory rate), with greater than 20 breaths per minute; or, an arterial partial pressure of carbon dioxide less than 4.3 kPa (32 mmHg), and (iv) white blood cell count less than 4000 cells/mm 3 (4 ⁇ 10 9 cells/L) or greater than 12,000 cells/mm 3 (12 ⁇ 10 9 cells/L); or the presence of greater than 10% immature neutrophils (band forms).
  • SIRS is broadly classified as either infectious or non-infectious. Most generally, infectious SIRS is associated with sepsis, a whole-body inflammatory state combined with a known or suspected infection, which includes bacteremia, viremia, parasitemia, and toxic shock syndrome. Sepsis may be associated with a wide variety of infectious agents, including, without limitation, bacteria such as Streptococcus agalactiae, Escherichia coli, Haemophilus influenzae, Listeria monocytogenes , Coagulase-negative Staphylococcus, Staphylococcus aureus, Klebsiella species, Pseudomonas aeruginosa, Enterobacter species, S.
  • bacteria such as Streptococcus agalactiae, Escherichia coli, Haemophilus influenzae, Listeria monocytogenes , Coagulase-negative Staphylococcus, Staphylococcus aureus, Klebsiella species, Ps
  • agalactiae Serratia species, Acinetobacter species, Streptococcus pneumoniae, Salmonella species, and Neisseria meningitidis ; viruses such as rubella, cytomegalovirus, herpes simplex and the chickenpox virus; parasites such as in malarial infection (e.g., Plasmodium falciparum ), trypanosomiasis, and filariasis; and fungi such as Candida species, Aspergillus species, Histoplasma species, Cryptococcus neoformans, Coccidioides immitis, Blastomyces dermatitidis , and Pneumocystis carinii .
  • viruses such as rubella, cytomegalovirus, herpes simplex and the chickenpox virus
  • parasites such as in malarial infection (e.g., Plasmodium falciparum ), trypanosomiasis, and filariasis
  • fungi such as Candida species,
  • infections in the lungs e.g., pneumonia
  • bladder and kidneys e.g., urinary tract infections
  • skin e.g., cellulitis
  • abdomen e.g., appendicitis
  • other areas e.g., meningitis
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to modulate inflammation associated with any of these infectious agents, whether sepsis is present or otherwise.
  • Noninfectious SIRS may be associated with trauma, burns, pancreatitis, ischemia, hemorrhage, surgical complications, adrenal insufficiency, pulmonary embolism, aortic aneurysm, cardiac tamponade, anaphylaxis, and drug overdose, among others.
  • SIRS is often complicated by the failure of one or more organs or organ system, including those described herein. Specific examples include acute lung injury, acute kidney injury, shock, and multiple organ dysfunction syndrome, among others.
  • SIRS is treated by focusing on the underlying problem (e.g., adequate fluid replacement for hypovolemia, IVF/NPO for pancreatitis, epinephrine/steroids/benadryl for anaphylaxis).
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to treat or manage SIRS and the complications of SIRS, alone or in combination with other therapies.
  • cytokine storm a dangerous immune reaction caused by a positive feedback loop between cytokines and immune cells, resulting in highly elevated levels of various cytokines.
  • cytokine storm hypercytokinemia
  • cytokine storm includes the systemic release of numerous known inflammatory mediators such as cytokines, oxygen free radicals, and coagulation factors). Included are elevated levels of pro-inflammatory cytokines such as TNF-alpha, IL-1, and IL-6, and anti-inflammatory cytokines such as IL-10 and IL-1 receptor antagonist.
  • Cytokine storms can occur in a number of infectious and non-infectious diseases including graft versus host disease (GVHD), acute respiratory distress syndrome (ARDS), sepsis, avian influenza, smallpox, and SIRS. Cytokine storm may also be induced by certain medications. Treatment includes OX40 IG, which reduces T-cell responses, ACE inhibitors, Angiotensin II receptor blockers, corticosteroids, gemfibrozil, free radical scavengers, and TNF- ⁇ blockers. Accordingly, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be employed to treat or manage cytokine storm, alone or in combination with other therapies.
  • GVHD graft versus host disease
  • ARDS acute respiratory distress syndrome
  • Sepsis avian influenza
  • smallpox smallpox
  • SIRS smallpox
  • Treatment includes OX40 IG, which reduces T-cell responses, ACE inhibitors, Angiotensin II receptor blockers, cor
  • Certain embodiments may employ NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents to reduce any one or more of granulomatous inflammation, fibrinous inflammation, purulent inflammation, serous inflammation, or ulcerative inflammation.
  • Granulomatous inflammation is characterized by the formation of granulomas, typically resulting from a response to infectious agents such as tuberculosis, leprosy, and syphilis.
  • Fibrinous inflammation results from a large increase in vascular permeability, which allows fibrin to pass through the blood vessels. If an appropriate pro-coagulative stimulus is present, such as a cancer cell, a fibrinous exudate is deposited.
  • Serous inflammation is characterized by the copious effusion of non-viscous serous fluid, commonly produced by mesothelial cells of serous membranes, but may also be derived from blood plasma. Examples of this type of inflammation include skin blisters. Ulcerative inflammation, which typically occurs near an epithelium, results in the necrotic loss of tissue from the surface, thereby exposing lower layers of tissue. The subsequent excavation of the epithelium is known as an ulcer.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be employed in the treatment of physical injuries or wounds. Examples include abrasions, bruises, cuts, puncture wounds, lacerations, impact wounds, concussions, contusions, thermal burns, frostbite, chemical burns, sunburns, gangrene, necrosis, desiccations, radiation burns, radioactivity burns, smoke inhalation, torn muscles, pulled muscles, torn tendons, pulled tendons, pulled ligaments, torn ligaments, hyperextensions, torn cartilage, bone fractures, pinched nerves, ulcers, and gunshot or other traumatic wounds.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be employed to treat or manage idiopathic inflammation or inflammation of unknown etiology. Also included are combination therapies, in which one or more NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents are administered or utilized in combination with one or more other therapies for any of the inflammatory diseases or conditions described herein, including those therapies that are commonly available and known in the art.
  • combination therapies include the use of standard anti-inflammatory agents such as non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs (NSAIDs), immune selective anti-inflammatory derivatives (ImSAIDs), and steroids (e.g., corticosteroids), anti-infectives such as antibiotics and anti-viral agents, anti-oxidants, cytokines, chemotherapeutic agents and other anti-cancer therapies, and immunosuppressive therapies.
  • NSAIDs non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs
  • ImSAIDs immune selective anti-inflammatory derivatives
  • steroids e.g., corticosteroids
  • anti-infectives such as antibiotics and anti-viral agents, anti-oxidants, cytokines, chemotherapeutic agents and other anti-cancer therapies
  • immunosuppressive therapies include the use of standard anti-inflammatory agents such as non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs (NSAIDs), immune selective anti-inflammatory derivatives (ImSAIDs), and steroids (e.g., corticosteroids), anti-infectives such as antibiotics and anti
  • Criteria for assessing the signs and symptoms of inflammatory and other conditions including for purposes of making differential diagnosis and also for monitoring treatments such as determining whether a therapeutically effective dose has been administered in the course of treatment, e.g., by determining improvement according to accepted clinical criteria, will be apparent to those skilled in the art and are exemplified by the teachings of e.g., Berkow et al., eds., The Merck Manual, 16 th edition, Merck and Co., Rahway, N.J., 1992; Goodman et al., eds., Goodman and Gilman's The Pharmacological Basis of Therapeutics, 10 th edition, Pergamon Press, Inc., Elmsford, N.Y., (2001); Avery's Drug Treatment: Principles and Practice of Clinical Pharmacology and Therapeutics, 3rd edition, ADIS Press, Ltd., Williams and Wilkins, Baltimore, Md.
  • Certain embodiments may employ NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents to increase inflammation. For instance, depending on the needs of the subject, certain embodiments may increase acute inflammation or increase acute inflammatory responses or both. Certain embodiments may increase chronic inflammation or chronic inflammatory responses or both. Certain embodiments may increase both acute and chronic inflammation. Certain embodiments may increase local or systemic inflammation or both.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to treat or manage immunodeficiencies, including primary immunodeficiencies and secondary immunodeficiencies, in which the body may not mount an adequate inflammatory response.
  • primary immunodeficiencies include various autosomal recessive and X-linked genetic conditions such as T-cell and B-cell immunodeficiencies, including combined T-cell and B-cell immunodeficiencies, antibody deficiencies, well-defined syndromes, immune dysregulation diseases, phagocyte disorders, innate immunity disorders, and complement deficiencies.
  • T-cell and B-cell immunodeficiencies include T ⁇ /B+ deficiencies such as ⁇ c deficiency, JAK3 deficiency, interleukin 7 receptor chain a deficiency, CD45 deficiency, CD3 ⁇ /CD3 ⁇ deficiency; and T ⁇ /B ⁇ deficiencies such as RAG 1/2 deficiency, DCLRE1C deficiency, adenosine deaminase (ADA) deficiency, reticular dysgenesis.
  • T ⁇ /B+ deficiencies such as ⁇ c deficiency, JAK3 deficiency, interleukin 7 receptor chain a deficiency, CD45 deficiency, CD3 ⁇ /CD3 ⁇ deficiency
  • T ⁇ /B ⁇ deficiencies such as RAG 1/2 deficiency, DCLRE1C deficiency, adenosine deaminase (ADA) deficiency, reticular dysgenesis.
  • Additional examples include Omenn syndrome, DNA ligase type IV deficiency, CD40 ligand deficiency, CD40 deficiency, purine nucleoside phosphorylase (PNP) deficiency, MHC class II deficiency, CD3 ⁇ deficiency, CD8 deficiency, ZAP-70 deficiency, TAP-1/2 deficiency, and winged helix deficiency.
  • PNP purine nucleoside phosphorylase
  • antibody deficiencies include X-linked agammaglobulinemia (btk deficiency, or Bruton's agammaglobulinemia), ⁇ -Heavy chain deficiency, 1-5 deficiency, Ig ⁇ deficiency, BLNK deficiency, thymoma with immunodeficiency, common variable immunodeficiency (CVID), ICOS deficiency, CD19 deficiency, TACI (TNFRSF13B) deficiency, and BAFF receptor deficiency.
  • btk deficiency or Bruton's agammaglobulinemia
  • ⁇ -Heavy chain deficiency 1-5 deficiency
  • Ig ⁇ deficiency BLNK deficiency
  • thymoma with immunodeficiency common variable immunodeficiency (CVID)
  • CVID common variable immunodeficiency
  • ICOS deficiency CD19 deficiency
  • TACI
  • Additional examples include AID deficiency, UNG deficiency, heavy chain deletions, kappa chain deficiency, isolated IgG subclass deficiency, IgA with IgG subclass deficiency, selective immunoglobulin A deficiency, and transient hypogammaglobulinemia of infancy (THI).
  • Examples of “well-defined syndromes” include Wiskott-Aldrich syndrome, ataxia telangiectasia, ataxia-like syndrome, Nijmegen breakage syndrome, Bloom syndrome, DiGeorge syndrome, immuno-osseous dysplasias such as cartilage-hair hypoplasia, Schimke syndrome, Hermansky-Pudlak syndrome type 2, Hyper-IgE syndrome, chronic mucocutaneous candidiasis.
  • immune dysregulation diseases include immunodeficiency with hypopigmentation or albinism such as Chediak-Higashi syndrome and Griscelli syndrome type 2, familial hemophagocytic lymphohistiocytosis such as perforin deficiency, MUNC13D deficiency, and syntaxin 11 deficiency, X-linked lymphoproliferative syndrome, autoimmune lymphoproliferative syndrome such as type 1a (CD95 defects), type 1b (Fas ligand defects), type 2a (CASP10 defects), and type 2b (CASP8 defects), autoimmune polyendocrinopathy with candidiasis and ectodermal dystrophy, and immunodysregulation polyendocrinopathy enteropathy X-linked syndrome.
  • immunodeficiency with hypopigmentation or albinism such as Chediak-Higashi syndrome and Griscelli syndrome type 2
  • familial hemophagocytic lymphohistiocytosis such as perforin deficiency
  • leukopenia diseases affecting the bone marrow may result in abnormal or few leukocytes, such as leukopenia.
  • Leukopenia can be induced by certain infections and diseases, including viral infection, Rickettsia infection, some protozoa, tuberculosis, and certain cancers
  • phagocyte disorders include severe congenital neutropenia such as ELA2 deficiency (e.g., with myelodysplasia), GFI1 deficiency (with T/B lymphopenia) or G-CSFR deficiency (G-CSF-unresponsive), Kostmann syndrome, cyclic neutropenia, X-linked neutropenia/myelodysplasia, leukocyte adhesion deficiency types 1, 2 and 3, RAC2 deficiency, 0-actin deficiency, localized juvenile periodontitis, Papillon-Lefsky syndrome, specific granule deficiency, Shwachman-Diamond syndrome, chronic granulomatous disease, including X-linked and autosomal forms, neutrophil glucose-6-phosphate dehydrogenase deficiency, IL-12 and IL-23 ⁇ 1 chain deficiency, IL-12p40 deficiency, interferon ⁇ receptor 1 deficiency, interferon ⁇
  • innate immunity deficiencies include hypohidrotic ectodermal dysplasia such as NEMO deficiency and IKBA deficiency, IRAK-4 deficiency, WHIM syndrome (warts, hypogammaglobulinaemia, infections, myleokathexis), and epidermodysplasia verruciformis.
  • hypohidrotic ectodermal dysplasia such as NEMO deficiency and IKBA deficiency, IRAK-4 deficiency, WHIM syndrome (warts, hypogammaglobulinaemia, infections, myleokathexis), and epidermodysplasia verruciformis.
  • complement deficiencies and exemplary associated conditions include C1q deficiency (e.g., lupus-like syndrome, rheumatoid disease, infections), C1r deficiency, C4 deficiency, C2 deficiency (e.g., lupus-like syndrome, vasculitis, polymyositis, pyogenic infections), C3 deficiency (e.g., recurrent pyogenic infections), C5 deficiency (e.g., neisserial infections), C6 deficiency, C7 deficiency (e.g., vasculitis), C8a and C8b deficiency, C9 deficiency (e.g., neisserial infections), C1-inhibitor deficiency (e.g., hereditary angioedema), Factor I deficiency (pyogenic infections), Factor H deficiency (e.g., haemolytic-uraemic syndrome, me
  • Exemplary diagnostic tests include, without limitation, performing counts of the different types of mononuclear cells in the blood (e.g., lymphocytes and monocytes, including lymphocytes, different groups of B lymphocytes such as CD19+, CD20+, and CD21+ lymphocytes, natural killer cells, and monocytes positive for CD15+), measuring the presence of activation markers (e.g., HLA-DR, CD25, CD80), performing tests for T cell function such as skin tests for delayed-type hypersensitivity, cell responses to mitogens and allogeneic cells, cytokine production by cells, performing tests for B cell function such as by identifying antibodies to routine immunizations and commonly acquired infections and by quantifying IgG subclasses, and performing tests or phagocyte function, such as by measuring the reduction of nitro blue tetrazolium chloride, and performing assays of chemotaxis and bactericidal activity.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents include, without limitation, performing counts of the different types
  • causes of secondary immunodeficiencies include malnutrition, aging, and medications (e.g., chemotherapy, disease-modifying anti-rheumatic drugs, immunosuppressive drugs after organ transplants, glucocorticoids).
  • Additional causes include various cancers, including cancers of the bone marrow and blood cells (e.g., leukemia, lymphoma, multiple myeloma), and certain chronic infections, such as acquired immunodeficiency syndrome (AIDS), caused by the human immunodeficiency virus (HIV).
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to stimulate or maintain acute inflammation or acute inflammatory responses in subjects with an immunodeficiency, as described herein and known in the art.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be used to stimulate or maintain chronic inflammation or chronic inflammatory responses in subjects with a secondary immunodeficiency, as described herein and known in the art.
  • certain embodiments include methods of treating metabolic diseases, whether due to activity or insufficient activity of a given NHR, such as GR.
  • a given NHR such as GR.
  • conditions associated with excessive (e.g., chronic, acute) GR or glucocorticoid activation include diabetes (e.g., insulin resistance), hypertension, osteoporosis, reduced cognitive function, and glaucoma.
  • conditions associated with GR or glucocorticoid deficiencies include Addison's disease, familial glucocorticoid deficiency, chronic glucocorticoid deficiency, acute glucocorticoid defiency, and their associated symptoms, such as hypoglycemia, hyperpigmentation, muscle weakness, seizures, and failure to thrive.
  • metabolic diseases include adrenoleukodystrophy, Krabbe's disease (globoid cell leukodystrophy), metachromatic leukodystrophy, Alexander's disease, Canavan's disease (spongiform leukodystrophy), Pelizaeus-Merzbacher disease, Cockayne's syndrome, Hurler's disease, Lowe's syndrome, Leigh's disease, Wilson's disease, Hallervorden-Spatz disease, Tay-Sachs disease, etc.
  • Krabbe's disease globoid cell leukodystrophy
  • metachromatic leukodystrophy Alexander's disease
  • Canavan's disease spongiform leukodystrophy
  • Pelizaeus-Merzbacher disease Cockayne's syndrome
  • Hurler's disease Lowe's syndrome
  • Leigh's disease Wilson's disease
  • Hallervorden-Spatz disease Tay-Sachs disease, etc.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents of the invention in modulating metabolic processes may be monitored using any of a variety of techniques known and available in the art including, for example, assays which measure adipocyte lipogenesis or adipocyte lipolysis.
  • Certain embodiments include modulation of NHRs such as GR for the treatment of auto-immune conditions.
  • auto-immune conditions include but are not limited to, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, autoimmune neonatal thrombocytopenia, idiopathic thrombocytopenia purpura, autoimmunocytopenia, hemolytic anemia, antiphospholipid syndrome, dermatitis, allergic encephalomyelitis, myocarditis, relapsing polychondritis, rheumatic heart disease, glomerulonephritis (for example, IgA nephropathy), multiple sclerosis, neuritis, uveitis ophthalmia, polyendocrinopathies, purpura (for example, Henloch-Scoenlein purpura), Reiter's disease, stiff-man syndrome, autoimmune pulmonary inflammation, Guillain-Barre Syndrome, insulin dependent diabetes mellitus, and autoimmune inflammatory eye disease.
  • autoimmune thyroiditis includes Hashimoto's thyroiditis and thyroiditis characterized, for example, by cell-mediated and humoral thyroid cytotoxicity; SLE (which is often characterized, for example, by circulating and locally generated immune complexes); Goodpasture's syndrome (which is often characterized, for example, by anti-basement membrane antibodies); pemphigus (which is often characterized, for example, by epidermal acantholytic antibodies); receptor autoimmunities such as, for example, Graves' disease (which is often characterized, for example, by antibodies to a thyroid stimulating hormone receptor; myasthenia gravis, which is often characterized, for example, by acetylcholine receptor antibodies); insulin resistance (which is often characterized, for example, by insulin receptor antibodies); autoimmune hemolytic anemia (which is often characterized, for example, by phagocytosis of antibody-sensitized red blood cells); and autoimmune thrombo
  • RNAi agents include non-alcoholic steatohepatitis (e.g., targeting TR), diabetes (e.g., targeting PPAR), conditions associated with calcium reabsorption and mobilization (e.g., targeting VDR), cancer (e.g., targeting ER and/or ERR), birth control/pregnancy related issues (e.g., targeting PR), and conditions associated with hormone regulation such as low testosterone (e.g., targeting AR), among others.
  • non-alcoholic steatohepatitis e.g., targeting TR
  • diabetes e.g., targeting PPAR
  • conditions associated with calcium reabsorption and mobilization e.g., targeting VDR
  • cancer e.g., targeting ER and/or ERR
  • birth control/pregnancy related issues e.g., targeting PR
  • hormone regulation such as low testosterone (e.g., targeting AR), among others.
  • An effective in vivo treatment regimen using the antisense oligonucleotides or RNAi agents of the invention may vary according to the duration, dose, frequency and route of administration, as well as the condition of the subject under treatment (i.e., prophylactic administration versus administration in response to an existing condition). Accordingly, such in vivo therapy will often require monitoring by tests appropriate to the particular type of viral infection under treatment, and corresponding adjustments in the dose or treatment regimen, in order to achieve an optimal therapeutic outcome. In certain embodiments, treatment may be monitored, e.g., by general indicators of inflammation.
  • the present invention provides formulations or compositions suitable for the therapeutic delivery of antisense oligomers or other agents such as RNAi agents, as described herein.
  • the present invention provides pharmaceutically acceptable compositions that comprise a therapeutically-effective amount of one or more of the oligomers or agents described herein, formulated together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers (additives) and/or diluents. While it is possible for an oligomer of the present invention to be administered alone, it is preferable to administer the compound as a pharmaceutical formulation (composition).
  • nucleic acid molecules Methods for the delivery of nucleic acid molecules are described, for example, in Akhtar et al., 1992, Trends Cell Bio., 2:139; and Delivery Strategies for Antisense Oligonucleotide Therapeutics , ed. Akhtar; Sullivan et al., PCT WO 94/02595. These and other protocols can be utilized for the delivery of virtually any nucleic acid molecule, including the isolated oligomers of the present invention.
  • compositions of the present invention may be specially formulated for administration in solid or liquid form, including those adapted for the following: (1) oral administration, for example, drenches (aqueous or non-aqueous solutions or suspensions), tablets, e.g., those targeted for buccal, sublingual, and systemic absorption, boluses, powders, granules, pastes for application to the tongue; (2) parenteral administration, for example, by subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or epidural injection as, for example, a sterile solution or suspension, or sustained-release formulation; (3) topical application, for example, as a cream, ointment, or a controlled-release patch or spray applied to the skin; (4) intravaginally or intrarectally, for example, as a pessary, cream or foam; (5) sublingually; (6) ocularly; (7) transdermally; or (8) nasally.
  • oral administration for example, drenches (aqueous or non-aqueous solutions or suspensions), tablets
  • phrases “pharmaceutically acceptable” is employed herein to refer to those compounds, materials, compositions, and/or dosage forms which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of human beings and animals without excessive toxicity, irritation, allergic response, or other problem or complication, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable carrier means a pharmaceutically-acceptable material, composition or vehicle, such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, manufacturing aid (e.g., lubricant, talc magnesium, calcium or zinc stearate, or steric acid), or solvent encapsulating material, involved in carrying or transporting the subject compound from one organ, or portion of the body, to another organ, or portion of the body.
  • a pharmaceutically-acceptable material such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, manufacturing aid (e.g., lubricant, talc magnesium, calcium or zinc stearate, or steric acid), or solvent encapsulating material, involved in carrying or transporting the subject compound from one organ, or portion of the body, to another organ, or portion of the body.
  • manufacturing aid e.g., lubricant, talc magnesium, calcium or zinc stearate, or steric acid
  • solvent encapsulating material involved in carrying or transporting the
  • materials that can serve as pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers include, without limitation: (1) sugars, such as lactose, glucose and sucrose; (2) starches, such as corn starch and potato starch; (3) cellulose, and its derivatives, such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; (4) powdered tragacanth; (5) malt; (6) gelatin; (7) talc; (8) excipients, such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; (9) oils, such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; (10) glycols, such as propylene glycol; (11) polyols, such as glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; (12) esters, such as ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; (13) agar; (14) buffering agents, such as magnesium hydroxide and
  • agents suitable for formulation with the antisense oligomers of the instant invention include: PEG conjugated nucleic acids, phospholipid conjugated nucleic acids, nucleic acids containing lipophilic moieties, phosphorothioates, P-glycoprotein inhibitors (such as Pluronic P85) which can enhance entry of drugs into various tissues; biodegradable polymers, such as poly (DL-lactide-coglycolide) microspheres for sustained release delivery after implantation (Emerich, D F et al., 1999 , Cell Transplant, 8, 47-58) Alkermes, Inc.
  • nanoparticles such as those made of polybutylcyanoacrylate, which can deliver drugs across the blood brain barrier and can alter neuronal uptake mechanisms ( Prog Neuropsychopharmacol Biol Psychiatry, 23, 941-949, 1999).
  • the invention also features the use of the composition comprising surface-modified liposomes containing poly (ethylene glycol) lipids (PEG-modified, branched and unbranched or combinations thereof, or long-circulating liposomes or stealth liposomes).
  • Oligomers of the invention can also comprise covalently attached PEG molecules of various molecular weights.
  • These formulations offer a method for increasing the accumulation of drugs in target tissues. This class of drug carriers resists opsonization and elimination by the mononuclear phagocytic system (MPS or RES), thereby enabling longer blood circulation times and enhanced tissue exposure for the encapsulated drug (Lasic et al. Chem. Rev.
  • the present invention includes oligomer compositions prepared for delivery as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,692,911, 7,163,695 and 7,070,807.
  • the present invention provides an oligomer of the present invention in a composition comprising copolymers of lysine and histidine (HK) as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 7,163,695, 7,070,807, and 6,692,911 either alone or in combination with PEG (e.g., branched or unbranched PEG or a mixture of both), in combination with PEG and a targeting moiety or any of the foregoing in combination with a crosslinking agent.
  • PEG e.g., branched or unbranched PEG or a mixture of both
  • the present invention provides antisense oligomers in compositions comprising gluconic-acid-modified polyhistidine or gluconylated-polyhistidine/transferrin-polylysine.
  • compositions comprising gluconic-acid-modified polyhistidine or gluconylated-polyhistidine/transferrin-polylysine.
  • amino acids with properties similar to His and Lys may be substituted within the composition.
  • oligomers described herein may contain a basic functional group, such as amino or alkylamino, and are, thus, capable of forming pharmaceutically-acceptable salts with pharmaceutically-acceptable acids.
  • pharmaceutically-acceptable salts refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic acid addition salts of compounds of the present invention. These salts can be prepared in situ in the administration vehicle or the dosage form manufacturing process, or by separately reacting a purified compound of the invention in its free base form with a suitable organic or inorganic acid, and isolating the salt thus formed during subsequent purification.
  • Representative salts include the hydrobromide, hydrochloride, sulfate, bisulfate, phosphate, nitrate, acetate, valerate, oleate, palmitate, stearate, laurate, benzoate, lactate, phosphate, tosylate, citrate, maleate, fumarate, succinate, tartrate, napthylate, mesylate, glucoheptonate, lactobionate, and laurylsulphonate salts and the like. (See, e.g., Berge et al. (1977) “Pharmaceutical Salts”, J. Pharm. Sci. 66:1-19).
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the subject oligomers include the conventional nontoxic salts or quaternary ammonium salts of the compounds, e.g., from non-toxic organic or inorganic acids.
  • such conventional nontoxic salts include those derived from inorganic acids such as hydrochloride, hydrobromic, sulfuric, sulfamic, phosphoric, nitric, and the like; and the salts prepared from organic acids such as acetic, propionic, succinic, glycolic, stearic, lactic, malic, tartaric, citric, ascorbic, palmitic, maleic, hydroxymaleic, phenylacetic, glutamic, benzoic, salicyclic, sulfanilic, 2-acetoxybenzoic, fumaric, toluenesulfonic, methanesulfonic, ethane disulfonic, oxalic, isothionic, and the like.
  • the oligomers of the present invention may contain one or more acidic functional groups and, thus, are capable of forming pharmaceutically acceptable salts with pharmaceutically acceptable bases.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable salts refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic base addition salts of compounds of the present invention. These salts can likewise be prepared in situ in the administration vehicle or the dosage form manufacturing process, or by separately reacting the purified compound in its free acid form with a suitable base, such as the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically-acceptable metal cation, with ammonia, or with a pharmaceutically-acceptable organic primary, secondary or tertiary amine.
  • Representative alkali or alkaline earth salts include the lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and aluminum salts and the like.
  • Representative organic amines useful for the formation of base addition salts include ethylamine, diethylamine, ethylenediamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, piperazine and the like. (See, e.g., Berge et al., supra).
  • wetting agents such as sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium stearate, as well as coloring agents, release agents, coating agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present in the compositions.
  • antioxidants examples include: (1) water soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbic acid, cysteine hydrochloride, sodium bisulfate, sodium metabisulfite, sodium sulfite and the like; (2) oil-soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT), lecithin, propyl gallate, alpha-tocopherol, and the like; and (3) metal chelating agents, such as citric acid, ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA), sorbitol, tartaric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like.
  • water soluble antioxidants such as ascorbic acid, cysteine hydrochloride, sodium bisulfate, sodium metabisulfite, sodium sulfite and the like
  • oil-soluble antioxidants such as ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT), le
  • Formulations of the present invention include those suitable for oral, nasal, topical (including buccal and sublingual), rectal, vaginal and/or parenteral administration.
  • the formulations may conveniently be presented in unit dosage form and may be prepared by any methods well known in the art of pharmacy.
  • the amount of active ingredient that can be combined with a carrier material to produce a single dosage form will vary depending upon the host being treated, the particular mode of administration.
  • the amount of active ingredient which can be combined with a carrier material to produce a single dosage form will generally be that amount of the compound which produces a therapeutic effect. Generally, out of one hundred percent, this amount will range from about 0.1 percent to about ninety-nine percent of active ingredient, preferably from about 5 percent to about 70 percent, most preferably from about 10 percent to about 30 percent.
  • a formulation of the present invention comprises an excipient selected from cyclodextrins, celluloses, liposomes, micelle forming agents, e.g., bile acids, and polymeric carriers, e.g., polyesters and polyanhydrides; and an oligomer of the present invention.
  • an aforementioned formulation renders orally bioavailable an oligomer of the present invention.
  • Methods of preparing these formulations or compositions include the step of bringing into association an oligomer of the present invention with the carrier and, optionally, one or more accessory ingredients.
  • the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association a compound of the present invention with liquid carriers, or finely divided solid carriers, or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product.
  • Formulations of the invention suitable for oral administration may be in the form of capsules, cachets, pills, tablets, lozenges (using a flavored basis, usually sucrose and acacia or tragacanth), powders, granules, or as a solution or a suspension in an aqueous or non-aqueous liquid, or as an oil-in-water or water-in-oil liquid emulsion, or as an elixir or syrup, or as pastilles (using an inert base, such as gelatin and glycerin, or sucrose and acacia) and/or as mouth washes and the like, each containing a predetermined amount of a compound of the present invention as an active ingredient.
  • An oligomer of the present invention may also be administered as a bolus, electuary or paste.
  • the active ingredient may be mixed with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers, such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate, and/or any of the following: (1) fillers or extenders, such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol, and/or silicic acid; (2) binders, such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, sucrose and/or acacia; (3) humectants, such as glycerol; (4) disintegrating agents, such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates, and sodium carbonate; (5) solution retarding agents, such as paraffin; (6) absorption accelerators, such as quaternary ammonium compounds and surfactants, such as polox
  • compositions may also comprise buffering agents.
  • Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-shelled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugars, as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols and the like.
  • a tablet may be made by compression or molding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients.
  • Compressed tablets may be prepared using binder (e.g., gelatin or hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose), lubricant, inert diluent, preservative, disintegrant (for example, sodium starch glycolate or cross-linked sodium carboxymethyl cellulose), surface-active or dispersing agent.
  • Molded tablets may be made by molding in a suitable machine a mixture of the powdered compound moistened with an inert liquid diluent.
  • the tablets, and other solid dosage forms of the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention may optionally be scored or prepared with coatings and shells, such as enteric coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical-formulating art. They may also be formulated so as to provide slow or controlled release of the active ingredient therein using, for example, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose in varying proportions to provide the desired release profile, other polymer matrices, liposomes and/or microspheres. They may be formulated for rapid release, e.g., freeze-dried.
  • compositions may be sterilized by, for example, filtration through a bacteria-retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved in sterile water, or some other sterile injectable medium immediately before use.
  • These compositions may also optionally contain opacifying agents and may be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain portion of the gastrointestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner.
  • embedding compositions which can be used include polymeric substances and waxes.
  • the active ingredient can also be in micro-encapsulated form, if appropriate, with one or more of the above-described excipients.
  • Liquid dosage forms for oral administration of the compounds of the invention include pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, microemulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs.
  • the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as, for example, water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers, such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof.
  • inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as, for example, water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and
  • the oral compositions can also include adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring, coloring, perfuming and preservative agents.
  • adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring, coloring, perfuming and preservative agents.
  • Suspensions in addition to the active compounds, may contain suspending agents as, for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol and sorbitan esters, microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar-agar and tragacanth, and mixtures thereof.
  • suspending agents as, for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol and sorbitan esters, microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar-agar and tragacanth, and mixtures thereof.
  • Formulations for rectal or vaginal administration may be presented as a suppository, which may be prepared by mixing one or more compounds of the invention with one or more suitable nonirritating excipients or carriers comprising, for example, cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol, a suppository wax or a salicylate, and which is solid at room temperature, but liquid at body temperature and, therefore, will melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
  • suitable nonirritating excipients or carriers comprising, for example, cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol, a suppository wax or a salicylate, and which is solid at room temperature, but liquid at body temperature and, therefore, will melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
  • Formulations or dosage forms for the topical or transdermal administration of an oligomer as provided herein include powders, sprays, ointments, pastes, creams, lotions, gels, solutions, patches and inhalants.
  • the active oligomers may be mixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically-acceptable carrier, and with any preservatives, buffers, or propellants which may be required.
  • the ointments, pastes, creams and gels may contain, in addition to an active compound of this invention, excipients, such as animal and vegetable fats, oils, waxes, paraffins, starch, tragacanth, cellulose derivatives, polyethylene glycols, silicones, bentonites, silicic acid, talc and zinc oxide, or mixtures thereof.
  • excipients such as animal and vegetable fats, oils, waxes, paraffins, starch, tragacanth, cellulose derivatives, polyethylene glycols, silicones, bentonites, silicic acid, talc and zinc oxide, or mixtures thereof.
  • Powders and sprays can contain, in addition to an oligomer of the present invention, excipients such as lactose, talc, silicic acid, aluminum hydroxide, calcium silicates and polyamide powder, or mixtures of these substances.
  • Sprays can additionally contain customary propellants, such as chlorofluorohydrocarbons and volatile unsubstituted hydrocarbons, such as butane and propane.
  • Transdermal patches have the added advantage of providing controlled delivery of an oligomer of the present invention to the body.
  • dosage forms can be made by dissolving or dispersing the oligomer in the proper medium.
  • Absorption enhancers can also be used to increase the flux of the agent across the skin. The rate of such flux can be controlled by either providing a rate controlling membrane or dispersing the agent in a polymer matrix or gel, among other methods known in the art.
  • compositions suitable for parenteral administration may comprise one or more oligomers of the invention in combination with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable sterile isotonic aqueous or nonaqueous solutions, dispersions, suspensions or emulsions, or sterile powders which may be reconstituted into sterile injectable solutions or dispersions just prior to use, which may contain sugars, alcohols, antioxidants, buffers, bacteriostats, solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient or suspending or thickening agents.
  • aqueous and nonaqueous carriers examples include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof, vegetable oils, such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters, such as ethyl oleate.
  • polyols such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like
  • vegetable oils such as olive oil
  • injectable organic esters such as ethyl oleate.
  • Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions, and by the use of surfactants.
  • compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents. Prevention of the action of microorganisms upon the subject oligomers may be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid, and the like. It may also be desirable to include isotonic agents, such as sugars, sodium chloride, and the like into the compositions. In addition, prolonged absorption of the injectable pharmaceutical form may be brought about by the inclusion of agents which delay absorption such as aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
  • adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents.
  • the absorption of the drug in order to prolong the effect of a drug, it is desirable to slow the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material having poor water solubility, among other methods known in the art. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon its rate of dissolution which, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally-administered drug form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
  • Injectable depot forms may be made by forming microencapsule matrices of the subject oligomers in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending on the ratio of oligomer to polymer, and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of oligomer release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations may also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions that are compatible with body tissues.
  • biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide.
  • Depot injectable formulations may also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions that are compatible with body tissues.
  • the oligomers of the present invention are administered as pharmaceuticals, to humans and animals, they can be given per se or as a pharmaceutical composition containing, for example, 0.1 to 99% (more preferably, 10 to 30%) of active ingredient in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the formulations or preparations of the present invention may be given orally, parenterally, topically, or rectally. They are typically given in forms suitable for each administration route. For example, they are administered in tablets or capsule form, by injection, inhalation, eye lotion, ointment, suppository, etc. administration by injection, infusion or inhalation; topical by lotion or ointment; and rectal by suppositories.
  • parenteral administration and “administered parenterally” as used herein means modes of administration other than enteral and topical administration, usually by injection, and includes, without limitation, intravenous, intramuscular, intraarterial, intrathecal, intracapsular, intraorbital, intracardiac, intradermal, intraperitoneal, transtracheal, subcutaneous, subcuticular, intraarticulare, subcapsular, subarachnoid, intraspinal and intrasternal injection and infusion.
  • systemic administration means the administration of a compound, drug or other material other than directly into the central nervous system, such that it enters the patient's system and, thus, is subject to metabolism and other like processes, for example, subcutaneous administration.
  • the oligomers of the present invention which may be used in a suitable hydrated form, and/or the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention, may be formulated into pharmaceutically-acceptable dosage forms by conventional methods known to those of skill in the art.
  • Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions of this invention may be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active ingredient which is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular patient, composition, and mode of administration, without being unacceptably toxic to the patient.
  • the selected dosage level will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the particular oligomer of the present invention employed, or the ester, salt or amide thereof, the route of administration, the time of administration, the rate of excretion or metabolism of the particular oligomer being employed, the rate and extent of absorption, the duration of the treatment, other drugs, compounds and/or materials used in combination with the particular oligomer employed, the age, sex, weight, condition, general health and prior medical history of the patient being treated, and like factors well known in the medical arts.
  • a physician or veterinarian having ordinary skill in the art can readily determine and prescribe the effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition required.
  • the physician or veterinarian could start doses of the compounds of the invention employed in the pharmaceutical composition at levels lower than that required in order to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and gradually increase the dosage until the desired effect is achieved.
  • a suitable daily dose of a compound of the invention will be that amount of the compound which is the lowest dose effective to produce a therapeutic effect.
  • Such an effective dose will generally depend upon the factors described above.
  • oral, intravenous, intracerebroventricular and subcutaneous doses of the compounds of this invention for a patient, when used for the indicated effects will range from about 0.0001 to about 100 mg per kilogram of body weight per day.
  • the effective daily dose of the active compound may be administered as two, three, four, five, six or more sub-doses administered separately at appropriate intervals throughout the day, optionally, in unit dosage forms.
  • dosing is one administration per day.
  • dosing is one or more administration per every 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 days, or every 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12 weeks, or every 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12 months, as needed, to treat the desired condition.
  • Nucleic acid molecules can be administered to cells by a variety of methods known to those familiar to the art, including, but not restricted to, encapsulation in liposomes, by iontophoresis, or by incorporation into other vehicles, such as hydrogels, cyclodextrins, biodegradable nanocapsules, and bioadhesive microspheres, as described herein and known in the art.
  • microemulsification technology may be utilized to improve bioavailability of lipophilic (water insoluble) pharmaceutical agents. Examples include Trimetrine (Dordunoo, S. K., et al., Drug Development and Industrial Pharmacy, 17(12), 1685-1713, 1991 and REV 5901 (Sheen, P.
  • microemulsification provides enhanced bioavailability by preferentially directing absorption to the lymphatic system instead of the circulatory system, which thereby bypasses the liver, and prevents destruction of the compounds in the hepatobiliary circulation.
  • the formulations contain micelles formed from an oligomer as provided herein and at least one amphiphilic carrier, in which the micelles have an average diameter of less than about 100 nm. More preferred embodiments provide micelles having an average diameter less than about 50 nm, and even more preferred embodiments provide micelles having an average diameter less than about 30 nm, or even less than about 20 nm.
  • amphiphilic carriers While all suitable amphiphilic carriers are contemplated, the presently preferred carriers are generally those that have Generally-Recognized-as-Safe (GRAS) status, and that can both solubilize the compound of the present invention and microemulsify it at a later stage when the solution comes into a contact with a complex water phase (such as one found in human gastro-intestinal tract).
  • GRAS Generally-Recognized-as-Safe
  • amphiphilic ingredients that satisfy these requirements have HLB (hydrophilic to lipophilic balance) values of 2-20, and their structures contain straight chain aliphatic radicals in the range of C-6 to C-20. Examples are polyethylene-glycolized fatty glycerides and polyethylene glycols.
  • amphiphilic carriers include saturated and monounsaturated polyethyleneglycolyzed fatty acid glycerides, such as those obtained from fully or partially hydrogenated various vegetable oils.
  • oils may advantageously consist of tri-, di-, and mono-fatty acid glycerides and di- and mono-polyethyleneglycol esters of the corresponding fatty acids, with a particularly preferred fatty acid composition including capric acid 4-10, capric acid 3-9, lauric acid 40-50, myristic acid 14-24, palmitic acid 4-14 and stearic acid 5-15%.
  • amphiphilic carriers includes partially esterified sorbitan and/or sorbitol, with saturated or mono-unsaturated fatty acids (SPAN-series) or corresponding ethoxylated analogs (TWEEN-series).
  • SPAN-series saturated or mono-unsaturated fatty acids
  • TWEEN-series corresponding ethoxylated analogs
  • amphiphilic carriers may be particularly useful, including Gelucire-series, Labrafil, Labrasol, or Lauroglycol (all manufactured and distributed by Gattefosse Corporation, Saint Priest, France), PEG-mono-oleate, PEG-di-oleate, PEG-mono-laurate and di-laurate, Lecithin, Polysorbate 80, etc (produced and distributed by a number of companies in USA and worldwide).
  • the delivery may occur by use of liposomes, nanocapsules, microparticles, microspheres, lipid particles, vesicles, and the like, for the introduction of the compositions of the present invention into suitable host cells.
  • the compositions of the present invention may be formulated for delivery either encapsulated in a lipid particle, a liposome, a vesicle, a nanosphere, a nanoparticle or the like.
  • the formulation and use of such delivery vehicles can be carried out using known and conventional techniques.
  • Hydrophilic polymers suitable for use in the present invention are those which are readily water-soluble, can be covalently attached to a vesicle-forming lipid, and which are tolerated in vivo without toxic effects (i.e., are biocompatible).
  • Suitable polymers include polyethylene glycol (PEG), polylactic (also termed polylactide), polyglycolic acid (also termed polyglycolide), a polylactic-polyglycolic acid copolymer, and polyvinyl alcohol.
  • polymers have a molecular weight of from about 100 or 120 daltons up to about 5,000 or 10,000 daltons, or from about 300 daltons to about 5,000 daltons.
  • the polymer is polyethyleneglycol having a molecular weight of from about 100 to about 5,000 daltons, or having a molecular weight of from about 300 to about 5,000 daltons. In certain embodiments, the polymer is polyethyleneglycol of 750 daltons (PEG(750)). Polymers may also be defined by the number of monomers therein; a preferred embodiment of the present invention utilizes polymers of at least about three monomers, such PEG polymers consisting of three monomers (approximately 150 daltons).
  • hydrophilic polymers which may be suitable for use in the present invention include polyvinylpyrrolidone, polymethoxazoline, polyethyloxazoline, polyhydroxypropyl methacrylamide, polymethacrylamide, polydimethylacrylamide, and derivatized celluloses such as hydroxymethylcellulose or hydroxyethylcellulose.
  • a formulation of the present invention comprises a biocompatible polymer selected from the group consisting of polyamides, polycarbonates, polyalkylenes, polymers of acrylic and methacrylic esters, polyvinyl polymers, polyglycolides, polysiloxanes, polyurethanes and co-polymers thereof, celluloses, polypropylene, polyethylenes, polystyrene, polymers of lactic acid and glycolic acid, polyanhydrides, poly(ortho)esters, poly(butic acid), poly(valeric acid), poly(lactide-co-caprolactone), polysaccharides, proteins, polyhyaluronic acids, polycyanoacrylates, and blends, mixtures, or copolymers thereof.
  • a biocompatible polymer selected from the group consisting of polyamides, polycarbonates, polyalkylenes, polymers of acrylic and methacrylic esters, polyvinyl polymers, polyglycolides, polysiloxanes, polyurethanes and
  • Cyclodextrins are cyclic oligosaccharides, consisting of 6, 7 or 8 glucose units, designated by the Greek letter ⁇ , ⁇ . or ⁇ , respectively.
  • the glucose units are linked by ⁇ -1,4-glucosidic bonds.
  • all secondary hydroxyl groups at C-2, C-3) are located on one side of the ring, while all the primary hydroxyl groups at C-6 are situated on the other side.
  • the external faces are hydrophilic, making the cyclodextrins water-soluble.
  • the cavities of the cyclodextrins are hydrophobic, since they are lined by the hydrogen of atoms C-3 and C-5, and by ether-like oxygens.
  • These matrices allow complexation with a variety of relatively hydrophobic compounds, including, for instance, steroid compounds such as 17 ⁇ -estradiol (see, e.g., van Uden et al. Plant Cell Tiss. Org. Cult. 38:1-3-113 (1994)).
  • the complexation takes place by Van der Waals interactions and by hydrogen bond formation.
  • the physico-chemical properties of the cyclodextrin derivatives depend strongly on the kind and the degree of substitution. For example, their solubility in water ranges from insoluble (e.g., triacetyl-beta-cyclodextrin) to 147% soluble (w/v) (G-2-beta-cyclodextrin). In addition, they are soluble in many organic solvents.
  • the properties of the cyclodextrins enable the control over solubility of various formulation components by increasing or decreasing their solubility.
  • Parmeter (I), et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 3,453,259) and Gramera, et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 3,459,731) described electroneutral cyclodextrins.
  • Other derivatives include cyclodextrins with cationic properties [Parmeter (II), U.S. Pat. No. 3,453,257], insoluble crosslinked cyclodextrins (Solms, U.S. Pat. No. 3,420,788), and cyclodextrins with anionic properties [Parmeter (III), U.S. Pat. No. 3,426,011].
  • cyclodextrin derivatives with anionic properties carboxylic acids, phosphorous acids, phosphinous acids, phosphonic acids, phosphoric acids, thiophosphonic acids, thiosulphinic acids, and sulfonic acids have been appended to the parent cyclodextrin [see, Parmeter (III), supra]. Furthermore, sulfoalkyl ether cyclodextrin derivatives have been described by Stella, et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 5,134,127).
  • Liposomes consist of at least one lipid bilayer membrane enclosing an aqueous internal compartment. Liposomes may be characterized by membrane type and by size. Small unilamellar vesicles (SUVs) have a single membrane and typically range between 0.02 and 0.05 ⁇ m in diameter; large unilamellar vesicles (LUVS) are typically larger than 0.05 ⁇ m. Oligolamellar large vesicles and multilamellar vesicles have multiple, usually concentric, membrane layers and are typically larger than 0.1 ⁇ m. Liposomes with several nonconcentric membranes, i.e., several smaller vesicles contained within a larger vesicle, are termed multivesicular vesicles.
  • SUVs Small unilamellar vesicles
  • Oligolamellar large vesicles and multilamellar vesicles have multiple, usually concentric, membrane layers and are typically larger than 0.1 ⁇ m.
  • One aspect of the present invention relates to formulations comprising liposomes containing an oligomer of the present invention, where the liposome membrane is formulated to provide a liposome with increased carrying capacity.
  • the compound of the present invention may be contained within, or adsorbed onto, the liposome bilayer of the liposome.
  • An oligomer of the present invention may be aggregated with a lipid surfactant and carried within the liposome's internal space; in these cases, the liposome membrane is formulated to resist the disruptive effects of the active agent-surfactant aggregate.
  • the lipid bilayer of a liposome contains lipids derivatized with polyethylene glycol (PEG), such that the PEG chains extend from the inner surface of the lipid bilayer into the interior space encapsulated by the liposome, and extend from the exterior of the lipid bilayer into the surrounding environment.
  • PEG polyethylene glycol
  • Active agents contained within liposomes of the present invention are in solubilized form. Aggregates of surfactant and active agent (such as emulsions or micelles containing the active agent of interest) may be entrapped within the interior space of liposomes according to the present invention.
  • a surfactant acts to disperse and solubilize the active agent, and may be selected from any suitable aliphatic, cycloaliphatic or aromatic surfactant, including but not limited to biocompatible lysophosphatidylcholines (LPCs) of varying chain lengths (for example, from about C14 to about C20).
  • Polymer-derivatized lipids such as PEG-lipids may also be utilized for micelle formation as they will act to inhibit micelle/membrane fusion, and as the addition of a polymer to surfactant molecules decreases the CMC of the surfactant and aids in micelle formation.
  • Liposomes according to the present invention may be prepared by any of a variety of techniques that are known in the art. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,235,871; Published PCT applications WO 96/14057; New RRC, Liposomes: A practical approach, IRL Press, Oxford (1990), pages 33-104; Lasic D D, Liposomes from physics to applications, Elsevier Science Publishers BV, Amsterdam, 1993.
  • liposomes of the present invention may be prepared by diffusing a lipid derivatized with a hydrophilic polymer into preformed liposomes, such as by exposing preformed liposomes to micelles composed of lipid-grafted polymers, at lipid concentrations corresponding to the final mole percent of derivatized lipid which is desired in the liposome.
  • Liposomes containing a hydrophilic polymer can also be formed by homogenization, lipid-field hydration, or extrusion techniques, as are known in the art.
  • the active agent is first dispersed by sonication in a lysophosphatidylcholine or other low CMC surfactant (including polymer grafted lipids) that readily solubilizes hydrophobic molecules.
  • a lysophosphatidylcholine or other low CMC surfactant including polymer grafted lipids
  • the resulting micellar suspension of active agent is then used to rehydrate a dried lipid sample that contains a suitable mole percent of polymer-grafted lipid, or cholesterol.
  • the lipid and active agent suspension is then formed into liposomes using extrusion techniques as are known in the art, and the resulting liposomes separated from the unencapsulated solution by standard column separation.
  • the liposomes are prepared to have substantially homogeneous sizes in a selected size range.
  • One effective sizing method involves extruding an aqueous suspension of the liposomes through a series of polycarbonate membranes having a selected uniform pore size; the pore size of the membrane will correspond roughly with the largest sizes of liposomes produced by extrusion through that membrane. See e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,737,323 (Apr. 12, 1988).
  • reagents such as DharmaFECT® and Lipofectamine® may be utilized to introduce polynucleotides or proteins into cells.
  • release characteristics of a formulation of the present invention depend on the encapsulating material, the concentration of encapsulated drug, and the presence of release modifiers.
  • release can be manipulated to be pH dependent, for example, using a pH sensitive coating that releases only at a low pH, as in the stomach, or a higher pH, as in the intestine.
  • An enteric coating can be used to prevent release from occurring until after passage through the stomach.
  • Multiple coatings or mixtures of cyanamide encapsulated in different materials can be used to obtain an initial release in the stomach, followed by later release in the intestine.
  • Release can also be manipulated by inclusion of salts or pore forming agents, which can increase water uptake or release of drug by diffusion from the capsule.
  • Excipients which modify the solubility of the drug can also be used to control the release rate.
  • Agents which enhance degradation of the matrix or release from the matrix can also be incorporated. They can be added to the drug, added as a separate phase (i.e., as particulates), or can be co-dissolved in the polymer phase depending on the compound. In most cases the amount should be between 0.1 and thirty percent (w/w polymer).
  • Types of degradation enhancers include inorganic salts such as ammonium sulfate and ammonium chloride, organic acids such as citric acid, benzoic acid, and ascorbic acid, inorganic bases such as sodium carbonate, potassium carbonate, calcium carbonate, zinc carbonate, and zinc hydroxide, and organic bases such as protamine sulfate, spermine, choline, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, and triethanolamine and surfactants such as Tween® and Pluronic®.
  • Pore forming agents which add microstructure to the matrices i.e., water soluble compounds such as inorganic salts and sugars
  • the range is typically between one and thirty percent (w/w polymer).
  • Uptake can also be manipulated by altering residence time of the particles in the gut. This can be achieved, for example, by coating the particle with, or selecting as the encapsulating material, a mucosal adhesive polymer.
  • a mucosal adhesive polymer examples include most polymers with free carboxyl groups, such as chitosan, celluloses, and especially polyacrylates (as used herein, polyacrylates refers to polymers including acrylate groups and modified acrylate groups such as cyanoacrylates and methacrylates).
  • An oligomer may be formulated to be contained within, or, adapted to release by a surgical or medical device or implant.
  • an implant may be coated or otherwise treated with an oligomer.
  • hydrogels, or other polymers such as biocompatible and/or biodegradable polymers, may be used to coat an implant with the compositions of the present invention (i.e., the composition may be adapted for use with a medical device by using a hydrogel or other polymer).
  • Polymers and copolymers for coating medical devices with an agent are well-known in the art.
  • implants include, but are not limited to, stents, drug-eluting stents, sutures, prosthesis, vascular catheters, dialysis catheters, vascular grafts, prosthetic heart valves, cardiac pacemakers, implantable cardioverter defibrillators, IV needles, devices for bone setting and formation, such as pins, screws, plates, and other devices, and artificial tissue matrices for wound healing.
  • the oligomers for use according to the invention may be formulated for administration in any convenient way for use in human or veterinary medicine, by analogy with other pharmaceuticals.
  • the antisense oligomers and their corresponding formulations may be administered alone or in combination with other therapeutic strategies in the treatment of inflammation.
  • routes of antisense oligomer delivery include, but are not limited to, various systemic routes, including oral and parenteral routes, e.g., intravenous, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, and intramuscular, as well as inhalation, transdermal, pulmonary and topical delivery.
  • the appropriate route may be determined by one of skill in the art, as appropriate to the condition of the subject under treatment.
  • an appropriate route for delivery of an antisense oligomer in the treatment of a condition of the skin may include topical delivery, while delivery of a antisense oligomer for the treatment of a respiratory condition (e.g., COPD) may include inhalation, intranasal or pulmonary delivery.
  • the oligomer may also be delivered directly to the site of inflammation infection, or to the bloodstream.
  • the antisense oligomer may be administered in any convenient vehicle which is physiologically acceptable.
  • a composition may include any of a variety of standard pharmaceutically acceptable carriers employed by those of ordinary skill in the art. Examples include, but are not limited to, saline, phosphate buffered saline (PBS), water, aqueous ethanol, emulsions, such as oil/water emulsions or triglyceride emulsions, tablets and capsules.
  • PBS phosphate buffered saline
  • emulsions such as oil/water emulsions or triglyceride emulsions
  • tablets and capsules emulsions
  • suitable physiologically acceptable carrier will vary dependent upon the chosen mode of administration.
  • liposomes may be employed to facilitate uptake of the antisense oligonucleotide into cells.
  • liposomes may be employed to facilitate uptake of the antisense oligonucleotide into cells.
  • Hydrogels may also be used as vehicles for antisense oligomer administration, for example, as described in WO 93/01286 or PCT Application No US1992/005305.
  • the oligonucleotides may be administered in microspheres or microparticles. (See, e.g., Wu, G. Y. and Wu, C. H., J. Biol. Chem. 262:4429-4432, 1987).
  • the use of gas-filled microbubbles complexed with the antisense oligomers can enhance delivery to target tissues, as described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,245,747.
  • Sustained release compositions may also be used. These may include semipermeable polymeric matrices in the form of shaped articles such as films or microcapsules.
  • the subject is a human subject, e.g., a patient diagnosed as having a localized or systemic inflammatory condition.
  • the condition of a patient may also dictate prophylactic administration of an antisense oligomer of the invention, e.g., in the case of a patient who (1) is immunocompromised; (2) is a burn victim; (3) has an indwelling catheter; or (4) is about to undergo or has recently undergone surgery.
  • the oligomer is a phosphorodiamidate morpholino oligomer, contained in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and is delivered orally.
  • the oligomer is a phosphorodiamidate morpholino oligomer, contained in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and is delivered intravenously (i.v.).
  • the antisense compounds may be administered in an amount and manner effective to result in a peak blood concentration of at least 200-400 nM antisense oligomer.
  • one or more doses of antisense oligomer are administered, generally at regular intervals, for a period of about one to two weeks.
  • Preferred doses for oral administration are from about 1-100 mg oligomer per 70 kg. In some cases, doses of greater than 100 mg oligomer/patient may be necessary. For i.v. administration, preferred doses are from about 1 mg to 500 mg oligomer per 70 kg.
  • the antisense oligomer may be administered at regular intervals for a short time period, e.g., daily for two weeks or less.
  • the oligomer is administered intermittently over a longer period of time. Administration may be followed by, or concurrent with, administration of an antibiotic or other therapeutic treatment.
  • the treatment regimen may be adjusted (dose, frequency, route, etc.) as indicated, based on the results of immunoassays, other biochemical tests and physiological examination of the subject under treatment.
  • Phosphorodiamidate morpholino oligomers were synthesized at AVI BioPharma in accordance with known methods, as described, for example, in ((Summerton and Weller 1997) and U.S. Pat. No. 5,185,444 and further described in PCT application No. U.S. Ser. No. 08/012,804. Exemplary structures of the PMO are as shown in FIGS. 1A-C .
  • PMOs peptide-conjugated PMOs
  • morpholino subunits (moN), which may be prepared as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,185,444 or in Summerton and Weller, 1997 (cited above) and further described in PCT application No. U.S. Ser. No. 08/012,804, to provide the activated subunits.
  • Suitable protecting groups are used for the nucleoside bases, where necessary; for example, benzoyl for adenine and cytosine, phenylacetyl for guanine, and pivaloylmethyl for inosine.
  • the subunits containing the (1-piperazino) phosphinylideneoxy linkage can be incorporated into the existing PMO synthesis protocol, as described, for example in Summerton and Weller (1997), without modification.
  • mice were treated with vehicle (n 3) or glucocorticoid receptor antisense PMO targeting either GR exon 6 or exon 7 (SEQ ID NOs: 13 or 16, respectively) for three days at the dose of 30 mg/kg/day administered subcutaneously.
  • TAT dexamethasone and tyrosine aminotransferase
  • the same two antisense oligomers were used to treat primary rat hepatocytes followed by measurement of TAT activity.
  • the following table shows the level of TAT activity in the treated animals and primary hepatocytes relative to vehicle controls.
  • TAT Tyrosine aminotransferase
  • RNA was reverse transcribed and PCR amplified using the SuperScript III 1-Step RTPCR kit from Life Technologies and the following primer pairs using standard conditions.
  • the forward primer was directed to exon 4 (FWD: 5′ GTG CTG GAA GAA ACG ATT GC 3′) (SEQ ID NO:27) and the reverse primer was directed to exon 8 (REV: 5′ CAG TTG GTA AAA CCG TTG CC 3′) (SEQ ID NO:28).
  • PCR amplification products using these primers are able to detect mRNA isoforms lacking exons 5 and/or 6.
  • the expected PCR amplification products for the rat glucocorticoid mRNA isoform lacking exon 6 is 504 bp compared to 780 bp obtained from the full length mRNA isoform.
  • FIG. 4 indicates the presence of the expected 504 bp band only in MuSA6-treated hepatocytes.
  • DNA sequence analysis was then performed on both the upper and lower bands from the RT-PCR reaction, and the precise removal of exon 6 was observed in the sequence from the lower 504 bp band.
  • Antisense agents are thus capable of inducing precise exon-skipping of exon 6 of the glucocorticoid receptor.
  • mice were treated intranasally with 100 ⁇ g of peptide-conjugated MuSA7 PPMO (SEQ ID NO: 13 conjugated at the 3′ end to SEQ ID NO: 19) in 40 ⁇ l of PBS at ⁇ 48 hr, ⁇ 24 hr and ⁇ 4 h.
  • LPS was then administered intranasally at 0 hr (50 ug/mouse in 50 ⁇ l PBS) to induce an inflammatory response in the lungs.
  • the mice were sacrificed at 0 min, 40 min, 90 min, 6 hr, and 22 hr post-LPS treatment.
  • FIG. 5 shows the presence of the expected alternative splice isoform lacking exon 7 (635 bp) compared to the band from the full length mRNA (780 bp).
  • the upper and lower bands from the RT-PCR reactions were sequenced and the expected sequence indicating the precise removal of exon 7 was determined to be present in the lower 635 bp band.
  • Antisense agents are thus capable of inducing precise in vivo exon-skipping of exon 7 of the glucocorticoid receptor.
  • Carboxyfluorescein succinimidyl ester (CFSE)-labeled mouse splenocytes were stimulated at 0.5 ⁇ 10 6 cells/well in a 96 well plate on plate bound anti-CD3 at 10 ⁇ g/ml.
  • a MuSA6 PPMO (SEQ ID NO:16 conjugated at the 3′ end to SEQ ID NO:19) was added at 10 ⁇ M, 5 ⁇ M, and 2.5 ⁇ M with or without 10 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 12 M dexamethasone.
  • Soluble anti-CD28 was added at 10 ⁇ g/ml and cells were incubated at 37° C. for 72 hours.
  • CD4 + and CD8 + T-cells were analyzed for CFSE dilution and CD25 by flow cytometry.
  • FIG. 6A shows that MuSA6 treatment reduces the mean fluorescence intensity of cell-surface activation marker CD25 on the surface of CD8 + T-cells.
  • FIG. 6B shows that MuSA6 treatment also reduces the percentage of dividing CD8 + T-cells relative to controls. Parallel observations were made for CD4 + T-cells ( FIGS. 6C and 6D ).
  • the legends in FIGS. 6A-6D refer to MuSA6 (the peptide-conjugated PMO described above) and Peptide only (SEQ ID NO: 19). Antisense-induced exon-skipping of exon 6 of the glucocorticoid receptor thus reduces activation of CD4 + and CD8 + T-cells.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Biotechnology (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Plant Pathology (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Microbiology (AREA)
  • Rheumatology (AREA)
  • Neurology (AREA)
  • Pulmonology (AREA)
  • Neurosurgery (AREA)
  • Hospice & Palliative Care (AREA)
  • Psychiatry (AREA)
  • Pain & Pain Management (AREA)
  • Obesity (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Orthopedic Medicine & Surgery (AREA)
  • Physical Education & Sports Medicine (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)

Abstract

Provided are antisense oligonucleotides and other agents that target and modulate nuclear hormone receptors (NHRs) such as the glucocorticoid receptor (GR), compositions that comprise the same, and methods of use thereof.

Description

    CROSS REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • This application is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 13/046,356, filed Mar. 11, 2011 (allowed), which claims benefit under 35 U.S.C. §119(e) of U.S. Provisional Application No. 61/313,652, filed Mar. 12, 2010, each of which is incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • STATEMENT REGARDING SEQUENCE LISTING
  • The Sequence Listing associated with this application is provided in text format in lieu of a paper copy, and is hereby incorporated by reference into the specification. The name of the text file containing the Sequence Listing is 120178485C1_SEQUENCE_LISTING.txt. The text file is 13 KB, was created on May 19, 2015, and is being submitted electronically via EFS-Web.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • 1. Technical Field
  • The present invention relates to antisense oligonucleotides and other agents that target nuclear hormone receptors (NHRs) and methods of use thereof.
  • 2. Description of the Related Art
  • The nuclear hormone receptor (NHR) family of transcription factors bind low molecular weight ligands and either stimulate or repress transcription. See, e.g., V. Laudet et al., The Nuclear Receptor Facts Book, 345, (2002) and (Gronemeyer, Gustafsson et al. 2004)). NHRs stimulate transcription by binding to DNA and inducing transcription of specific genes. NHRs may also stimulate transcription by not binding to DNA but through the modulation of the activity of other DNA binding proteins. This process of stimulation of transcription is called transactivation. NHRs also repress transcription by interacting with other transcription factors or coactivators and inhibiting the ability of these other transcription factors or coactivators from inducing transcription of specific genes. This type of repression is called transrepression (see V. Laudet et al (2002) and (Newton, Leigh et al. 2010).
  • The glucocorticoid receptor (GR) is a member of the nuclear hormone receptor family of transcription factors, and a member of the steroid hormone family of transcription factors. Glucocorticoids that interact with GR have been used for over 50 years to treat inflammatory diseases. Although glucocorticoids are potent anti-inflammatory agents, their systemic use is limited by numerous side effects. A compound that causes GR to retain the anti-inflammatory efficacy of glucocorticoids while minimizing the side effects such as diabetes, osteoporosis and glaucoma would be of great benefit to a very large number of patients with inflammatory diseases or other conditions. The art is therefore in need of effective and relatively specific modulators of NHRs such as GRs.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTIONS OF THE DRAWINGS
  • FIG. 1A shows an exemplary morpholino oligomer structure with a phosphorodiamidate linkage;
  • FIG. 1B shows a morpholino oligomer as in FIG. 1A, but where the backbone linkages contain one positively charged group in the form of a (piperazino) phosphorodiamidate linkage;
  • FIG. 1C shows a conjugate of an arginine-rich peptide and an antisense oligomer, in accordance with one embodiment of the invention;
  • FIGS. 1D-G show the repeating subunit segment of exemplary morpholino oligonucleotides, designated D through G.
  • FIG. 2 shows the exon organization of the human and murine GR gene and the human PR gene with the associated GenBank numbers. The human GR schematic shows the exon locations for several of the known alternatively spliced forms of the gene.
  • FIG. 3 shows the target location of the exemplary targeting sequences for the human GR gene relative to the exon 5 and 6 splice donor and acceptor sites.
  • FIG. 4 shows that antisense treatment induces precise exon-skipping of exon 6 of the glucocorticoid receptor in rat hepatocytes. The presence of the expected 504 bp band relative to 780 bp full-length band indicates removal of exon 6. This result was confirmed by sequencing the 504 bp band.
  • FIG. 5 shows that intranasally administered antisense agents induce precise exon-skipping of exon 7 of the glucocorticoid receptor in an in vivo mouse model. This figure indicates the presence of the expected alternative splice isoform lacking exon 7 (635 bp) compared to the band from the full length mRNA (780 bp).
  • FIGS. 6A-6D show that antisense-induced exon-skipping of exon 6 of the glucocorticoid receptor reduces activation of CD4+ and CD8+ T-cells. FIG. 6A shows that MuSA6 treatment reduces the mean fluorescence intensity of cell-surface activation marker CD25 on the surface of CD8+ T-cells. FIG. 6B shows that MuSA6 treatment also reduces the percentage of dividing CD8+ T-cells relative to controls. FIGS. 6C and 6D show the same results for CD4+ T-cells. The figure legends refer to MuSA6-PPMO (SEQ ID NO:16 conjugated to the peptide of SEQ ID NO:19) and Peptide only (SEQ ID NO: 19).
  • BRIEF SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • The present invention relates generally to compositions and methods for modulating expression of nuclear hormone receptors (NHR) from the nuclear hormone receptor superfamily (NHRSF), mainly by controlling or altering the splicing of pre-mRNA that codes for the receptors. Examples of particular NHRs include glucocorticoid receptors (GR). In certain embodiments, the antisense oligonucleotides and agents described herein lead to increased expression of ligand-independent or other selected forms of the receptors, and decreased expression of their inactive forms.
  • Embodiments of the present invention include nucleic acids and nucleic acid analogs that are complementary to selected exonic or intronic sequences of an NHR, including the “ligand-binding exons” and/or adjacent introns of a NHRSF pre-mRNA, among other NHR-domains described herein. The term “ligand-binding exons” refers to exon(s) that are present in the wild-type mRNA but are removed from the primary transcript (the “pre-mRNA”) to make a ligand-independent form of the mRNA. In certain embodiments, complementarity can be based on sequences in the sequence of pre-mRNA that spans a splice site, which includes, but is not limited to, complementarity based on sequences that span an exon-intron junction. In other embodiments, complementarity can be based solely on the sequence of the intron. In other embodiments, complementarity can be based solely on the sequence of the exon.
  • NHR modulators may be useful in treating NHR-associated diseases, including diseases associated with the expression products of genes whose transcription is stimulated or repressed by NHRs. For instance, modulators of NHRs that inhibit AP-1 and/or NF-κB can be useful in the treatment of inflammatory and immune diseases and disorders such as osteoarthritis, rheumatoid arthritis, multiple sclerosis, asthma, inflammatory bowel disease, transplant rejection, and graft vs. host disease, among others described herein and known in the art. Compounds that antagonize transactivation can be useful in treating metabolic diseases associated with increased levels of glucocorticoid, such as diabetes, osteoporosis and glaucoma, among others. Also, compounds that agonize transactivation can be useful in treating metabolic diseases associated with a deficiency in glucocorticoid, such as Addison's disease and others.
  • There are several alternative antisense or RNA interference chemistries available and known to those skilled in the art. One important feature of certain antisense chemistries is the ability to hybridize to a target RNA without causing degradation of the target by RNase H, as with 2′-deoxy oligonucleotides (“antisense oligonucleotides” hereafter “ASON”). Such compounds may also be referred to as splice-switching oligomers (SSOs). Those skilled in the art will appreciate that SSOs include, but are not limited to, 2′ O-modified oligonucleotides and ribonucleosidephosphorothioates as well as peptide nucleic acids (PNA), morpholinos, locked nucleic acids (LNA), and other polymers lacking ribofuranosyl-based linkages.
  • Embodiments of the present invention include methods of modulating nuclear hormone receptor (NHR) activity or expression in a cell, comprising contacting the cell with an antisense oligomer composed of morpholino subunits linked by phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkages joining a morpholino nitrogen of one subunit to a 5′ exocyclic carbon of an adjacent subunit, wherein the oligonucleotide contains between 10-40 bases and a targeting sequence of at least 10 contiguous bases complementary to a target sequence, wherein the target sequence is a pre-mRNA transcript of the NHR, thereby modulating activity or expression of the NHR. In certain embodiments, the NHR is selected from Table 1.
  • In certain embodiments, the oligomer alters splicing of the pre-mRNA transcript and increases expression of a variant of the NHR. In some embodiments, the oligomer induces full or partial exon-skipping of one or more exons of the pre-mRNA transcript. In certain embodiments, the one or more exons encode at least a portion of a ligand-binding domain of the NHR, and the variant is a ligand independent form of the NHR. In certain embodiments, the one or more exons encode at least a portion of a transactivation domain of the NHR, and the variant has reduced transcriptional activation activity. In certain embodiments, the one or more exons encode at least a portion of a DNA-binding domain of the NHR. In certain embodiments, the one or more exons encode at least a portion of an N-terminal activation domain of the NHR. In certain embodiments, the one or more exons encode at least a portion of a carboxy-terminal domain of the NHR. In specific embodiments, the variant binds to NF-κB, AP-1, or both, and reduces transcription of one or more of their pro-inflammatory target genes.
  • In certain embodiments, the oligomer agonizes a transactivation/transcriptional activity of the NHR. In other embodiments, the oligomer antagonizes a transactivation/transcriptional activity of the NHR. In certain embodiments, the oligomer agonizes a transrepression activity of the NHR. In other embodiments, the oligomer antagonizes a transrepression activity of the NHR. In specific embodiments, the oligomer antagonizes a transactivation/transcriptional activity of the NHR and agonizes a transrepression activity of the NHR.
  • In certain embodiments, the NHR is a glucocorticoid receptor (GR), a progesterone receptor (GR), or an androgen receptor (AR). In specific embodiments, the NHR is the GR. In certain embodiments, the target sequence is SEQ ID NO:1. In certain embodiments, the targeting sequence is selected from SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41.
  • In some embodiments, the cell is in a subject. Certain embodiments include reducing inflammation or an inflammatory response in the subject. Other embodiments comprise increasing inflammation or an inflammatory response in the subject.
  • Embodiments of the present invention also include substantially uncharged antisense oligomers, composed of morpholino subunits linked by phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkages joining a morpholino nitrogen of one subunit to a 5′ exocyclic carbon of an adjacent subunit, wherein the oligonucleotide contains between 10-40 bases and a targeting sequence of at least 10 contiguous bases complementary to a target sequence, wherein the target sequence is a pre-mRNA transcript of a nuclear hormone receptor (NHR). In certain embodiments, the oligomer contains about 10%-50% intersubunit cationic linkages. In some embodiments, the oligomer comprises an arginine-rich carrier peptide. In certain embodiments, the peptide is linked at its C-terminus to the 5′ end of the oligonucleotide through a one- or two-amino acid linker. In other embodiments, the peptide is linked at its C-terminus to the 3′ end of the oligonucleotide through a one- or two-amino acid linker. In specific embodiments, the linker is AhxβAla, wherein Ahx is 6-amino hexanoic acid and βAla is β-alanine. In preferred embodiments, the peptide is selected from SEQ ID NOS:18-26.
  • In some embodiments, the morpholino subunits in the oligonucleotide are joined by phosphorodiamidate linkages, in accordance with the structure:
  • Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00001
  • wherein Z is S or O,
  • X═NR1R2 or OR6,
  • Y═O or NR7,
  • and each said linkage is selected from:
  • (a) uncharged linkage (a), wherein each of R1, R2, R6, and R7 is independently selected from hydrogen and lower alkyl;
  • (b1) cationic linkage (b1), wherein X═NR1R2 and Y═O, and NR1R2 represents an optional substituted piperazino group, such that R1R2=
  • —CHRCHRN(R3)(R4)CHRCHR—, wherein
  • each R4 is H, CH3 or null, and
  • R3 is selected from H, lower alkyl, C(═NH)NH2, Z-L-NHC(═NH)NH2, and
  • [C(O)CHR′NH]mH, wherein where Z is carbonyl (C(O)) or a direct bond, L is an optional linker up to 18 atoms in length having bonds selected from alkyl, alkoxy, and alkylamino, R′ is a side chain of a naturally occurring amino acid or a one- or two-carbon homolog thereof, and m is 1 to 6;
  • (b2) cationic linkage (b2), wherein X═NR1R2 and Y═O, R1═H or CH3, and R2=LNR3R4R5, wherein L, R3, and R4 are defined as above, and R5 is H, lower alkyl, or lower (alkoxy)alkyl; and
  • (b3) cationic linkage (b3), wherein Y═NR′ and X═OR6, and R7=LNR3R4R5. wherein L, R3, and R4 and R5 are defined as above, and R6 is H or lower alkyl; and at least one said linkage is selected from cationic linkages (b1), (b2), and (b3).
  • In certain embodiments, each of R1 and R2, in linkages of type (a), is methyl.
  • In some embodiments, at least one linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, R4 is H, CH3, or an electron pair, and R3 is selected from H, CH3, C(═NH)NH2, and C(O)-L-NHC(═NH)NH2.
  • In specific embodiments, at least one linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, R4 is an electron pair, and R3 is selected from C(═NH)NH2 and C(O)-L-NHC(═NH)NH2.
  • In certain embodiments, at least one linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, R4 is an electron pair, and R3 is selected from C(═NH)NH2 and C(O)-L-NHC(═NH)NH2.
  • In certain embodiments, R3 is C(O)-L-NHC(NH)NH2, and L is a hydrocarbon having the structure —(CH2)n—, where n is 1 to 12.
  • In certain embodiments, at least one linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, and each of R3 and R4 is independently H or CH3.
  • Also included are methods of modulating inflammation in a subject, comprising administering to the subject an antisense oligomer composed of morpholino subunits linked by phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkages joining a morpholino nitrogen of one subunit to a 5′ exocyclic carbon of an adjacent subunit, wherein the oligonucleotide contains between 10-40 bases and a targeting sequence of at least 10 contiguous bases complementary to a target sequence, wherein the target sequence is a pre-mRNA transcript of a nuclear hormone receptor (NHR), thereby modulating inflammation in the subject.
  • Certain embodiments include reducing an acute inflammatory response, reducing a chronic inflammatory response, or both. Other embodiments include increasing an acute inflammatory response, increasing a chronic inflammatory response, or both. Certain embodiments comprise modulating the activation, inflammatory molecule secretion, proliferation, activity, migration, or adhesion of one or more immune cells or vascular cells.
  • Certain embodiments include modulating the levels or activity of one or more inflammatory molecules. In some embodiments, the one or more inflammatory molecules comprise plasma-derived inflammatory molecules of any one or more of the complement system, kinin system, coagulation system, or fibrinolysis system. In certain embodiments, the one or more inflammatory molecules comprise cell-derived inflammatory molecules of any one or more of lysosome granules, vasoactive amines, eicosanoids, cytokines, acute-phase proteins, or nitric oxide.
  • Certain embodiments relate to modulating an inflammatory response or inflammatory condition associated with one or more tissues, tissue systems, or organs selected from skin, hair follicles, nervous system, auditory system or balance organs, respiratory system, gastroesophogeal tissues, gastrointestinal system, vascular system, liver, gallbladder, lymphatic/immune system, uro-genital system, musculoskeletal system, adipose tissue, mammaries, and endocrine system.
  • Some embodiments include treating inflammation associated with hypersensitivity, an auto-inflammatory condition, cancer, systemic inflammatory response syndrome (SIRS), or cytokine storm.
  • Certain embodiments include treating inflammation associated with any one or more of granulomatous inflammation, fibrinous inflammation, purulent inflammation, serous inflammation, or ulcerative inflammation. Certain embodiments treating inflammation associated with one or more wounds. Certain embodiments treating inflammation associated with chronic obstructive pulmonary disorder (COPD). Certain embodiments comprising increasing the inflammatory response to treat a primary or secondary immunodeficiency. Also included are pharmaceutical composition, comprising an oligomer as described herein an a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION Definitions
  • Unless defined otherwise, all technical and scientific terms used herein have the same meaning as commonly understood by those of ordinary skill in the art to which the invention belongs. Although any methods and materials similar or equivalent to those described herein can be used in the practice or testing of the present invention, preferred methods and materials are described. For the purposes of the present invention, the following terms are defined below.
  • The articles “a” and “an” are used herein to refer to one or to more than one (i.e., to at least one) of the grammatical object of the article. By way of example, “an element” means one element or more than one element.
  • By “about” is meant a quantity, level, value, number, frequency, percentage, dimension, size, amount, weight or length that varies by as much as 30, 25, 20, 25, 10, 9, 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2 or 1% to a reference quantity, level, value, number, frequency, percentage, dimension, size, amount, weight or length.
  • An “agonist” refers to an agent that intensifies or mimics a selected biological activity of an NHR. Examples of such biological activities include transactivation and transrepression. Included are partial and full agonists.
  • The term “antagonist” refers to an agent that inhibits or attenuates a selected biological activity of an NHR. Examples of such biological activities include transactivation and transrepression. Included are partial and full antagonists.
  • By “coding sequence” is meant any nucleic acid sequence that contributes to the code for the polypeptide product of a gene. By contrast, the term “non-coding sequence” refers to any nucleic acid sequence that does not contribute to the code for the polypeptide product of a gene.
  • Throughout this specification, unless the context requires otherwise, the words “comprise,” “comprises,” and “comprising” will be understood to imply the inclusion of a stated step or element or group of steps or elements but not the exclusion of any other step or element or group of steps or elements.
  • By “consisting of” is meant including, and limited to, whatever follows the phrase “consisting of.” Thus, the phrase “consisting of” indicates that the listed elements are required or mandatory, and that no other elements may be present. By “consisting essentially of” is meant including any elements listed after the phrase, and limited to other elements that do not interfere with or contribute to the activity or action specified in the disclosure for the listed elements. Thus, the phrase “consisting essentially of” indicates that the listed elements are required or mandatory, but that other elements are optional and may or may not be present depending upon whether or not they materially affect the activity or action of the listed elements.
  • The terms “complementary” and “complementarity” refer to polynucleotides (i.e., a sequence of nucleotides) related by the base-pairing rules. For example, the sequence “A-G-T,” is complementary to the sequence “T-C-A.” Complementarity may be “partial,” in which only some of the nucleic acids' bases are matched according to the base pairing rules. Or, there may be “complete” or “total” complementarity between the nucleic acids. The degree of complementarity between nucleic acid strands has significant effects on the efficiency and strength of hybridization between nucleic acid strands. While perfect complementarity is often desired, some embodiments can include one or more but preferably 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, or 1 mismatches with respect to the target RNA. Variations at any location within the oligomer are included. In certain embodiments, variations in sequence near the termini of an oligomer are generally preferable to variations in the interior, and if present are typically within about 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, or 1 nucleotides of the 5′ and/or 3′ terminus.
  • The terms “cell penetrating peptide” or “CPP” are used interchangeably and refer to cationic cell penetrating peptides, also called transport peptides, carrier peptides, or peptide transduction domains. The peptides, as shown herein, have the capability of inducing cell penetration within 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, or 100% of cells of a given cell culture population, including all integers in between, and allow macromolecular translocation within multiple tissues in vivo upon systemic administration.
  • The terms “antisense oligomer” or “antisense compound” or “antisense oligonucleotide” or “oligonucleotide” are used interchangeably and refer to a sequence of cyclic subunits, each bearing a base-pairing moiety, linked by intersubunit linkages that allow the base-pairing moieties to hybridize to a target sequence in a nucleic acid (typically an RNA) by Watson-Crick base pairing, to form a nucleic acid:oligomer heteroduplex within the target sequence. The cyclic subunits may be based on ribose or another pentose sugar or, in certain embodiments, a morpholino group (see description of morpholino oligomers below). Also contemplated are peptide nucleic acids (PNAs), locked nucleic acids (LNAs), 2′-O-Methyl oligonucleotides and RNA interference agents (siRNA agents), and other antisense agents known in the art.
  • Such an antisense oligomer can be designed to block or inhibit translation of mRNA or to inhibit natural pre-mRNA splice processing, or induce degradation of targeted mRNAs, and may be said to be “directed to” or “targeted against” a target sequence with which it hybridizes. In certain embodiments, the target sequence includes a region including an AUG start codon of an mRNA, a 3′ or 5′ splice site of a pre-processed mRNA, a branch point. The target sequence may be within an exon or within an intron. The target sequence for a splice site may include an mRNA sequence having its 5′ end 1 to about 25 base pairs downstream of a normal splice acceptor junction in a preprocessed mRNA. A preferred target sequence for a splice is any region of a preprocessed mRNA that includes a splice site or is contained entirely within an exon coding sequence or spans a splice acceptor or donor site. An oligomer is more generally said to be “targeted against” a biologically relevant target, such as an NHR mRNA, when it is targeted against the nucleic acid of the target in the manner described above.
  • Included are antisense oligonucleotides that comprise, consist essentially of, or consist of one or more of SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41. Also included are variants of these antisense oligomers, including variant oligomers having 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, 97%, 98%, or 99% (including all integers in between) sequence identity or sequence homology to any one of SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41, and/or variants that differ from these sequences by about 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 nucleotides, preferably those variants that modulate NHR expression in a cell. Also included are oligonucleotides of any one or more of SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41, which comprise a suitable number of charged linkages, as described herein, e.g., up to about 1 per every 2-5 uncharged linkages, such as about 4-5 per every 10 uncharged linkages, and/or which comprise an Arg-rich peptide attached thereto, as also described herein.
  • The terms “morpholino oligomer” or “PMO” (phosphoramidate- or phosphorodiamidate morpholino oligomer) refer to an oligonucleotide analog composed of morpholino subunit structures, where (i) the structures are linked together by phosphorus-containing linkages, one to three atoms long, preferably two atoms long, and preferably uncharged or cationic, joining the morpholino nitrogen of one subunit to a 5′ exocyclic carbon of an adjacent subunit, and (ii) each morpholino ring bears a purine or pyrimidine or an equivalent base-pairing moiety effective to bind, by base specific hydrogen bonding, to a base in a polynucleotide. See, for example, the structure in FIG. 1A, which shows a preferred phosphorodiamidate linkage type. Variations can be made to this linkage as long as they do not interfere with binding or activity. For example, the oxygen attached to phosphorus may be substituted with sulfur (thiophosphorodiamidate). The 5′ oxygen may be substituted with amino or lower alkyl substituted amino. The pendant nitrogen attached to phosphorus may be unsubstituted, monosubstituted, or disubstituted with (optionally substituted) lower alkyl. See also the discussion of cationic linkages below. The purine or pyrimidine base pairing moiety is typically adenine, cytosine, guanine, uracil, thymine or inosine. The synthesis, structures, and binding characteristics of morpholino oligomers are detailed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,698,685, 5,217,866, 5,142,047, 5,034,506, 5,166,315, 5,521,063, and 5,506,337, and PCT Appn. Nos. PCT/US07/11435 (cationic linkages) and U.S. Ser. No. 08/012,804 (improved synthesis), all of which are incorporated herein by reference.
  • The term “oligonucleotide analog” refers to an oligonucleotide having (i) a modified backbone structure, e.g., a backbone other than the standard phosphodiester linkage found in natural oligo- and polynucleotides, and (ii) optionally, modified sugar moieties, e.g., morpholino moieties rather than ribose or deoxyribose moieties. Oligonucleotide analogs support bases capable of hydrogen bonding by Watson-Crick base pairing to standard polynucleotide bases, where the analog backbone presents the bases in a manner to permit such hydrogen bonding in a sequence-specific fashion between the oligonucleotide analog molecule and bases in a standard polynucleotide (e.g., single-stranded RNA or single-stranded DNA). Preferred analogs are those having a substantially uncharged, phosphorus containing backbone.
  • A substantially uncharged, phosphorus containing backbone in an oligonucleotide analog is one in which a majority of the subunit linkages, e.g., between 50-100%, typically at least 60% to 100% or 75% or 80% of its linkages, are uncharged, and contain a single phosphorous atom. Antisense oligonucleotides and oligonucleotide analogs may contain between about 8 and 40 subunits, typically about 8-25 subunits, and preferably about 12 to 25 subunits. In certain embodiments, oligonucleotides may have exact sequence complementarity to the target sequence or near complementarity, as defined below.
  • A “subunit” of an oligonucleotide refers to one nucleotide (or nucleotide analog) unit. The term may refer to the nucleotide unit with or without the attached intersubunit linkage, although, when referring to a “charged subunit”, the charge typically resides within the intersubunit linkage (e.g., a phosphate or phosphorothioate linkage or a cationic linkage, as shown in FIG. 1B).
  • The purine or pyrimidine base pairing moiety is typically adenine, cytosine, guanine, uracil, thymine or inosine. Also included are bases such as pyridin-4-one, pyridin-2-one, phenyl, pseudouracil, 2,4,6-trime115thoxy benzene, 3-methyl uracil, dihydrouridine, naphthyl, aminophenyl, 5-alkylcytidines (e.g., 5-methylcytidine), 5-alkyluridines (e.g., ribothymidine), 5-halouridine (e.g., 5-bromouridine) or 6-azapyrimidines or 6-alkylpyrimidines (e.g. 6-methyluridine), propyne, quesosine, 2-thiouridine, 4-thiouridine, wybutosine, wybutoxosine, 4-acetyltidine, 5-(carboxyhydroxymethyl)uridine, 5′-carboxymethylaminomethyl-2-thiouridine, 5-carboxymethylaminomethyluridine, β-D-galactosylqueosine, 1-methyladenosine, 1-methylinosine, 2,2-dimethylguanosine, 3-methylcytidine, 2-methyladenosine, 2-methylguanosine, N6-methyladenosine, 7-methylguanosine, 5-methoxyaminomethyl-2-thiouridine, 5-methylaminomethyluridine, 5-methylcarbonyhnethyluridine, 5-methyloxyuridine, 5-methyl-2-thiouridine, 2-methylthio-N6-isopentenyladenosine, β-D-mannosylqueosine, uridine-5-oxyacetic acid, 2-thiocytidine, threonine derivatives and others (Burgin et al., 1996, Biochemistry, 35, 14090; Uhlman & Peyman, supra). By “modified bases” in this aspect is meant nucleotide bases other than adenine (A), guanine (G), cytosine (C), thymine (T), and uracil (U), as illustrated above; such bases can be used at any position in the antisense molecule. Persons skilled in the art will appreciate that depending on the uses of the oligomers, Ts and Us are interchangeable. For instance, with other antisense chemistries such as 2′-O-methyl antisense oligonucleotides that are more RNA-like, the T bases may be shown as U (see, e.g., Sequence Listing).
  • An “amino acid subunit” or “amino acid residue” can refer to an α-amino acid residue (—CO—CHR—NH—) or a β- or other amino acid residue (e.g., —CO—(CH2)nCHR—NH—), where R is a side chain (which may include hydrogen) and n is 1 to 7, preferably 1 to 4.
  • The term “naturally occurring amino acid” refers to an amino acid present in proteins found in nature, such as the 20 (L)-amino acids utilized during protein biosynthesis as well as others such as 4-hydroxyproline, hydroxylysine, desmosine, isodesmosine, homocysteine, citrulline and ornithine. The term “non-natural amino acids” refers to those amino acids not present in proteins found in nature, examples include beta-alanine (β-Ala), 6-aminohexanoic acid (Ahx) and 6-aminopentanoic acid. Additional examples of “non-natural amino acids” include, without limitation, (D)-amino acids, norleucine, norvaline, p-fluorophenylalanine, ethionine and the like, which are known to a person skilled in the art.
  • By “isolated” is meant material that is substantially or essentially free from components that normally accompany it in its native state. For example, an “isolated polynucleotide” or “isolated oligonucleotide,” as used herein, may refer to a polynucleotide that has been purified or removed from the sequences that flank it in a naturally-occurring state, e.g., a DNA fragment that has been removed from the sequences that are normally adjacent to the fragment.
  • An “effective amount” or “therapeutically effective amount” refers to an amount of therapeutic compound, such as an antisense oligomer or RNA interference agent (e.g., siRNA), administered to a mammalian subject, either as a single dose or as part of a series of doses, which is effective to produce a desired therapeutic effect. For an antisense oligomer, this effect is typically brought about by inhibiting translation or natural splice-processing of a selected target sequence. An “effective amount,” targeted against an NHR, also relates to an amount effective to modulate expression of the NHR.
  • By “enhance” or “enhancing,” or “increase” or “increasing,” or “stimulate” or “stimulating,” refers generally to the ability of one or antisense or RNAi compounds or compositions to produce or cause a greater physiological response (i.e., downstream effects) in a cell or a subject, as compared to the response caused by either no antisense compound or a control compound. An “increased” or “enhanced” amount is typically a “statistically significant” amount, and may include an increase that is 1.1, 1.2, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 15, 20, 30, 40, 50 or more times (e.g., 500, 1000 times) (including all integers and decimal points in between and above 1), e.g., 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, etc.) the amount produced by no antisense compound (the absence of an agent) or a control compound.
  • The term “reduce” or “inhibit” may relate generally to the ability of one or more antisense or RNAi compounds of the invention to “decrease” a relevant physiological or cellular response, such as a symptom of a disease or condition described herein, as measured according to routine techniques in the diagnostic art. Relevant physiological or cellular responses (in vivo or in vitro) will be apparent to persons skilled in the art, and may include, for example, reductions in inflammation. A “decrease” in a response may be “statistically significant” as compared to the response produced by no antisense compound or a control composition, and may include a 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 100% decrease, including all integers in between.
  • The term “target sequence” refers to a portion of the target RNA against which the oligonucleotide or antisense agent is directed, that is, the sequence to which the oligonucleotide will hybridize by Watson-Crick base pairing of a complementary sequence. In certain embodiments, the target sequence may be a contiguous region of a pre-mRNA that includes both intron and exon target sequence. In certain other embodiments, the target sequence will consist exclusively of either intron or exon sequences.
  • The term “targeting sequence” or “antisense targeting sequence” refers to the sequence in an oligonucleotide or other antisense agent that is complementary (meaning, in addition, substantially complementary) to the target sequence in the RNA genome. The entire sequence, or only a portion, of the antisense compound may be complementary to the target sequence. For example, in an oligonucleotide having 20-30 bases, about 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, or 29 may be targeting sequences that are complementary to the target region. Typically, the targeting sequence is formed of contiguous bases, but may alternatively be formed of non-contiguous sequences that when placed together, e.g., from opposite ends of the oligonucleotide, constitute sequence that spans the target sequence.
  • The target and targeting sequences may be selected such that binding of the antisense compound is to a region of a NHR pre-mRNA that causes exon skipping of those exon or exons that encode the NHR ligand-binding domain.
  • Target and targeting sequences are described as “complementary” to one another when hybridization occurs in an antiparallel configuration. A targeting sequence may have “near” or “substantial” complementarity to the target sequence and still function for the purpose of the present invention, that is, it may still be functionally “complementary.” In certain embodiments, an oligonucleotide may have at most one mismatch with the target sequence out of 10 nucleotides, and preferably at most one mismatch out of 20. Alternatively, an oligonucleotide may have at least 90% sequence homology, and preferably at least 95% sequence homology, with the exemplary antisense targeting sequences described herein.
  • An oligonucleotide “specifically hybridizes” to a target polynucleotide if the oligomer hybridizes to the target under physiological conditions, with a Tm substantially greater than 45° C., preferably at least 50° C., and typically 60° C.-80° C. or higher. Such hybridization preferably corresponds to stringent hybridization conditions. At a given ionic strength and pH, the Tm is the temperature at which 50% of a target sequence hybridizes to a complementary polynucleotide. Again, such hybridization may occur with “near” or “substantial” complementarity of the antisense oligomer to the target sequence, as well as with exact complementarity.
  • “Homology” refers to the percentage number of amino acids that are identical or constitute conservative substitutions. Homology may be determined using sequence comparison programs such as GAP (Deveraux et al., 1984, Nucleic Acids Research 12, 387-395). In this way sequences of a similar or substantially different length to those cited herein could be compared by insertion of gaps into the alignment, such gaps being determined, for example, by the comparison algorithm used by GAP.
  • The recitations “sequence identity” or, for example, comprising a “sequence 50% identical to,” as used herein, refer to the extent that sequences are identical on a nucleotide-by-nucleotide basis or an amino acid-by-amino acid basis over a window of comparison. Thus, a “percentage of sequence identity” may be calculated by comparing two optimally aligned sequences over the window of comparison, determining the number of positions at which the identical nucleic acid base (e.g., A, T, C, G, I) or the identical amino acid residue (e.g., Ala, Pro, Ser, Thr, Gly, Val, Leu, Ile, Phe, Tyr, Trp, Lys, Arg, His, Asp, Glu, Asn, Gln, Cys and Met) occurs in both sequences to yield the number of matched positions, dividing the number of matched positions by the total number of positions in the window of comparison (i.e., the window size), and multiplying the result by 100 to yield the percentage of sequence identity.
  • Terms used to describe sequence relationships between two or more polynucleotides or polypeptides include “reference sequence,” “comparison window,” “sequence identity,” “percentage of sequence identity,” and “substantial identity”. A “reference sequence” is at least 8 or 10 but frequently 15 to 18 and often at least 25 monomer units, inclusive of nucleotides and amino acid residues, in length. Because two polynucleotides may each comprise (1) a sequence (i.e., only a portion of the complete polynucleotide sequence) that is similar between the two polynucleotides, and (2) a sequence that is divergent between the two polynucleotides, sequence comparisons between two (or more) polynucleotides are typically performed by comparing sequences of the two polynucleotides over a “comparison window” to identify and compare local regions of sequence similarity. A “comparison window” refers to a conceptual segment of at least 6 contiguous positions, usually about 50 to about 100, more usually about 100 to about 150 in which a sequence is compared to a reference sequence of the same number of contiguous positions after the two sequences are optimally aligned. The comparison window may comprise additions or deletions (i.e., gaps) of about 20% or less as compared to the reference sequence (which does not comprise additions or deletions) for optimal alignment of the two sequences. Optimal alignment of sequences for aligning a comparison window may be conducted by computerized implementations of algorithms (GAP, BESTFIT, FASTA, and TFASTA in the Wisconsin Genetics Software Package Release 7.0, Genetics Computer Group, 575 Science Drive Madison, Wis., USA) or by inspection and the best alignment (i.e., resulting in the highest percentage homology over the comparison window) generated by any of the various methods selected. Reference also may be made to the BLAST family of programs as for example disclosed by Altschul et al., 1997, Nucl. Acids Res. 25:3389. A detailed discussion of sequence analysis can be found in Unit 19.3 of Ausubel et al., “Current Protocols in Molecular Biology,” John Wiley & Sons Inc, 1994-1998, Chapter 15.
  • A “nuclease-resistant” oligomeric molecule (oligomer) refers to one whose backbone is substantially resistant to nuclease cleavage, in non-hybridized or hybridized form; by common extracellular and intracellular nucleases in the body; that is, the oligomer shows little or no nuclease cleavage under normal nuclease conditions in the body to which the oligomer is exposed.
  • A “heteroduplex” refers to a duplex between an antisense oligonucleotide and the complementary portion of a target RNA. A “nuclease-resistant heteroduplex” refers to a heteroduplex formed by the binding of an antisense oligomer to its complementary target, such that the heteroduplex is substantially resistant to in vivo degradation by intracellular and extracellular nucleases, such as RNaseH, which are capable of cutting double-stranded RNA/RNA or RNA/DNA complexes.
  • A “base-specific intracellular binding event involving a target RNA” refers to the specific binding of an antisense oligonucleotide to a target RNA sequence inside a cell. The base specificity of such binding is sequence dependent. For example, a single-stranded polynucleotide can specifically bind to a single-stranded polynucleotide that is complementary in sequence.
  • As used herein, the term “body fluid” encompasses a variety of sample types obtained from a subject including, urine, saliva, plasma, blood, spinal fluid, or other sample of biological origin, such as skin cells or dermal debris, and may refer to cells or cell fragments suspended therein, or the liquid medium and its solutes.
  • The term “relative amount” is used where a comparison is made between a test measurement and a control measurement. The relative amount of a reagent forming a complex in a reaction is the amount reacting with a test specimen, compared with the amount reacting with a control specimen. The control specimen may be run separately in the same assay, or it may be part of the same sample (for example, normal tissue surrounding a malignant area in a tissue section).
  • “Treatment” of an individual or a cell is any type of intervention provided as a means to alter the natural course of a disease or pathology in the individual or cell. Treatment includes, but is not limited to, administration of, e.g., a pharmaceutical composition, and may be performed either prophylactically, or subsequent to the initiation of a pathologic event or contact with an etiologic agent. Treatment includes any desirable effect on the symptoms or pathology of a disease or condition associated with inflammation, among others described herein.
  • Also included are “prophylactic” treatments, which can be directed to reducing the rate of progression of the disease or condition being treated, delaying the onset of that disease or condition, or reducing the severity of its onset. “Treatment” or “prophylaxis” does not necessarily indicate complete eradication, cure, or prevention of the disease or condition, or associated symptoms thereof.
  • An agent is “actively taken up by mammalian cells” when the agent can enter the cell by a mechanism other than passive diffusion across the cell membrane. The agent may be transported, for example, by “active transport,” referring to transport of agents across a mammalian cell membrane by e.g., an ATP-dependent transport mechanism, or by “facilitated transport,” referring to transport of antisense agents across the cell membrane by a transport mechanism that requires binding of the agent to a transport protein, which then facilitates passage of the bound agent across the membrane. For both active and facilitated transport, oligonucleotide analogs preferably have a substantially uncharged backbone, as defined below.
  • Alternatively, the antisense compound may be formulated in a complexed form, such as an agent having an anionic backbone complexed with cationic lipids or liposomes, which can be taken into cells by an endocytotic mechanism. The antisense oligonucleotide may also be conjugated, e.g., at its 5′ or 3′ end, to an arginine-rich peptide, such as a portion of the HIV TAT protein, polyarginine, or to combinations of arginine and other amino acids including the non-natural amino acids 6-aminohexanoic acid (Ahx) and beta-alanine (β-Ala). Exemplary arginine-rich delivery peptides are listed as SEQ ID NOs:18-26. These exemplary arginine-rich delivery peptides facilitate transport into the target host cell as described (Moulton, Nelson et al. 2004).
  • Hence, included are methods of treating a subject in need thereof, by administering one or more antisense oligomers of the present invention (e.g., SEQ ID NOS:1-17 or 34-41, and variants thereof), optionally as part of a pharmaceutical formulation or dosage form, to a subject in need thereof. A “subject,” as used herein, may include any animal that exhibits a symptom, or is at risk for exhibiting a symptom, which can be treated with an antisense compound of the invention, such as a subject that has or is at risk for having an inflammatory condition. Suitable subjects (patients) include laboratory animals (such as mouse, rat, rabbit, or guinea pig), farm animals, and domestic animals or pets (such as a cat or dog). Non-human primates and, preferably, human patients, are included.
  • Also contemplated are alternate methods of RNA interference (RNAi), such as those involving double stranded RNA-molecules, or dsRNA. The term “double-stranded” means two separate nucleic acid strands comprising a region in which at least a portion of the strands are sufficiently complementary to hydrogen bond and form a duplex structure. The term “duplex” or “duplex structure” refers to the region of a double stranded molecule wherein the two separate strands are substantially complementary, and thus hybridize to each other.
  • “dsRNA” refers to a ribonucleic acid molecule having a duplex structure comprising two complementary and anti-parallel nucleic acid strands (i.e., the sense and antisense strands). Not all nucleotides of a dsRNA must exhibit Watson-Crick base pairs; the two RNA strands may be substantially complementary. The RNA strands may have the same or a different number of nucleotides. The term “dsRNA” also includes “siRNA” or short interfering RNA.
  • It will be understood that the term “ribonucleotide” or “nucleotide” can, in the case of a modified RNA or nucleotide surrogate, also refer to a modified nucleotide, or surrogate replacement moiety at one or more positions. Thus, the dsRNA is or includes a region which is at least partially complementary to the target RNA. In certain embodiments, the dsRNA is fully complementary to the target RNA. It is not necessary that there be perfect complementarity between the dsRNA and the target, but the correspondence must be sufficient to enable the dsRNA, or a cleavage product thereof, to direct sequence specific silencing, such as by RNAi cleavage of the target RNA. Complementarity, or degree of homology with the target strand, is most critical in the antisense strand. While perfect complementarity, particularly in the antisense strand, is often desired some embodiments can include one or more but preferably 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, or fewer mismatches with respect to the target RNA. The mismatches are most tolerated in the terminal regions, and if present are preferably in a terminal region or regions, e.g., within 6, 5, 4, or 3 nucleotides of the 5′ and/or 3′ terminus. The sense strand need only be substantially complementary with the antisense strand to maintain the overall double-strand character of the molecule.
  • As used herein, “modified dsRNA” refers to a dsRNA molecule that comprises at least one alteration that renders it more resistant to nucleases (e.g., protein kinase) than an identical dsRNA molecule that recognizes the same target RNA. Modified dsRNAs may include a single-stranded nucleotide overhang and/or at least one substituted nucleotide.
  • As used herein, a “nucleotide overhang” refers to the unpaired nucleotide or nucleotides that protrude from the duplex structure when a 3′-end of one RNA strand extends beyond the 5′-end of the other complementary strand, or vice versa. “Blunt” or “blunt end” means that there are no unpaired nucleotides at that end of the dsRNA, i.e., no nucleotide overhang. A “blunt ended” dsRNA is a dsRNA that is double stranded over its entire length, i.e., no nucleotide overhang at either end of the molecule.
  • The term “terminal base pair,” as used herein, refers to the last nucleotide base pair on one end of the duplex region of a double-stranded molecule. For example, if a dsRNA or other molecule is blunt ended (i.e., has no nucleotide overhangs), the last nucleotide base pairs at both ends of the molecule are terminal base pairs. Where a dsRNA or other molecule has a nucleotide overhang at one or both ends of the duplex structure, the last nucleotide base pair(s) immediately adjacent the nucleotide overhang(s) is the terminal base pair at that end(s) of the molecule.
  • Also included are vector delivery systems that are capable of expressing the oligomeric, NHR-targeted exon skipping sequences of the present invention, such as vectors that express a polynucleotide sequence comprising any one or more of SEQ ID NOS:2-17 or 34-41, or variants thereof, as described herein, or that express a polynucleotide sequence that is complementary to any or more of the target sequences in Table 1 or set forth in SEQ ID NO:1.
  • By “vector” or “nucleic acid construct” is meant a polynucleotide molecule, preferably a DNA molecule derived, for example, from a plasmid, bacteriophage, yeast or virus, into which a polynucleotide can be inserted or cloned. A vector preferably contains one or more unique restriction sites and can be capable of autonomous replication in a defined host cell including a target cell or tissue or a progenitor cell or tissue thereof, or be integrable with the genome of the defined host such that the cloned sequence is reproducible. Accordingly, the vector can be an autonomously replicating vector, i.e., a vector that exists as an extra-chromosomal entity, the replication of which is independent of chromosomal replication, e.g., a linear or closed circular plasmid, an extra-chromosomal element, a mini-chromosome, or an artificial chromosome. The vector can contain any means for assuring self-replication. Alternatively, the vector can be one which, when introduced into the host cell, is integrated into the genome and replicated together with the chromosome(s) into which it has been integrated.
  • A vector or nucleic acid construct system can comprise a single vector or plasmid, two or more vectors or plasmids, which together contain the total DNA to be introduced into the genome of the host cell, or a transposon. The choice of the vector will typically depend on the compatibility of the vector with the host cell into which the vector is to be introduced. In the present case, the vector or nucleic acid construct is preferably one which is operably functional in a mammalian cell, such as a muscle cell. The vector can also include a selection marker such as an antibiotic or drug resistance gene, or a reporter gene (i.e., green fluorescent protein, luciferase), that can be used for selection or identification of suitable transformants or transfectants. Exemplary delivery systems may include viral vector systems (i.e., viral-mediated transduction) including, but not limited to, retroviral (e.g., lentiviral) vectors, adenoviral vectors, adeno-associated viral vectors, and herpes viral vectors, among others known in the art.
  • The term “operably linked” as used herein means placing an oligomer-encoding sequence under the regulatory control of a promoter, which then controls the transcription of the oligomer.
  • A wild-type gene or gene product is that which is most frequently observed in a population and is thus arbitrarily designed the “normal” or “wild-type” form of the gene.
  • “Alkyl” refers to a fully saturated monovalent radical containing carbon and hydrogen, which may be branched, linear, or cyclic (cycloalkyl). Examples of alkyl groups are methyl, ethyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, n-heptyl, isopropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclopentyl, ethylcyclopentyl, and cyclohexyl. Generally preferred are alkyl groups having one to six carbon atoms, referred to as “lower alkyl”, and exemplified by methyl, ethyl, n-butyl, i-butyl, t-butyl, isoamyl, n-pentyl, and isopentyl. In one embodiment, lower alkyl refers to C1 to C4 alkyl.
  • “Alkenyl” refers to an unsaturated monovalent radical containing carbon and hydrogen, which may be branched, linear, or cyclic. The alkenyl group may be monounsaturated or polyunsaturated. Generally preferred are alkenyl groups having one to six carbon atoms, referred to as “lower alkenyl.”
  • “Alkynyl” refers to an unsaturated straight or branched chain hydrocarbon radical containing from 2 to 18 carbons comprising at least one carbon to carbon triple bond. Examples include without limitation ethynyl, propynyl, iso-propynyl, butynyl, iso-butynyl, tert-butynyl, pentynyl and hexynyl. The term “lower alkynyl” refers to an alkynyl group, as defined herein, containing between 2 and 8 carbons.
  • “Cycloalkyl” refers to a mono- or poly-cyclic alkyl radical. Examples include without limitation cyclobutyl, cycopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl and cyclooctyl.
  • “Aryl” refers to a substituted or unsubstituted monovalent aromatic radical, generally having a single ring (e.g., phenyl) or two condensed rings (e.g., naphthyl). This term includes heteroaryl groups, which are aromatic ring groups having one or more nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur atoms in the ring, such as furyl, pyrrolyl, pyridyl, and indolyl. By “substituted” is meant that one or more ring hydrogens in the aryl group is replaced with a halide such as fluorine, chlorine, or bromine; with a lower alkyl group containing one or two carbon atoms; nitro, amino, methylamino, dimethylamino, methoxy, halomethoxy, halomethyl, or haloethyl. Preferred substituents include halogen, methyl, ethyl, and methoxy. Generally preferred are aryl groups having a single ring.
  • “Aralkyl” refers to an alkyl, preferably lower (C1-C4, more preferably C1-C2) alkyl, substituent which is further substituted with an aryl group; examples are benzyl (—CH2C6H5) and phenethyl (—CH2CH2C6H5).
  • “Thioalkoxy” refers to a radical of the formula —SRc where Rc is an alkyl radical as defined herein. The term “lower thioalkoxy” refers to an alkoxy group, as defined herein, containing between 1 and 8 carbons.
  • “Alkoxy” refers to a radical of the formula —ORda where Rd is an alkyl radical as defined herein. The term “lower alkoxy” refers to an alkoxy group, as defined herein, containing between 1 and 8 carbons. Examples of alkoxy groups include, without limitation, methoxy and ethoxy.
  • “Alkoxyalkyl” refers to an alkyl group substituted with an alkoxy group.
  • “Carbonyl” refers to the —C(═O)— radical.
  • “Guanidynyl” refers to the H2N(C═NH2)—NH— radical.
  • “Amidinyl” refers to the H2N(C═NH2)CH— radical.
  • “Amino” refers to the —NH2 radical.
  • “Alkylamino” refers to a radical of the formula —NHRd or —NRdRd where each Rd is, independently, an alkyl radical as defined herein. The term “lower alkylamino” refers to an alkylamino group, as defined herein, containing between 1 and 8 carbons.
  • “Heterocycle” means a 5- to 7-membered monocyclic, or 7- to 10-membered bicyclic, heterocyclic ring which is either saturated, unsaturated, or aromatic, and which contains from 1 to 4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur, and wherein the nitrogen and sulfur heteroatoms may be optionally oxidized, and the nitrogen heteroatom may be optionally quaternized, including bicyclic rings in which any of the above heterocycles are fused to a benzene ring. The heterocycle may be attached via any heteroatom or carbon atom. Preferably, the ring atoms include 3 to 6 carbon atoms. Such heterocycles include, for example, pyrrolidine, piperidine, piperazine, and morpholine.
  • Heterocycles include heteroaryls as defined below. Thus, in addition to the heteroaryls listed below, heterocycles also include morpholinyl, pyrrolidinonyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, piperizynyl, hydantoinyl, valerolactamyl, oxiranyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydropyridinyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl, tetrahydropyrimidinyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl, and the like.
  • “Heteroaryl” means an aromatic heterocycle ring of 5- to 10 members and having at least one heteroatom selected from nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur, and containing at least 1 carbon atom, including both mono- and bicyclic ring systems. Representative heteroaryls are pyridyl, furyl, benzofuranyl, thiophenyl, benzothiophenyl, quinolinyl, pyrrolyl, indolyl, oxazolyl, benzoxazolyl, imidazolyl, benzimidazolyl, thiazolyl, benzothiazolyl, isoxazolyl, pyrazolyl, isothiazolyl, pyridazinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, triazinyl, cinnolinyl, phthalazinyl, and quinazolinyl.
  • The term “substituted”, with respect to an alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, aralkyl, or alkaryl group, refers to replacement of a hydrogen atom with a heteroatom-containing substituent, such as, for example, halogen, hydroxy, alkoxy, thiol, alkylthio, amino, alkylamino, imino, oxo (keto), nitro, cyano, or various acids or esters such as carboxylic, sulfonic, or phosphonic.
  • The term “substituted”, particularly with respect to an alkyl, alkoxy, thioalkoxy, or alkylamino group, refers to replacement of a hydrogen atom on carbon with a heteroatom-containing substituent, such as, for example, halogen, hydroxy, alkoxy, thiol, alkylthio, amino, alkylamino, imino, oxo (keto), nitro, cyano, or various acids or esters such as carboxylic, sulfonic, or phosphonic. It may also refer to replacement of a hydrogen atom on a heteroatom (such as an amine hydrogen) with an alkyl, carbonyl or other carbon containing group.
  • In certain embodiments, the terms “optionally substituted alkyl”, “optionally substituted alkenyl”, “optionally substituted alkoxy”, “optionally substituted thioalkoxy”, “optionally substituted alkyl amino”, “optionally substituted lower alkyl”, “optionally substituted lower alkenyl”, “optionally substituted lower alkoxy”, “optionally substituted lower thioalkoxy”, “optionally substituted lower alkyl amino” and “optionally substituted heterocyclyl” mean that, when substituted, at least one hydrogen atom is replaced with a substituent. In the case of an oxo substituent (═O) two hydrogen atoms are replaced. In this regard, substituents include: deuterium, optionally substituted alkyl, optionally substituted alkenyl, optionally substituted alkynyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted heterocycle, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, oxo, halogen, —CN, —ORx, NRxRy, NRxC(═O)Ry, NRxSO2Ry, —NRxC(═O)NRxRy, C(═O)Rx, C(═O)ORx, C(═O)NRxRy, —SOmRx and —SOmNRxRy, wherein m is 0, 1 or 2, Rx and Ry are the same or different and independently hydrogen, optionally substituted alkyl, optionally substituted alkenyl, optionally substituted alkynyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted heterocycle or optionally substituted cycloalkyl and each of said optionally substituted alkyl, optionally substituted alkenyl, optionally substituted alkynyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted heterocycle and optionally substituted cycloalkyl substituents may be further substituted with one or more of oxo, halogen, —CN, —ORx, NRxRy, NRxC(═O)Ry, NRxSO2Ry, —NRxC(═O)NRxRy, C(═O)Rx, C(═O)ORx, C(═O)NRxRy, —SOmRx and —SOmNRxRy.
  • The selection of targeting sequences capable of inducing exon skipping of those exons that encode all or part of an NHR ligand-binding domain are discussed below.
  • Targeted NHR Genes
  • Embodiments of the present invention are based, in part, on the discovery that antisense oligomer-induced exon skipping of either of the two exons that encode the ligand-binding domain of the glucocorticoid receptor (GR) result in the induction of an activated, ligand-independent GR (liGR). It is fully contemplated that similar exon skipping strategies can be employed to induce ligand-independent steroid receptors other than GR and, more generally, ligand-independent NHRs as a whole. A list of human NHRSF targets and their known ligands that are considered targets for the compositions and methods of this invention are shown below in Table 1 (see Gronemeyer, Gustafsson et al. 2004). The sequences of these NHRSF targets are known in the art.
  • TABLE 1
    Nuclear Hormone Receptors
    Name Abbrev. Nomenclature Ligand
    Thyroid hormone receptor TRα NR1A1 Thyroid hormone
    TRβ NR1A2
    Retinoic acid receptor RARα NR1B1 Retinoic acid
    RARβ NR1B2
    RARγ NR1B3
    Peroxisome proliferator- activated PPARα NR1C1 Fatty acids, leukotriene B4, fibrates
    receptor PPARβ NR1C2 Fatty acids Fatty acids,
    PPARγ NR1C3 prostaglandin J2,
    Reverse erbA Rev-erbα NR1D1 Orphan
    Rev-erbβ NR1D1
    RAR-related orphan receptor RORα NR1F1 Cholesterol, cholesteryl sulphate
    RORβ NR1F2 Retinoic acid
    RORγ NR1F3
    Liver X receptor LXRα NR1H3 Oxysterols, T0901317, GW3965
    LXRβ NR1H2 Oxysterols, T0901317, GW3965
    Farnesoid X receptor FXRα NR1H4 Bile acids, Fexaramine Lanosterol
    FXRβ NR1H5
    Vitamin D receptor VDR NR1I1 1,25-dihydroxy vitamin D3,
    litocholic acid
    Pregnane X receptor PXR NR1I2 Xenobiotics, PCN
    Constitutive androstane receptor CAR NR1I3 Xenobiotics, phenobarbital
    Human nuclear factor 4 HNF4α NR2A1 Orphan
    HNF4γ NR2A2
    Retinoid X receptor RXRα NR2B1 Retinoic acid
    RXRβ NR2B2
    RXRγ NR2B3
    Testis receptor TR2 NR2C1 Orphan
    TR4 NR2C2
    Tailless TLL NR2E2 Orphan
    Photoreceptor-specific nuclear PNR NR2E3 Orphan
    receptor
    Chicken ovalbumin upstream COUP-TFI NR2F1 Orphan
    promoter-transcription factor COUP-TFII NR2F2
    ErbA2-related gene-2 EAR2 NR2F6 Orphan
    Oestrogen receptor ERα NR3A1 Oestradiol-17□, tamoxifen,
    ERβ NR3A2 raloxifene
    Oestrogen receptor-related ERRα NR3B1 Orphan DES, 4-OH tamoxifen DES,
    receptor ERRβ NR3B2 4-OH tamoxifen
    ERRγ NR3B3
    Glucocorticoid receptor GR NR3C1 Cortisol, dexamethasone, RU486
    Mineralocorticoid receptor MR NR3C2 Aldosterone, spirolactone
    Progesterone receptor PR NR3C3 Progesterone, medroxyprogesterone
    acetate, RU486
    Androgen receptor AR NR3C4 Testosterone, flutamide
    NGF-induced factor B NGFIB NR4A1 Orphan
    Nur related factor 1 NURR1 NR4A2 Orphan
    Neuron-derived orphan receptor 1 NOR1 NR4A3 Orphan
    Steroidogenic factor 1 SF1 NR5A1 Orphan
    Liver receptor homologous LRH1 NR5A2 Orphan
    protein 1
    Germ cell nuclear factor GCNF NR6A1 Orphan
    DSS-AHC critical region on the DAX1 NR0B1 Orphan
    chromosome, gene 1
    Short heterodimeric partner SHP NR0B2 Orphan
    Aryl hydrocarbon receptor AHR Aromatic hydrocarbons
  • Exemplary members of the steroid hormone receptor group of NHRs and their ligand binding domains are described in more detail below.
  • A. Glucocorticoid Receptor (GR)
  • The GR is a ligand-activated transcription factor belonging to the NHRSF. It binds with high affinity to cortisol and other glucocorticoids. GR is expressed in almost every cell in the body and regulates genes controlling a wide variety of processes including the development, metabolism, and immune response of the organism. In the absence of hormone, GR is complexed with a variety of heat shock proteins in the cytosol. The binding of the glucocorticoids results in release of the heat shock proteins and transforms it to its active state. One mechanism of action of GR is by direct activation of gene transcription. The activated form of GR forms dimers, translocates into the nucleus, and binds to specific glucocorticoid responsive elements (GRE), activating gene transcription.
  • The interaction of a glucocorticoid with GR can cause GR to induce transcription of certain genes. This induction of transcription is termed transactivation. Transactivation typically requires dimerization of GR and binding to a glucocorticoid response element (GRE).
  • GR can also function as a repressor of other gene transcription activators, such as NF-κB and AF-1 by directly binding to them, and blocking the expression of their activated genes. It has been shown that glucocorticoids exert their anti-inflammatory activity via the inhibition by GR of the transcription factors NF-κB and AP-1. This inhibition is termed transrepression. By this mechanism, GR is able to prevent the transcription of pro-inflammatory genes, including interleukins IL-1B, IL-4, IL-5, and IL-8, chemokines, cytokines, GM-CSF, and TNF genes, among others.
  • It has also been shown that the primary mechanism for inhibition of these transcription factors by GR is via a direct physical interaction. This interaction alters the transcription factor complex and inhibits the ability of NF-κB and AP-1 to stimulate transcription. NF-κB and AP-1 (c-Fos/c-Jun) play key roles in the initiation and perpetuation of inflammatory and immunological disorders and are involved in regulating the expression of a number of important inflammatory and immunomodulatory genes including cytokines, chemokines, adhesion molecules, inflammatory proteins and many others (e.g., TNF-alpha, IL-1, IL-2, IL-5, adhesion molecules, Cox-2, and others (Gronemeyer, Gustafsson et al. 2004; Newton, Leigh et al. 2010).
  • Like other members of the NHRSF of ligand-activated transcription factors, GR has a central well conserved DNA binding domain (DBD), a variable N-terminal domain, a flexible hinge and a C-terminal ligand binding domain (LBD). The LBD also functions for dimerization and chaperone protein association. Recent studies using a transgenic GR dimerization defective mouse which cannot bind DNA have shown that the transactivation (DNA binding) activities of GR could be separated from the transrepressive (non-DNA binding) effect of GR. These studies also indicate that many of the side effects of glucocorticoid therapy are due to the ability of GR to induce transcription of various genes involved in metabolism, whereas, transrepression, which does not require DNA binding leads to suppression of inflammation. See, e.g., Newton, et al (Newton, Leigh et al. 2010).
  • Given the functional separation of GR transactivation and transrepression, certain embodiments of the present invention therefore relate to methods of modulating the splicing of GR to produce an altered GR transcript that encodes a GR protein with reduced transactivation activity, normal or increased transrepression activity, or both. These and related embodiments would reduce inflammation without the side effects of typical glucocorticoid therapy.
  • B. Progesterone Receptor (Pr)
  • The PR is a member of the NHRSF of ligand dependent transcription factors, mediating the biological actions of progesterone. PR functions in a variety of biological processes including development of the mammary gland, regulating cell cycle progression, protein processing, and metabolism. When no binding hormone is present the carboxyl terminal inhibits transcription. Binding to a hormone induces a structural change that removes the inhibitory action. After progesterone binds to the receptor, PR forms a dimer and the complex enters the nucleus where it interacts with the hormone response element (HRE) in the promoters of progesterone responsive genes and alters their transcription. In addition, rapid actions of PR that occur independent of transcription, have also been observed in several tissues like brain, liver, mammary gland and spermatozoa. There are two natural PR isoforms called PR-A and PR-B. PR-B has an additional stretch of 164 amino acids at the N terminus. The extra domain in PR-B performs activation functions by recruiting coactivators that could not be recruited by PR-A. Like other members of the NHRSF of ligand-activated transcription factors, PR has a central well conserved DNA binding domain (DBD), a variable N-terminal domain, a flexible hinge and a C-terminal ligand-binding domain (LBD). The LBD is not only involved in binding to progesterone, but also involved in coactivator binding and dimerization.
  • C. Androgen Receptor
  • The AR is activated by binding either of the androgenic hormones, testosterone or dihydrotestosterone, which are responsible for male primary sexual characteristics and for secondary male characteristics, respectively. The primary mechanism of action of ARs is by direct regulation of gene transcription. The binding of an androgen results in a conformational change in AR which causes its transport from the cytosol into the cell nucleus, and dimerization. The receptor dimer binds to a hormone response element of AR-regulated genes and modulates their expression. Another mode of action is independent on interactions with DNA. The receptors interact directly with signal transduction proteins in the cytoplasm, causing rapid changes in cell function, such as ion transport. Like other members of the NHRSF of ligand-activated transcription factors, AR has a central well conserved DNA binding domain (DBD), a variable N-terminal domain, a flexible hinge and a C-terminal ligand binding domain (LBD). The LBD is not only involved in binding to androgen, but also involved in binding of coactivator proteins and dimerization. A ligand dependent nuclear export signal is also present at the ligand binding domain.
  • NHR Target Selection
  • In certain embodiments, the exons encoding ligand binding domains of the NHRs are the antisense or RNAi targets of the present invention; however, other exons can also be targeted. For NHRs generally, antisense agents can be targeted against, or be complementary to, a variety of regions in a pre-processed mRNA. For instance, certain antisense or RNAi agents may comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to a region that overlaps the splice junction of a splice donor (SD) or splice acceptor (SA) site of exon 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, or 12 of a NHR in Table 1, and is complementary to a portion of an exonic region (e.g., 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, or 30 nucleotides) and a portion of an intronic region (e.g., 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, nucleotides) of the pre-processed mRNA.
  • Certain exemplary antisense or RNAi agents may comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to an exonic region defined by the first 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, or 100 nucleotides (or ranges such as the first 10-30, 20-40, 30-50, 40-60, 50-70, 60-80, 80-100 nucleotides) immediately downstream of the splice acceptor site of exon 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, or 12 of a NHR in Table 1, but either does not overlap with the splice junction, or overlaps with the splice junction and is complementary to about 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 nucleotides of the proximal (upstream) intron. Some exemplary antisense or RNAi agents may comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to an exonic region defined by the first 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, or 100 nucleotides (or ranges such as the first 10-30, 20-40, 30-50, 40-60, 50-70, 60-80, 80-100 nucleotides) immediately upstream of the splice donor site of exon 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, or 12 of a selected NHR in Table 1, but either does not overlap with the splice junction, or overlaps with the splice junction and is complementary to about 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 nucleotides of the proximal (downstream) intron. Certain antisense or RNAi agents are complementary to at least about 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30 or more contiguous or non-contiguous nucleotides within these regions. These targeting strategies can be applied to any of the NHR genes described herein (see, e.g., Table 1).
  • An exemplary gene that forms the basis of the experimental evidence that supports this aspect of invention is the glucocorticoid receptor (GR) gene. The exon structure of the murine and human GR genes is shown in FIG. 2 along with the structure of the human progesterone receptor gene. Human GR contains about 9 coding exons. The exons encoding the ligand binding domains of each of the genes in FIG. 2 are indicated with arrows. Certain experiments described herein were conducted in rats, using antisense oligonucleotides targeted against either the murine GR exons 6 or 7 (the murine and rat target sequences are identical) (see, e.g., SEQ ID NOs: 16 and 13, respectively). The target sequence for the muSA7 compound is identical in mice, rats and humans. Exemplary sequences for targeting the human GR exons 5 and 6 are listed herein as SEQ ID NOs: 2-9 (exon 5) and SEQ ID NOs: 10-14 (exon 6). The location of these targeting sequences relative to the human GR exon 5 and 6 splice acceptor (SA) or splice donor sites is shown in FIG. 3. Hence, certain antisense or RNAi agents comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to a region of exons 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 of human GR, as described herein. Certain preferred targets include exons 5, 6, or 7.
  • In certain embodiments, the exons in the carboxy-terminal domain of the receptor gene are candidates for selection as targets of the invention. The exemplary target exons shown in FIG. 2 for GR and PR are instructive in the selection of target sequences and the design of targeting oligomers for other NHR genes. The two or three exons immediately upstream of the 3′ terminal exon are preferred. Listed as SEQ ID NO: 1 in the Sequence Listing is a region of human GR pre-mRNA extending 70 bases upstream of exon 5 through intron 5 and exon 6 and extending 70 bases into intron 6. This sequence illustrates a preferred target sequence or region for inducing exon skipping of the two exons encoding the GR ligand-binding domain.
  • Similar sequences for other NHR genes (see Table 1) can be identified and used by skilled artisans in practicing the invention. For instance, the human PR and AR genes have about 8 coding exons, and the TR gene as about 10 coding exons. Certain antisense or RNAi agents may thus comprise a targeting sequence that is complementary to a defined region of exons 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8 of human PR or AR, or that is complementary to a defined region of exons 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 of human TR, as described herein.
  • In certain embodiments, antisense targeting sequences are designed to hybridize to a region of one or more of the target sequences listed in Table 1, such as an exon, an intron, an exon-intron junction, or a splice junction. The pre-mRNA sequences of these target genes are known in the art. In certain embodiments, the antisense sequences are designed to skip selected exons of a NHR such as GR, and produce an altered (typically by deletion) but functional protein. Exemplary targets for exon-skipping include exons that encode at least a portion of an N-terminal activation or regulatory domain, a DNA-binding domain, a ligand binding domain, and/or a C-terminal domain. Also contemplated is the targeting of any combination of such exons or domains.
  • In certain embodiments, a particular function of the NHR can be modulated by such an approach. For instance, certain embodiments include the targeting of selected exons of an NHR such as GR to alter (e.g., delete) at least a portion of a domain associated with its transactivation-related activities (i.e., transcriptional activation), its transrepression-related activities, or both, and thereby modulate one or both of these activities. Certain exemplary embodiments increase or agonize the transactivation activities of an NHR such as GR. Other embodiments decrease or antagonize the transactivation activities of an NHR such as GR. Certain embodiments increase or agonize the transrepression activities of an NHR such as GR. Other embodiments decrease or antagonize the transrepression activities of an NHR such as GR. Specific embodiments agonize the transactivation activities of an NHR such as GR, and also antagonize the transrepression activities of the same NHR. Preferred embodiments antagonize the transactivation activities of an NHR such as GR, and also agonize the transrepression activities of the same NHR.
  • Selected antisense targeting sequences can be made shorter, e.g., about 12 bases, or longer, e.g., about 40 bases, and include a small number of mismatches, as long as the sequence is sufficiently complementary to effect translation, splicing, and/or other form of inhibition upon hybridization with the target, and forms with the target RNA, a heteroduplex having a Tm of 45° C. or greater.
  • In certain embodiments, the degree of complementarity between the target and antisense targeting sequence is sufficient to form a stable duplex. The region of complementarity of the antisense oligomers with the target RNA sequence may be as short as 8-11 bases, but is preferably 12-15 bases or more, e.g., 12-20 bases, 12-25, or 15-25 bases, including all integers in between these ranges. An antisense oligomer of about 14-15 bases is generally long enough to have a unique complementary sequence in the target mRNA. In certain embodiments, a minimum length of complementary bases may be required to achieve the requisite binding Tm, as discussed below.
  • In certain embodiments, oligomers as long as 40 bases may be suitable, where at least a minimum number of bases, e.g., 10-12 bases, are complementary to the target sequence. In general, however, facilitated or active uptake in cells is optimized at oligomer lengths less than about 30. For PMO oligomers, described further below, an optimum balance of binding stability and uptake generally occurs at lengths of 18-25 bases. Included are antisense oligomers (e.g., PNAs, LNAs, 2′-OMe, MOE) and PMO oligomers that consist of about 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, or 40 bases, in which at least about 6, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, or 40 contiguous or non-contiguous bases are complementary to a target sequence of Table 1 or set forth in SEQ ID NO:1, or variants thereof.
  • In certain embodiments, antisense oligomers may be 100% complementary to the NHR nucleic acid target sequence, or they may include mismatches, e.g., to accommodate variants, as long as a heteroduplex formed between the oligomer and the target sequence is sufficiently stable to withstand the action of cellular nucleases and other modes of degradation which may occur in vivo. Oligomer backbones which are less susceptible to cleavage by nucleases are discussed below. Mismatches, if present, are less destabilizing toward the end regions of the hybrid duplex than in the middle. The number of mismatches allowed will depend on the length of the oligomer, the percentage of G:C base pairs in the duplex, and the position of the mismatch(es) in the duplex, according to well understood principles of duplex stability. Although such an antisense oligomer is not necessarily 100% complementary to the target sequence, it is effective to stably and specifically bind to the target sequence, such that a biological activity of the nucleic acid target, e.g., expression of NHR protein(s), is modulated.
  • The stability of the duplex formed between an oligomer and a target sequence is a function of the binding Tm and the susceptibility of the duplex to cellular enzymatic cleavage. The Tm of an antisense compound with respect to complementary-sequence RNA may be measured by conventional methods, such as those described by Hames et al., Nucleic Acid Hybridization, IRL Press, 1985, pp. 107-108 or as described in Miyada C. G. and Wallace R. B., 1987, Oligonucleotide hybridization techniques, Methods Enzymol. Vol. 154 pp. 94-107. In certain embodiments, antisense oligomer may have a binding Tm, with respect to a complementary-sequence RNA, of greater than body temperature and preferably greater than 50° C. Tm's in the range 60-80° C. or greater are preferred. According to well known principles, the Tm of an oligomer compound, with respect to a complementary-based RNA hybrid, can be increased by increasing the ratio of C:G paired bases in the duplex, and/or by increasing the length (in base pairs) of the heteroduplex. At the same time, for purposes of optimizing cellular uptake, it may be advantageous to limit the size of the oligomer. For this reason, compounds that show high Tm (50° C. or greater) at a length of 25 bases or less are generally preferred over those requiring greater than 25 bases for high Tm values.
  • In certain embodiments, such as PMO oligomers, the antisense activity of an oligomer may be enhanced by using a mixture of uncharged and cationic phosphorodiamidate linkages, as exemplified in FIG. 1B. The total number of cationic linkages in the oligomer can vary from 1 to 10 (including all integers in between), and be interspersed throughout the oligomer. Preferably the number of charged linkages is at least 2 and no more than half the total backbone linkages, e.g., between 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8 positively charged linkages, and preferably each charged linkages is separated along the backbone by at least 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5 uncharged linkages. The antisense activity of various oligomers can be measured in vitro by fusing the oligomer target region to the 5′ end a reporter gene (e.g., firefly luciferase) and then measuring the inhibition of translation of the fusion gene mRNA transcripts in cell free translation assays. The inhibitory properties of oligomers containing a mixture of uncharged and cationic linkages can be enhanced between, approximately, five to 100 fold in cell free translation assays.
  • Exemplary antisense sequences for inducing exon skipping of either exon 5, 6, 7, or 8 of the human GR pre-mRNA are shown below in Table 2.
  • TABLE 2
    Exemplary Antisense
    Targeting Sequences
    SEQ ID
    Sequence (5′ to 3′) NO:
    TTCGAGCTGTGGGTATTTAAAC 2
    TGTTTTTCGAGCTGTGGGTATT 3
    TTCTTTGTTTTTCGAGCTGTGG 4
    ATTTTTTTCTTTGTTTTTCGAG 5
    TTCCTTTTATTTTTTTCTTTGT 6
    TCTTGTGAGACTCCTGTAGTGG 7
    GCCTTTGCCCATTTCACTGCTG 8
    CCTGGTATTGCCTTTGCCCATT 9
    TCCTGAAACCTGAATTAAGAGA 10
    TAAGTTCCTGAAACCTGAATTA 11
    GGTCATCCAGGTGTAAGTTCCT 12
    CATTTGGTCATCCAGGTGTAAG 13
    AGGGTCATTTGGTCATCCAGGT 14
    CACATCTGGTCTCATTCCAGGG 15
    ATTTTTTTTCTTCGTTTTTCGAG 16
    ATTTTTTTCTTCGTTTTTCGAG 17
    GCAGGGTAGAGTCATTCTCTGC 34
    GGTCGTACATGCAGGGTAGAGT 35
    ACATTGGTCGTACATGCAGGGT 36
    GAGAGAAGCAGTAAGGTTTTCA 37
    CTCTTCAGACCGTCCTTAGGAA 38
    GGCTCTTCAGACCGTCCTTAGG 39
    AGGTCATTCTAATTTCATCAAA 40
    CATGCATAGAATCCAAGAGTTT 41
  • Antisense Oligonucleotide Compounds
  • The antisense oligonucleotides of the present invention typically (a) have the ability to be actively taken up by mammalian cells, and (b) once taken up, form a duplex with the target RNA with a Tm greater than about 45° C. In certain embodiments, the oligomer backbone may be substantially uncharged, and, preferably, may be recognized as a substrate for active or facilitated transport across the cell membrane. The ability of the oligomer to form a stable duplex with the target RNA may also relate to other features of the oligomer backbone, including the length and degree of complementarity of the antisense oligomer with respect to the target, the ratio of G:C to A:T base matches, and the positions of any mismatched bases. The ability of the antisense oligomer to resist cellular nucleases may promote survival and ultimate delivery of the agent to the cell cytoplasm. Exemplary antisense oligomer targeting sequences of the invention using the PMO backbone chemistry are listed above in Table 2. In general, PNA and LNA chemistries utilize shorter targeting oligomers due to their relatively high target binding strength compared to PMO and 2′O-Me oligomers.
  • Peptide nucleic acids (PNAs) are analogs of DNA in which the backbone is structurally homomorphous with a deoxyribose backbone, consisting of N-(2-aminoethyl) glycine units to which pyrimidine or purine bases are attached. PNAs containing natural pyrimidine and purine bases hybridize to complementary oligonucleotides obeying Watson-Crick base-pairing rules, and mimic DNA in terms of base pair recognition (Egholm, Buchardt et al. 1993). The backbone of PNAs is formed by peptide bonds rather than phosphodiester bonds, making them well-suited for antisense applications (see structure below). The backbone is uncharged, resulting in PNA/DNA or PNA/RNA duplexes that exhibit greater than normal thermal stability. PNAs are not recognized by nucleases or proteases.
  • PNAs are produced synthetically using any technique known in the art. PNA is a DNA analog in which a polyamide backbone replaces the traditional phosphate ribose ring of DNA as shown below.
  • Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00002
  • Despite a radical structural change to the natural structure, PNA is capable of sequence-specific binding in a helix form to DNA or RNA. Characteristics of PNA include a high binding affinity to complementary DNA or RNA, a destabilizing effect caused by single-base mismatch, resistance to nucleases and proteases, hybridization with DNA or RNA independent of salt concentration and triplex formation with homopurine DNA. Panagene™ has developed its proprietary Bts PNA monomers (Bts; benzothiazole-2-sulfonyl group) and proprietary oligomerisation process. The PNA oligomerisation using Bts PNA monomers is composed of repetitive cycles of deprotection, coupling and capping. Panagene's patents to this technology include U.S. Pat. No. 6,969,766, U.S. Pat. No. 7,211,668, U.S. Pat. No. 7,022,851, U.S. Pat. No. 7,125,994, U.S. Pat. No. 7,145,006 and U.S. Pat. No. 7,179,896. Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of PNA compounds include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,539,082; 5,714,331; and 5,719,262, each of which is herein incorporated by reference. Further teaching of PNA compounds can be found in Nielsen et al., Science, 1991, 254, 1497.
  • Oligonucleotide compounds of the present invention may also contain “locked nucleic acid” subunits (LNAs). The structures of LNAs are known in the art: for example, Wengel, et al., Chemical Communications (1998) 455; Tetrahedron (1998) 54, 3607, and Accounts of Chem. Research (1999) 32, 301); Obika, et al., Tetrahedron Letters (1997) 38, 8735; (1998) 39, 5401, and Bioorganic Medicinal Chemistry (2008)16, 9230. Exemplary, non-limiting LNA structures are illustrated below:
  • Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00003
  • Compounds of the invention may incorporate one or more LNAs; in some cases, the compounds may be entirely composed of LNAs. Methods for the synthesis of individual LNA nucleoside subunits and their incorporation into oligonucleotides are known in the art: U.S. Pat. Nos. 7,572,582; 7,569,575; 7,084,125; 7,060,809; 7,053,207; 7,034,133; 6,794,499; and 6,670,461. Typical intersubunit linkers include phosphodiester and phosphorothioate moieties; alternatively, non-phosphorous containing linkers may be employed. A preferred embodiment is an LNA containing compound where each LNA subunit is separated by a DNA subunit (i.e., a deoxyribose nucleotide). Further preferred compounds are composed of alternating LNA and DNA subunits where the intersubunit linker is phosphorothioate.
  • A preferred oligomer structure employs morpholino-based subunits bearing base-pairing moieties, joined by uncharged linkages, as described above. Especially preferred is a substantially uncharged phosphorodiamidate-linked morpholino oligomer. Morpholino oligonucleotides, including antisense oligomers, are detailed, for example, in co-owned U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,698,685, 5,217,866, 5,142,047, 5,034,506, 5,166,315, 5,185, 444, 5,521,063, and 5,506,337, and in PCT application No. U.S. Ser. No. 08/088,339, all of which are expressly incorporated by reference herein.
  • Certain properties of the morpholino-based subunits include: the ability to be linked in a oligomeric form by stable, uncharged backbone linkages; the ability to support a nucleotide base (e.g., adenine, cytosine, guanine or uracil) such that the polymer formed can hybridize with a complementary-base target nucleic acid, including target RNA, with high Tm, even with oligomers as short as 10-14 bases; the ability of the oligomer to be actively transported into mammalian cells; and the ability of the oligomer:RNA heteroduplex to resist RNase degradation.
  • Examples of morpholino oligonucleotides having phosphorus-containing backbone linkages are illustrated in FIGS. 1A-1C. Especially preferred is a phosphorodiamidate-linked morpholino oligonucleotide, as shown in FIG. 1B, which is modified, in accordance with one aspect of the present invention, to contain positively charged groups at preferably 10%-50% of its backbone linkages. Morpholino oligonucleotides with uncharged backbone linkages, including antisense oligonucleotides, are detailed, for example, in (Summerton and Weller, 1997) and in co-owned U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,698,685, 5,217,866, 5,142,047, 5,034,506, 5,166,315, 5,185, 444, 5,521,063, and 5,506,337, and in PCT application No. U.S. Ser. No. 08/012,804, all of which are expressly incorporated by reference herein.
  • Properties of the morpholino-based subunits include: 1) the ability to be linked in a oligomeric form by stable, uncharged or positively charged backbone linkages; 2) the ability to support a nucleotide base (e.g., adenine, cytosine, guanine, thymidine, uracil and hypoxanthine) such that the polymer formed can hybridize with a complementary-base target nucleic acid, including target RNA, Tm values above about 45° C. in relatively short oligonucleotides (e.g., 10-15 bases); 3) the ability of the oligonucleotide to be actively or passively transported into mammalian cells; and 4) the ability of the antisense oligonucleotide:RNA heteroduplex to resist RNase and RNaseH degradation, respectively.
  • Exemplary backbone structures for antisense oligonucleotides of the claimed subject matter include the morpholino subunit types shown in FIGS. 1D-1G, each linked by an uncharged or positively charged, phosphorus-containing subunit linkage. FIG. 1D shows a phosphorus-containing linkage which forms the five atom repeating-unit backbone, where the morpholino rings are linked by a 1-atom phosphoamide linkage. FIG. 1E shows a linkage which produces a 6-atom repeating-unit backbone. In this structure, the atom Y linking the 5′ morpholino carbon to the phosphorus group may be sulfur, nitrogen, carbon or, preferably, oxygen. The X moiety pendant from the phosphorus may be fluorine, an alkyl or substituted alkyl, an alkoxy or substituted alkoxy, a thioalkoxy or substituted thioalkoxy, or unsubstituted, monosubstituted, or disubstituted nitrogen, including cyclic structures, such as morpholines or piperidines. Alkyl, alkoxy and thioalkoxy preferably include 1-6 carbon atoms. The Z moieties are sulfur or oxygen, and are preferably oxygen.
  • The linkages shown in FIGS. 1F and 1G are designed for 7-atom unit-length backbones. In structure 1F, the X moiety is as in Structure 1E, and the Y moiety may be methylene, sulfur, or, preferably, oxygen. In Structure 1G, the X and Y moieties are as in Structure 1E. Particularly preferred morpholino oligonucleotides include those composed of morpholino subunit structures of the form shown in FIG. 1E, where X═NH2, N(CH3)2, or 1-piperazine or other charged group, Y═O, and Z═O.
  • As noted above, the substantially uncharged oligonucleotide may be modified, in accordance with an aspect of the invention, to include charged linkages, e.g., up to about 1 per every 2-5 uncharged linkages, such as about 4-5 per every 10 uncharged linkages. In certain embodiments, optimal improvement in antisense activity may be seen when about 25% of the backbone linkages are cationic. In certain embodiments, enhancement may be seen with a small number e.g., 10-20% cationic linkages, or where the number of cationic linkages are in the range 50-80%, such as about 60%.
  • Additional experiments conducted in support of the present invention indicate that the enhancement seen with added cationic backbone charges may, in some cases, be further enhanced by distributing the bulk of the charges close of the “center-region” backbone linkages of the antisense oligonucleotide, e.g., in a 20-mer oligonucleotide with 8 cationic backbone linkages, having at least 70% of these charged linkages localized in the 10 centermost linkages.
  • In certain embodiments, the antisense compounds can be prepared by stepwise solid-phase synthesis, employing methods detailed in the references cited above, and below with respect to the synthesis of oligonucleotides having a mixture or uncharged and cationic backbone linkages. In some cases, it may be desirable to add additional chemical moieties to the antisense compound, e.g., to enhance pharmacokinetics or to facilitate capture or detection of the compound. Such a moiety may be covalently attached, typically to a terminus of the oligomer, according to standard synthetic methods. For example, addition of a polyethyleneglycol moiety or other hydrophilic polymer, e.g., one having 10-100 monomeric subunits, may be useful in enhancing solubility. One or more charged groups, e.g., anionic charged groups such as an organic acid, may enhance cell uptake.
  • A reporter moiety, such as fluorescein or a radiolabeled group, may be attached for purposes of detection. Alternatively, the reporter label attached to the oligomer may be a ligand, such as an antigen or biotin, capable of binding a labeled antibody or streptavidin. In selecting a moiety for attachment or modification of an antisense compound, it is generally of course desirable to select chemical compounds of groups that are biocompatible and likely to be tolerated by a subject without undesirable side effects.
  • As noted above, certain of the antisense compounds can be constructed to contain a selected number of cationic linkages interspersed with uncharged linkages of the type described above. The intersubunit linkages, both uncharged and cationic, preferably are phosphorus-containing linkages, having the structure:
  • Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00004
  • where
    W is S or O, and is preferably O,
  • X═NR1R2 or OR6, Y═O or NR7,
  • and each said linkage in the oligomer is selected from:
  • (a) uncharged linkage (a), where each of R1, R2, R6 and R7 is independently selected from hydrogen and lower alkyl;
  • (b1) cationic linkage (b1), where X═NR1R2 and Y═O, and NR1R2 represents an optionally substituted piperazino group, such that R1R2═—CHRCHRN(R3)(R4)CHRCHR—, where
  • each R is independently H or CH3,
  • R4 is H, CH3, or an electron pair, and
  • R3 is selected from H, lower alkyl, e.g., CH3, C(═NH)NH2, Z-L-NHC(═NH)NH2, and [C(O)CHR′NH]mH, where: Z is C(O) or a direct bond, L is an optional linker up to 18 atoms in length, preferably up to 12 atoms, and more preferably up to 8 atoms in length, having bonds selected from alkyl, alkoxy, and alkylamino, R′ is a side chain of a naturally occurring amino acid or a one- or two-carbon homolog thereof, and m is 1 to 6, preferably 1 to 4;
  • (b2) cationic linkage (b2), where X═NR1R2 and Y═O, R1═H or CH3, and R2=LNR3R4R5, where L, R3, and R4 are as defined above, and R5 is H, lower alkyl, or lower (alkoxy)alkyl; and
  • (b3) cationic linkage (b3), where Y═NR7 and X═OR6, and R7=LNR3R4R5, where L, R3, R4 and R5 are as defined above, and R6 is H or lower alkyl;
  • and at least one said linkage is selected from cationic linkages (b1), (b2), and (b3).
  • In certain embodiments, an oligomer may include at least two consecutive linkages of type (a) (i.e. uncharged linkages). In further embodiments, at least 5% of the linkages in the oligomer are cationic linkages (i.e. type (b1), (b2), or (b3)); for example, 10% to 60%, and preferably 20-50% linkages may be cationic linkages.
  • In one embodiment, at least one linkage is of type (b1), where, preferably, each R is H, R4 is H, CH3, or an electron pair, and R3 is selected from H, lower alkyl, e.g., CH3, C(═NH)NH2, and C(O)-L-NHC(═NH)NH2. The latter two embodiments of R3 provide a guanidino moiety, either attached directly to the piperazine ring, or pendant to a linker group L, respectively. For ease of synthesis, the variable Z in R3 is preferably C(O) (carbonyl), as shown.
  • The linker group L, as noted above, contains bonds in its backbone selected from alkyl (e.g., —CH2—CH2—), alkoxy (—C—O—), and alkylamino (e.g., —CH2—NH—), with the proviso that the terminal atoms in L (e.g., those adjacent to carbonyl or nitrogen) are carbon atoms. Although branched linkages (e.g., —CH2—CHCH3—) are possible, the linker is preferably unbranched. In one embodiment, the linker is a hydrocarbon linker Such a linker may have the structure —(CH2)n—, where n is 1-12, preferably 2-8, and more preferably 2-6.
  • The morpholino subunits have the structure:
  • Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00005
  • where Pi is a base-pairing moiety, and the linkages depicted above connect the nitrogen atom of (i) to the 5′ carbon of an adjacent subunit. The base-pairing moieties Pi may be the same or different, and are generally designed to provide a sequence which binds to a target nucleic acid.
  • The use of embodiments of linkage types (b1), (b2) and (b3) above to link morpholino subunits may be illustrated graphically as follows:
  • Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00006
  • Preferably, all cationic linkages in the oligomer are of the same type; i.e. all of type (b1), all of type (b2), or all of type (b3).
  • In further embodiments, the cationic linkages are selected from linkages (b1′) and (b1″) as shown below, where (b1″) is referred to herein as a “Pip” linkage and (b1″) is referred to herein as a “GuX” linkage:
  • Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00007
  • In the structures above, W is S or O, and is preferably O; each of R1 and R2 is independently selected from hydrogen and lower alkyl, and is preferably methyl; and A represents hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent on one or more carbon atoms in (b1′) and (b1″). Preferably, the ring carbons in the piperazine ring are unsubstituted; however, they may include non-interfering substituents, such as methyl or fluorine. Preferably, at most one or two carbon atoms is so substituted. In further embodiments, at least 10% of the linkages are of type (b1′) or (b1″); for example, 10%-60% and preferably 20% to 50%, of the linkages may be of type (b1′) or (b1″).
  • In certain embodiments, the oligomer contains no linkages of the type (b1′) above. Alternatively, the oligomer contains no linkages of type (b1) where each R is H, R3 is H or CH3, and R4 is H, CH3, or an electron pair.
  • The morpholino subunits may also be linked by non-phosphorus-based intersubunit linkages, as described further below, where at least one linkage is modified with a pendant cationic group as described above.
  • Other oligonucleotide analog linkages which are uncharged in their unmodified state but which could also bear a pendant amine substituent could be used. For example, a 5′nitrogen atom on a morpholino ring could be employed in a sulfamide linkage or a urea linkage (where phosphorus is replaced with carbon or sulfur, respectively) and modified in a manner analogous to the 5′-nitrogen atom in structure (b3) above.
  • Oligomers having any number of cationic linkages are provided, including fully cationic-linked oligomers. Preferably, however, the oligomers are partially charged, having, for example, 10%-80%. In preferred embodiments, about 10% to 60%, and preferably 20% to 50% of the linkages are cationic.
  • In one embodiment, the cationic linkages are interspersed along the backbone. The partially charged oligomers preferably contain at least two consecutive uncharged linkages; that is, the oligomer preferably does not have a strictly alternating pattern along its entire length.
  • Also considered are oligomers having blocks of cationic linkages and blocks of uncharged linkages; for example, a central block of uncharged linkages may be flanked by blocks of cationic linkages, or vice versa. In one embodiment, the oligomer has approximately equal-length 5′, 3′ and center regions, and the percentage of cationic linkages in the center region is greater than about 50%, preferably greater than about 70%.
  • Oligomers for use in antisense applications generally range in length from about 10 to about 40 subunits, more preferably about 10 to 30 subunits, and typically 15-25 bases. For example, an oligomer of the invention having 19-20 subunits, a useful length for an antisense compound, may ideally have two to ten, e.g., four to eight, cationic linkages, and the remainder uncharged linkages. An oligomer having 14-15 subunits may ideally have two to seven, e.g., 3, 4, or 5, cationic linkages and the remainder uncharged linkages.
  • Each morpholino ring structure supports a base pairing moiety, to form a sequence of base pairing moieties which is typically designed to hybridize to a selected antisense target in a cell or in a subject being treated. The base pairing moiety may be a purine or pyrimidine found in native DNA or RNA (e.g., A, G, C, T or U) or an analog, such as hypoxanthine (the base component of the nucleoside inosine) or 5-methyl cytosine.
  • Peptide Transporters
  • In certain embodiments, the antisense compounds of the invention may include an oligonucleotide moiety conjugated to an arginine-rich peptide transport moiety effective to enhance transport of the compound into cells. The transport moiety may be attached to a terminus of the oligomer, as shown, for example, in FIG. 1C. The peptide transport moiety preferably comprises 6 to 16 subunits selected from X′ subunits, Y′ subunits, and Z′ subunits, where
  • (a) each X′ subunit independently represents lysine, arginine or an arginine analog, said analog being a cationic α-amino acid comprising a side chain of the structure R1N═C(NH2)R2, where R1 is H or R; R2 is R, NH2, NHR, or NR2, where R is lower alkyl or lower alkenyl and may further include oxygen or nitrogen; R1 and R2 may together form a ring; and the side chain is linked to said amino acid via R1 or R2;
  • (b) each Y′ subunit independently represents a neutral amino acid —C(O)—(CHR)n—NH—, where n is 2 to 7 and each R is independently H or methyl; and
  • (c) each Z′ subunit independently represents an α-amino acid having a neutral aralkyl side chain;
  • wherein the peptide comprises a sequence represented by one of (X′Y′X′)p, (X′Y′)m, and (X′Z′Z′)p, where p is 2 to 5 and m is 2 to 8. Certain embodiments include various combinations selected independently from (X′Y′X′)p, (X′Y′)m, and/or (X′Z′Z′)p, including, for example, peptides having the sequence (X′Y′X′)(X′Z′Z′)(X′Y′X′)(X′Z′Z′) (SEQ ID NO:31).
  • In selected embodiments, for each X′, the side chain moiety is guanidyl, as in the amino acid subunit arginine (Arg). In further embodiments, each Y′ is —CO—(CH2)n—CHR—NH—, where n is 2 to 7 and R is H. For example, when n is 5 and R is H, Y′ is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit, abbreviated herein as Ahx; when n is 2 and R is H, Y′ is a β-alanine subunit, abbreviated herein as B. Certain embodiments relate to carrier peptides having a combination of different neutral amino acids, including, for example, peptides comprising the sequence -RAhxRRBRRAhxRRBRAhxB- (SEQ ID NO:26), which contains both β-alanine and 6-aminohexanoic acid.
  • Preferred peptides of this type include those comprising arginine dimers alternating with single Y′ subunits, where Y′ is preferably Ahx. Examples include peptides having the formula (RY′R)p or the formula (RRY′)p, where Y′ is preferably Ahx. In one embodiment, Y′ is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit, R is arginine and p is 4.
  • Certain embodiments include various linear combinations of at least two of (RY′R)p and (RRY′)p, including, for example, illustrative peptides having the sequence (RY′R)(RRY′)(RY′R)(RRY′) (SEQ ID NO:32), or (RRY′)(RY′R)(RRY′) (SEQ ID NO:33). Other combinations are contemplated. In a further illustrative embodiment, each Z′ is phenylalanine, and m is 3 or 4.
  • The conjugated peptide is preferably linked to a terminus of the oligomer via a linker Ahx-B, where Ahx is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit and B is a β-alanine subunit, as shown, for example, in FIG. 1C.
  • In selected embodiments, for each X′, the side chain moiety is independently selected from the group consisting of guanidyl (HN═C(NH2)NH—), amidinyl (HN═C(NH2)C<), 2-aminodihydropyrimidyl, 2-aminotetrahydropyrimidyl, 2-aminopyridinyl, and 2-aminopyrimidonyl, and it is preferably selected from guanidyl and amidinyl. In one embodiment, the side chain moiety is guanidyl, as in the amino acid subunit arginine (Arg).
  • In certain embodiments, the Y′ subunits may be either contiguous, in that no X′ subunits intervene between Y′ subunits, or interspersed singly between X′ subunits. In certain embodiments, the linking subunit may be between Y′ subunits. In one embodiment, the Y′ subunits are at a terminus of the transporter; in other embodiments, they are flanked by X′ subunits. In further preferred embodiments, each Y′ is —CO—(CH2)n—CHR—NH—, where n is 2 to 7 and R is H. For example, when n is 5 and R is H, Y′ is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit, abbreviated herein as Ahx.
  • In selected embodiments of this group, each X′ comprises a guanidyl side chain moiety, as in an arginine subunit. Preferred peptides of this type include those comprising arginine dimers alternating with single Y′ subunits, where Y′ is preferably Ahx. Examples include peptides having the formula (RY′R)4 or the formula (RRY′)4, where Y′ is preferably Ahx. In the latter case, the nucleic acid analog is preferably linked to a terminal Y′ subunit, preferably at the C-terminus, as shown, for example, in FIG. 1C. The preferred linker is of the structure AhxB, where Ahx is a 6-aminohexanoic acid subunit and B is a β-alanine subunit.
  • The transport moieties as described herein have been shown to greatly enhance cell entry of attached oligomers, relative to uptake of the oligomer in the absence of the attached transport moiety, and relative to uptake by an attached transport moiety lacking the hydrophobic subunits Y′. Such enhanced uptake is preferably evidenced by at least a two-fold increase, and preferably a four-fold increase, in the uptake of the compound into mammalian cells relative to uptake of the agent by an attached transport moiety lacking the hydrophobic subunits Y′. Uptake is preferably enhanced at least twenty fold, and more preferably forty fold, relative to the unconjugated compound.
  • A further benefit of the transport moiety is its expected ability to stabilize a duplex between an antisense compound and its target nucleic acid sequence, presumably by virtue of electrostatic interaction between the positively charged transport moiety and the negatively charged nucleic acid. The number of charged subunits in the transporter is less than 14, as noted above, and preferably between 8 and 11.
  • The use of arginine-rich peptide transporters (i.e., cell-penetrating peptides) are particularly useful in practicing certain embodiments of the present invention. Certain peptide transporters have been shown to be highly effective at delivery of antisense compounds into primary cells including hematopoietic and muscle cells (Marshall, Oda et al. 2007; Jearawiriyapaisarn, Moulton et al. 2008; Wu, Moulton et al. 2008). Furthermore, compared to other known peptide transporters such as Penetratin and the Tat peptide, the peptide transporters described herein, when conjugated to an antisense PMO, demonstrate an enhanced ability to alter splicing of several gene transcripts (Marshall, Oda et al. 2007). Exemplary peptide transporters, including linkers (B or AhxB) are shown in Table 3 below. Especially preferred are the P007, CP04057, and CP06062 transport peptides (SEQ ID NOS:21, 25, and 26, respectively).
  • TABLE 3
    Exemplary Peptide Transporters
    SEQ
    Sequence ID
    Peptide (N-terminal to C-terminal) NO:
    rTAT RRRQRRKKRC 18
    R9F2 RRRRRRRRRFFC 19
    (RRAhx)4B RRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxB 20
    (RAhxR)4AhxB; RAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRAhxB 21
    (P007)
    (AhxRR)4AhxB AhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxB 22
    (RAhx)6B RAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxB 23
    (RAhx)8B RAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhx 24
    RAhxRahxB
    (RAhxR)5AhxB RAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhx 25
    (CP04057) RAhxB
    (RAhxRRBR)2AhxB; RAhxRRBRRAhxRRBRAhxB 26
    (CP06062)
  • RNA Interference Agents
  • The NHR target regions described herein may also be targeted by a variety of RNA interference-based methods. RNA interference (RNAi) is an evolutionarily conserved gene-silencing mechanism, originally discovered in studies of the nematode Caenorhabditis elegans (Lee et al, Cell 75:843, 1993; Reinhart et al., Nature 403:901, 2000). It may be triggered by introducing dsRNA into cells expressing the appropriate molecular machinery, which then degrades the corresponding endogenous mRNA. The mechanism involves conversion of dsRNA into short RNAs that direct ribonucleases to homologous mRNA targets (summarized, Ruvkun, Science 2294:797, 2001).
  • In certain embodiments, the methods provided herein may utilize double-stranded ribonucleic acid (dsRNA) molecules as NHR modulating agents. dsRNAs generally comprise two single strands. One strand of the dsRNA comprises a nucleotide sequence that is substantially identical to a portion of the target gene or target region (the “sense” strand), and the other strand (the “complementary” or “antisense” strand) comprises a sequence that is substantially complementary to a portion of the target region. The strands are sufficiently complementary to hybridize to form a duplex structure. In certain embodiments, the complementary RNA strand may be less than 30 nucleotides, less than 25 nucleotides in length, or even 19 to 24 nucleotides in length. In certain aspects, the complementary nucleotide sequence may be 20-23 nucleotides in length, or 22 nucleotides in length.
  • In certain embodiments, at least one of the RNA strands comprises a nucleotide overhang of 1 to 4 nucleotides in length. In other embodiments, the dsRNA may further comprise at least one chemically modified nucleotide. In certain aspects, a dsRNA comprising a single-stranded overhang of 1 to 4 nucleotides may comprise a molecule wherein the unpaired nucleotide of the single-stranded overhang that is directly adjacent to the terminal nucleotide pair contains a purine base. In other aspects, the last complementary nucleotide pairs on both ends of a dsRNA are a G-C pair, or, at least two of the last four terminal nucleotide pairs are G-C pairs.
  • Certain embodiments of the present invention may comprise microRNAs. Micro-RNAs represent a large group of small RNAs produced naturally in organisms, some of which regulate the expression of target genes. Micro-RNAs are formed from an approximately 70 nucleotide single-stranded hairpin precursor transcript by Dicer. (V. Ambros et al. Current Biology 13:807, 2003). Micro-RNAs are not translated into proteins, but instead bind to specific messenger RNAs, thereby blocking translation. It is thought that micro-RNAs base-pair imprecisely with their targets to inhibit translation. Certain micro-RNAs may be transcribed as hairpin RNA precursors, which are then processed to their mature forms by Dicer enzyme.
  • In certain embodiments, the modulating agent, or RNAi oligonucleotide, is single stranded. In other embodiments, the modulating agent, or RNAi oligonucleotide, is double stranded. Certain embodiments may also employ short-interfering RNAs (siRNA). In certain embodiments, the first strand of the double-stranded oligonucleotide contains two more nucleoside residues than the second strand. In other embodiments, the first strand and the second strand have the same number of nucleosides; however, the first and second strands are offset such that the two terminal nucleosides on the first and second strands are not paired with a residue on the complimentary strand. In certain instances, the two nucleosides that are not paired are thymidine resides.
  • In instances when the modulating agent comprises siRNA, the agent should include a region of sufficient homology to the target region, and be of sufficient length in terms of nucleotides, such that the siRNA agent, or a fragment thereof, can mediate down regulation of the target RNA. It will be understood that the term “ribonucleotide” or “nucleotide” can, in the case of a modified RNA or nucleotide surrogate, also refer to a modified nucleotide, or surrogate replacement moiety at one or more positions. Thus, an siRNA agent is or includes a region which is at least partially complementary to the target RNA. It is not necessary that there be perfect complementarity between the siRNA agent and the target, but the correspondence must be sufficient to enable the siRNA agent, or a cleavage product thereof, to direct sequence specific silencing, such as by RNAi cleavage of the target RNA. Complementarity, or degree of homology with the target strand, is most critical in the antisense strand. While perfect complementarity, particularly in the antisense strand, is often desired some embodiments include one or more but preferably 10, 8, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, or fewer mismatches with respect to the target RNA. The mismatches are most tolerated in the terminal regions, and if present are preferably in a terminal region or regions, e.g., within 6, 5, 4, or 3 nucleotides of the 5′ and/or 3′ terminus. The sense strand need only be sufficiently complementary with the antisense strand to maintain the over all double-strand character of the molecule.
  • In addition, an siRNA modulating agent may be modified or include nucleoside surrogates. Single stranded regions of an siRNA agent may be modified or include nucleoside surrogates, e.g., the unpaired region or regions of a hairpin structure, e.g., a region which links two complementary regions, can have modifications or nucleoside surrogates. Modification to stabilize one or more 3′- or 5′-terminus of an siRNA agent, e.g., against exonucleases, or to favor the antisense siRNA agent to enter into RISC are also useful. Modifications can include C3 (or C6, C7, C12) amino linkers, thiol linkers, carboxyl linkers, non-nucleotidic spacers (C3, C6, C9, C12, abasic, triethylene glycol, hexaethylene glycol), special biotin or fluorescein reagents that come as phosphoramidites and that have another DMT-protected hydroxyl group, allowing multiple couplings during RNA synthesis.
  • siRNA agents may include, for example, molecules that are long enough to trigger the interferon response (which can be cleaved by Dicer (Bernstein et al. 2001. Nature, 409:363-366) and enter a RISC (RNAi-induced silencing complex)), in addition to molecules which are sufficiently short that they do not trigger the interferon response (which molecules can also be cleaved by Dicer and/or enter a RISC), e.g., molecules which are of a size which allows entry into a RISC, e.g., molecules which resemble Dicer-cleavage products. Molecules that are short enough that they do not trigger an interferon response are termed siRNA agents or shorter RNAi agents herein. “siRNA agent or shorter RNAi agent” as used refers to an siRNA agent that is sufficiently short that it does not induce a deleterious interferon response in a human cell, e.g., it has a duplexed region of less than 60 but preferably less than 50, 40, or 30 nucleotide pairs. An siRNA modulating agent, or a cleavage product thereof, can down regulate a target gene, e.g., by inducing RNAi with respect to a target RNA.
  • Each strand of an siRNA modulating agent can be equal to or less than 35, 30, 25, 24, 23, 22, 21, or 20 nucleotides in length. The strand is preferably at least 19 nucleotides in length. For example, each strand can be between 21 and 25 nucleotides in length. Preferred siRNA agents have a duplex region of 17, 18, 19, 29, 21, 22, 23, 24, or 25 nucleotide pairs, and one or more overhangs, preferably one or two 3′ overhangs, of 2-3 nucleotides.
  • In addition to homology to target RNA and the ability to down regulate a target gene, an siRNA modulating agent may have one or more of the following properties: it may, despite modifications, even to a very large number, or all of the nucleosides, have an antisense strand that can present bases (or modified bases) in the proper three dimensional framework so as to be able to form correct base pairing and form a duplex structure with a homologous target RNA which is sufficient to allow down regulation of the target, e.g., by cleavage of the target RNA; it may, despite modifications, even to a very large number, or all of the nucleosides, still have “RNA-like” properties, i.e., it may possess the overall structural, chemical and physical properties of an RNA molecule, even though not exclusively, or even partly, of ribonucleotide-based content. For example, an siRNA agent can contain, e.g., a sense and/or an antisense strand in which all of the nucleotide sugars contain e.g., 2′ fluoro in place of 2′ hydroxyl. This deoxyribonucleotide-containing agent can still be expected to exhibit RNA-like properties. While not wishing to be bound by theory, the electronegative fluorine prefers an axial orientation when attached to the C2′ position of ribose. This spatial preference of fluorine can, in turn, force the sugars to adopt a C3′-endo pucker. This is the same puckering mode as observed in RNA molecules and gives rise to the RNA-characteristic A-family-type helix. Further, since fluorine is a good hydrogen bond acceptor, it can participate in the same hydrogen bonding interactions with water molecules that are known to stabilize RNA structures. Generally, it is preferred that a modified moiety at the 2′ sugar position will be able to enter into H-bonding which is more characteristic of the OH moiety of a ribonucleotide than the H moiety of a deoxyribonucleotide.
  • A “single strand RNAi agent” as used herein, is an RNAi agent which is made up of a single molecule. It may include a duplexed region, formed by intra-strand pairing, e.g., it may be, or include, a hairpin or pan-handle structure. Single strand RNAi modulating agents are preferably antisense with regard to the target molecule. A single strand RNAi agent should be sufficiently long that it can enter the RISC and participate in RISC mediated cleavage of a target mRNA. A single strand RNAi agent is at least 14, and more preferably at least 15, 20, 25, 29, 35, 40, or 50 nucleotides in length. It is preferably less than 200, 100, or 60 nucleotides in length.
  • Hairpin RNAi modulating agents may have a duplex region equal to or at least 17, 18, 19, 29, 21, 22, 23, 24, or 25 nucleotide pairs. The duplex region may preferably be equal to or less than 200, 100, or 50, in length. Certain ranges for the duplex region are 15-30, 17 to 23, 19 to 23, and 19 to 21 nucleotides pairs in length. The hairpin may have a single strand overhang or terminal unpaired region, preferably the 3′, and preferably of the antisense side of the hairpin. In certain embodiments, overhangs are 2-3 nucleotides in length.
  • Certain modulating agents utilized according to the methods provided herein may comprise RNAi oligonucleotides such as chimeric oligonucleotides, or “chimeras,” which contain two or more chemically distinct regions, each made up of at least one monomer unit, i.e., a nucleotide in the case of an oligonucleotide compound. These oligonucleotides typically contain at least one region wherein the oligonucleotide is modified so as to confer upon the oligonucleotide increased resistance to nuclease degradation, increased cellular uptake, and/or increased binding affinity for the target nucleic acid. Consequently, comparable results can often be obtained with shorter oligonucleotides when chimeric oligonucleotides are used, compared to phosphorothioate oligodeoxynucleotides. Chimeric oligonucleotides may be formed as composite structures of two or more oligonucleotides, modified oligonucleotides, oligonucleotides and/or oligonucleotide mimetics as described above. Such oligonucleotides have also been referred to in the art as hybrids or gapmers. Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of such hybrid structures include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,013,830; 5,149,797; 5,220,007; 5,256,775; 5,366,878; 5,403,711; 5,491,133; 5,565,350; 5,623,065; 5,652,355; 5,652,356; 5,700,922; and 5,955,589, each of which is herein incorporated by reference. In certain embodiments, the chimeric oligonucleotide is RNA-DNA, DNA-RNA, RNA-DNA-RNA, DNA-RNA-DNA, or RNA-DNA-RNA-DNA, wherein the oligonucleotide is between 5 and 60 nucleotides in length.
  • In one aspect of the invention, modulating agents, such as RNAi agents, relate to an oligonucleotide comprising at least one ligand tethered to an altered or non-natural nucleobase. A large number of compounds can function as the altered base. The structure of the altered base is important to the extent that the altered base should not substantially prevent binding of the oligonucleotide to its target, e.g., mRNA. In certain embodiments, the altered base is difluorotolyl, nitropyrrolyl, nitroimidazolyl, nitroindolyl, napthalenyl, anthrancenyl, pyridinyl, quinolinyl, pyrenyl, or the divalent radical of any one of the non-natural nucleobases described herein. In certain embodiments, the non-natural nucleobase is difluorotolyl, nitropyrrolyl, or nitroimidazolyl. In certain embodiments, the non-natural nucleobase is difluorotolyl. A wide variety of ligands are known in the art and are amenable to the present invention. For example, the ligand can be a steroid, bile acid, lipid, folic acid, pyridoxal, B12, riboflavin, biotin, aromatic compound, polycyclic compound, crown ether, intercalator, cleaver molecule, protein-binding agent, or carbohydrate. In certain embodiments, the ligand is a steroid or aromatic compound. In certain instances, the ligand is cholesteryl.
  • In other embodiments, the RNAi agent is an oligonucleotide tethered to a ligand for the purposes of improving cellular targeting and uptake. For example, an RNAi agent may be tethered to an antibody, or antigen binding fragment thereof. As an additional example, an RNAi agent may be tethered to a specific ligand binding molecule, such as a polypeptide or polypeptide fragment that specifically binds a particular cell-surface receptor.
  • In other embodiments, the modulating agent comprises a non-natural nucleobase. In certain embodiments, the non-natural nucleobase is difluorotolyl, nitroimidazolyl, nitroindolyl, or nitropyrrolyl. In certain embodiments, the modulating agents provided herein relate to a double-stranded oligonucleotide sequence, wherein only one of the two strands contains a non-natural nucleobase. In certain embodiments, the modulating agents as used herein relate to a double-stranded oligonucleotide sequence, wherein both of the strands independently comprise at least one non-natural nucleobase.
  • In certain instances, the ribose sugar moiety that naturally occurs in nucleosides is replaced with a hexose sugar. In certain aspects, the hexose sugar is an allose, altrose, glucose, mannose, gulose, idose, galactose, talose, or a derivative thereof. In a preferred embodiment, the hexose is a D-hexose. In certain instances, the ribose sugar moiety that naturally occurs in nucleosides is replaced with a polycyclic heteroalkyl ring or cyclohexenyl group. In certain instances, the polycyclic heteroalkyl group is a bicyclic ring containing one oxygen atom in the ring. In certain instances, the polycyclic heteroalkyl group is a bicyclo[2.2.1]heptane, a bicyclo[3.2.1]octane, or a bicyclo[3.3.1]nonane. In certain embodiments, the backbone of the oligonucleotide has been modified to improve the therapeutic or diagnostic properties of the oligonucleotide compound. In certain embodiments, at least one of the bases or at least one of the sugars of the oligonucleotide has been modified to improve the therapeutic or diagnostic properties of the oligonucleotide compound. In instances when the oligonucleotide is double stranded, the two strands are complementary, partially complementary, or chimeric oligonucleotides.
  • Examples of modified RNAi agents envisioned for use in the methods of the present invention include oligonucleotides containing modified backbones or non-natural internucleoside linkages. As defined here, oligonucleotides having modified backbones or internucleoside linkages include those that retain a phosphorus atom in the backbone and those that do not have a phosphorus atom in the backbone. Modified oligonucleotides that do not have a phosphorus atom in their intersugar backbone can also be considered to be oligonucleotides. Specific oligonucleotide chemical modifications are described below. It is not necessary for all positions in a given compound to be uniformly modified, and in fact more than one of the following modifications may be incorporated in a single oligonucleotide compound or even in a single nucleotide thereof
  • Examples of modified internucleoside linkages or backbones include, for example, phosphorothioates, chiral phosphorothioates, phosphorodithioates, phosphotriesters, aminoalkylphosphotriesters, methyl and other alkyl phosphonates including 3′-alkylene phosphonates and chiral phosphonates, phosphinates, phosphoramidates including 3′-amino phosphoramidate and aminoalkylphosphoramidates, thionophosphoramidates, thionoalkylphosphonates, thionoalklyphosphotriesters, and boranophosphates having normal 3′-5′ linkages, 2′-5′ linked analogs of these, and those having inverted polarity wherein the adjacent pairs of nucleoside units are linked 3′-5′ to 5′-3′ or 2′-5′ to 5′-2′. Various salts, mixed salts and free-acid forms are also included.
  • Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of the above phosphorus atom-containing linkages include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,687,808; 4,469,863; 4,476,301; 5,023,243; 5,177,196; 5,188,897; 5,264,423; 5,276,019; 5,278,302; 5,286,717; 5,321,131; 5,399,676; 5,405,939; 5,453,496; 5,455,233; 5,466,677; 5,476,925; 5,519,126; 5,536,821; 5,541,306; 5,550,111; 5,563,253; 5,571,799; 5,587,361; 5,625,050; and 5,697,248, each of which is herein incorporated by reference.
  • Examples of modified internucleoside linkages or backbones that do not include a phosphorus atom therein (i.e., oligonucleotides) have backbones that are formed by short chain alkyl or cycloalkyl intersugar linkages, mixed heteroatom and alkyl or cycloalkyl intersugar linkages, or one or more short chain heteroatomic or heterocyclic intersugar linkages. These include those having morpholino linkages (formed in part from the sugar portion of a nucleoside); siloxane backbones; sulfide, sulfoxide and sulfone backbones; formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones; methylene formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones; alkene containing backbones; sulfamate backbones; methyleneimino and methylenehydrazino backbones; sulfonate and sulfonamide backbones; amide backbones; and others having mixed N, O, S and CH2 component parts.
  • Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of the above oligonucleotides include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,034,506; 5,166,315; 5,185,444; 5,214,134; 5,216,141; 5,235,033; 5,264,562; 5,264,564; 5,405,938; 5,434,257; 5,466,677; 5,470,967; 5,489,677; 5,541,307; 5,561,225; 5,596,086; 5,602,240; 5,610,289; 5,602,240; 5,608,046; 5,610,289; 5,618,704; 5,623,070; 5,663,312; 5,633,360; 5,677,437; and 5,677,439, each of which is herein incorporated by reference.
  • In other examples of oligonucleotide mimetics, both the sugar and the internucleoside linkage, i.e., the backbone, of the nucleoside units may be replaced with novel groups. The nucleobase units are maintained for hybridization with an appropriate nucleic acid target compound. One such oligonucleotide, an oligonucleotide mimetic, that has been shown to have excellent hybridization properties, is referred to as a peptide nucleic acid (PNA). In PNA compounds, the sugar-backbone of an oligonucleotide is replaced with an amide-containing backbone, in particular an aminoethylglycine backbone. The nucleobases are retained and are bound directly or indirectly to atoms of the amide portion of the backbone. Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of PNA compounds include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,539,082; 5,714,331; and 5,719,262, each of which is herein incorporated by reference. Further teaching of PNA compounds can be found in Nielsen et al., Science, 1991, 254, 1497.
  • The present invention further encompasses oligonucleotides employing ribozymes. Synthetic RNA molecules and derivatives thereof that catalyze highly specific endoribonuclease activities are known as ribozymes. (See, generally, U.S. Pat. No. 5,543,508 to Haseloff et al., and U.S. Pat. No. 5,545,729 to Goodchild et al.) The cleavage reactions are catalyzed by the RNA molecules themselves. In naturally occurring RNA molecules, the sites of self-catalyzed cleavage are located within highly conserved regions of RNA secondary structure (Buzayan et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A., 1986, 83, 8859; Forster et al., Cell, 1987, 50, 9). Naturally occurring autocatalytic RNA molecules have been modified to generate ribozymes which can be targeted to a particular cellular or pathogenic RNA molecule with a high degree of specificity. Thus, ribozymes serve the same general purpose as antisense oligonucleotides (i.e., modulation of expression of a specific gene) and, like oligonucleotides, are nucleic acids possessing significant portions of single-strandedness. That is, ribozymes have substantial chemical and functional identity with oligonucleotides and are thus considered to be equivalents for purposes of the present invention.
  • In certain instances, the RNAi agents for use with the methods provided herein may be modified by non-ligand group. A number of non-ligand molecules have been conjugated to oligonucleotides in order to enhance the activity, cellular distribution, cellular targeting, or cellular uptake of the oligonucleotide, and procedures for performing such conjugations are available in the scientific literature. Such non-ligand moieties have included lipid moieties, such as cholesterol (Letsinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 1989, 86:6553), cholic acid (Manoharan et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Lett., 1994, 4:1053), a thioether, e.g., hexyl-5-tritylthiol (Manoharan et al., Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci., 1992, 660:306; Manoharan et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Let., 1993, 3:2765), a thiocholesterol (Oberhauser et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 1992, 20:533), an aliphatic chain, e.g., dodecandiol or undecyl residues (Saison-Behmoaras et al., EMBO J., 1991, 10:111; Kabanov et al., FEBS Lett., 1990, 259:327; Svinarchuk et al., Biochimie, 1993, 75:49), a phospholipid, e.g., di-hexadecyl-rac-glycerol or triethylammonium 1,2-di-O-hexadecyl-rac-glycero-3-H-phosphonate (Manoharan et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36:3651; Shea et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 1990, 18:3777), a polyamine or a polyethylene glycol chain (Manoharan et al., Nucleosides & Nucleotides, 1995, 14:969), or adamantane acetic acid (Manoharan et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36:3651), a palmityl moiety (Mishra et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 1995, 1264:229), or an octadecylamine or hexylamino-carbonyl-oxycholesterol moiety (Crooke et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 1996, 277:923). Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of such oligonucleotide conjugates have been listed above. Typical conjugation protocols involve the synthesis of oligonucleotides bearing an aminolinker at one or more positions of the sequence. The amino group is then reacted with the molecule being conjugated using appropriate coupling or activating reagents. The conjugation reaction may be performed either with the oligonucleotide still bound to the solid support or following cleavage of the oligonucleotide in solution phase. Purification of the oligonucleotide conjugate by HPLC typically affords the pure conjugate.
  • Additional examples of modulating agents, such as RNAi oligonucleotides, may be found in U.S. Application Publication Nos. 2007/0275465, 2007/0054279, 2006/0287260, 2006/0035254, 2006/0008822, which are incorporated by reference.
  • Methods of Use
  • In another aspect, the present invention relates to methods of using the NHR-targeted antisense or RNAi agents described herein for treating a cell, tissue or subject, typically to modulate the activity of an NHR in a therapeutically beneficial manner. The cells or tissue that may be modulated by the present invention are preferably mammalian cells, or more preferably human cells. Such cells can be of a healthy state or of a diseased state.
  • In certain embodiments, for example, methods are provided for modulating therapeutically relevant cellular activities including, but not limited to, cellular metabolism, cell differentiation, cell proliferation, cell death, cell mobilization, cell migration, immune system function (e.g., inflammation, auto-immunity), gene transcription, mRNA translation, cell impedance, cytokine production, and the like, comprising contacting a cell with an NHR-targeted antisense or RNAi agent as described herein.
  • Specific embodiments relate to modulating the activity of the glucocorticoid receptor (GR). For example, by antagonizing transactivation, certain GR-targeted antisense or RNAi agents may be employed to treat metabolic diseases associated with increased levels of glucocorticoid, such as diabetes, osteoporosis and glaucoma, among others. Preferred embodiments agonize transrepression, and optionally antagonize transactivation. These and related embodiments may be useful in the treatment of inflammatory conditions.
  • As another example, by agonizing transactivation, certain GR-targeted antisense or RNAi agents may be employed to treated metabolic diseases associated with a deficiency in glucocorticoid, such as Addison's disease and others. Such embodiments may also be used as pro-inflammatory agents, to increase inflammatory responses in a subject in need thereof, as exemplified herein.
  • As noted above, certain preferred embodiments relate to the modulation of inflammation. Certain embodiments include methods of decreasing inflammation, and depending on the needs of the subject and the selection of the target sequence, other embodiments include methods of increasing inflammation or inflammatory responses. “Inflammation” refers generally to the biological response of tissues to harmful stimuli, such as pathogens, damaged cells (e.g., wounds), and irritants. The term “inflammatory response” refers to the specific mechanisms by which inflammation is achieved and regulated, including, merely by way of illustration, immune cell activation or migration, cytokine production, vasodilation, including kinin release, fibrinolysis, and coagulation, among others described herein and known in the art. Ideally, inflammation is a protective attempt by the body to both remove the injurious stimuli and initiate the healing process for the affected tissue or tissues. In the absence of inflammation, wounds and infections would never heal, creating a situation in which progressive destruction of the tissue would threaten survival. On the other hand, excessive or chronic inflammation may associate with a variety of diseases, such as hay fever, atherosclerosis, and rheumatoid arthritis, among others described herein and known in the art.
  • The NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents of the invention may modulate acute inflammation, chronic inflammation, or both. Certain embodiments relate to increasing acute inflammation or acute inflammatory responses, and certain embodiments relate to increasing chronic inflammation or chronic inflammatory responses. Depending on the needs of the subject, certain embodiments relate to reducing acute inflammation or inflammatory responses, and certain embodiments relate to reducing chronic inflammation or chronic inflammatory responses.
  • Acute inflammation relates to the initial response of the body to presumably harmful stimuli and involves increased movement of plasma and leukocytes from the blood into the injured tissues. It is a short-term process, typically beginning within minutes or hours and ending upon the removal of the injurious stimulus. Acute inflammation may be characterized by any one or more of redness, increased heat, swelling, pain, and loss of function. Redness and heat are due mainly to increased blood flow at body core temperature to the inflamed site, swelling is caused by accumulation of fluid, pain is typically due to release of chemicals that stimulate nerve endings, and loss of function has multiple causes.
  • Acute inflammatory responses are initiated mainly by local immune cells, such as resident macrophages, dendritic cells, histiocytes, Kuppfer cells and mastocytes. At the onset of an infection, burn, or other injuries, these cells undergo activation and release inflammatory mediators responsible for the clinical signs of inflammation, such as vasoactive amines and eicosanoids. Vasodilation and its resulting increased blood flow cause the redness and increased heat. Increased permeability of the blood vessels results in an exudation or leakage of plasma proteins and fluid into the tissue, which creates swelling. Certain released mediators such as bradykinin increase sensitivity to pain, and alter the blood vessels to permit the migration or extravasation of leukocytes, such as neutrophils, which typically migrate along a chemotactic gradient created by the local immune cells.
  • Acute inflammatory responses also includes one or more acellular biochemical cascade systems, consisting of preformed plasma proteins modulate, which act in parallel to initiate and propagate the inflammatory response. These systems include the complement system, which is mainly activated by bacteria, and the coagulation and fibrinolysis systems, which are mainly activated by necrosis, such as the type of tissue damage that is caused by certain infections, burns, or other trauma. Hence, antisense and RNAi agents may be used to modulate acute inflammation, or any of one or more of the individual acute inflammatory responses.
  • Chronic inflammation, a prolonged and delayed inflammatory response, is characterized by a progressive shift in the type of cells that are present at the site of inflammation, and often leads to simultaneous or near simultaneous destruction and healing of the tissue from the inflammatory process. At the cellular level, chronic inflammatory responses involve a variety of immune cells such as monocytes, macrophages, lymphocytes, plasma cells, and fibroblasts, though in contrast to acute inflammation, which is mediated mainly by granulocytes, chronic inflammation is mainly mediated by mononuclear cells such as monocytes and lymphocytes. Chronic inflammation also involves a variety of inflammatory mediators, such as IFN-γ and other cytokines, growth factors, reactive oxygen species, and hydrolytic enzymes. Chronic inflammation may last for many months or years, and may result in undesired tissue destruction and fibrosis.
  • Clinical signs of chronic inflammation are dependent upon duration of the illness, inflammatory lesions, cause and anatomical area affected. (see, e.g., Kumar et al., Robbins Basic Pathology-8th Ed., 2009 Elsevier, London; Miller, L M, Pathology Lecture Notes, Atlantic Veterinary College, Charlottetown, PEI, Canada). Chronic inflammation is associated with a variety of pathological conditions or diseases, including, for example, allergies, Alzheimer's disease, anemia, aortic valve stenosis, arthritis such as rheumatoid arthritis and osteoarthritis, cancer, congestive heart failure, fibromyalgia, fibrosis, heart attack, kidney failure, lupus, pancreatitis, stroke, surgical complications, inflammatory lung disease, inflammatory bowel disease, atherosclerosis, and psoriasis, among others described herein and known in the art. Hence, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to treat or manage chronic inflammation, modulate any of one or more of the individual chronic inflammatory responses, or treat any one or more diseases or conditions associated with chronic inflammation.
  • Antisense and RNAi agents may also modulate proliferative inflammation, an inflammatory process characterized by an increase in the number of tissue cells. These can encompass skin conditions such as psoriasis, seborrhea or eczema, or can also be thought of in terms of cancers and abnormal growths especially in light of accumulating evidence based on more efficient molecular methods to document even low grade chronic inflammation.
  • In certain embodiments, antisense and RNAi agents may modulate inflammatory responses at the cellular level, such as by modulating the activation, inflammatory molecule secretion (e.g., cytokine or kinin secretion), proliferation, activity, migration, or adhesion of various cells involved in inflammation. Examples of such cells include immune cells and vascular cells. Immune cells include, for example, granulocytes such as neutrophils, eosinophils and basophils, macrophages/monocytes, lymphocytes such as B-cells, killer T-cells (i.e., CD8+ T-cells), helper T-cells (i.e., CD4+ T-cells, including Th1 and T h2 cells), natural killer cells, γδ T-cells, dendritic cells, and mast cells. Examples of vascular cells include smooth muscle cells, endothelial cells, and fibroblasts. Also included are methods of modulating an inflammatory condition associated with one or more immune cells or vascular cells, including neutrophil-mediated, macrophage-mediated, and lymphocyte-mediated inflammatory conditions.
  • In certain embodiments, antisense and RNAi agents may modulate the levels or activity of inflammatory molecules, including plasma-derived inflammatory molecules and cell-derived inflammatory molecules (e.g., TNF-alpha, IL-1, IL-2, IL-5, adhesion molecules, Cox-2, and others). Included are pro-inflammatory molecules and anti-inflammatory molecules. Examples of plasma-derived inflammatory molecules include, without limitation, proteins or molecules of any one or more of the complement system, kinin system, coagulation system, and the fibrinolysis system. Examples of members of the complement system include C1, which exists in blood serum as a molecular complex containing about 6 molecules of C1q, 2 molecules of C1r, and 2 molecules of C1s, C2 (a and b), C3(a and B), C4 (a and b), C5, and the membrane attack complex of C5a, C5b, C6, C7, C8, and C9. Examples of the kinin system include bradykinin, kallidin, kallidreins, carboxypeptidases, angiotensin-converting enzyme, and neutral endopeptidase.
  • Examples of cell-derived inflammatory molecules include, without limitation, enzymes contained within lysosome granules, vasoactive amines, eicosanoids, cytokines, acute-phase proteins, and soluble gases such as nitric oxide. Vasoactive amines contain at least one amino group, and target blood vessels to alter their permeability or cause vasodilation. Examples of vasoactive amines include histamine and serotonin. Eicosanoids refer to signaling molecules made by oxidation of twenty-carbon essential fatty acids, and include prostaglandins, prostacyclins, thromboxanes, and leukotrienes.
  • Cytokines refer to a variety of substances that are secreted by immune cells, and include polypeptides and glycoproteins. Typically, cytokines are categorized as either autocrine cytokines, which act on the same type of cell from which the cytokine is secreted, or paracrine cytokines, which are restricted to acting on a different cell type from which the cytokine is secreted. Examples of cytokines that can be modulated include GM-CSF, IL-1a, IL1b, IL-2, IL-3, IL-4, IL-5, IL-6, IL-7, IL-8, IL-9, IL-10, IL-12, IFN-α, IFN-β, IFN-gamma, MIP-1α, MIP-1β, TGF-β, TNF-α, TNF-β, CXCL1-5, CXCL9-14, and CXCL16, among others known in the art.
  • Each cytokine typically has a corresponding cytokine receptor. Examples of classes of cytokine receptors include, without limitation, receptors from the immunoglobulin (Ig) superfamily, such as the IL-1 receptor types, which share structural homology with immunoglobulins (antibodies), cell adhesion molecules, and even some cytokines, and receptors from the hematopoietic growth factor family, such as the IL-2 receptor family and the receptors for GM-CSF, IL-3, and IL-5, receptors from the interferon (type 2) family, including receptors for IFN β and γ. Additional examples include receptors from the tumor necrosis factors (TNF) (type 3) family, which share a cysteine-rich common extracellular binding domain and interact with several other non-cytokine ligands such as CD40, CD27 and CD30, receptors from the seven transmembrane helix family, including G-protein coupled receptors, and chemokine receptors such as CXCR4 and CCR5, as well as receptors for IL-8, MIP-1 and RANTES. Hence, in certain embodiments, NHR-targeted antisense or RNAi agents may modulate the levels or activity of one or more selected cytokines, the levels or activity of one or more selected cytokine receptors, the interaction between cytokines and their receptors, or any combination thereof.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also modulate levels or activity of acute-phase proteins. Examples of acute-phase proteins include C-reactive protein, serum amyloid A, serum amyloid P, and vasopressin. In certain instances, expression of acute-phase proteins can cause a range of undesired systemic effects including amyloidosis, fever, increased blood pressure, decreased sweating, malaise, loss of appetite, and somnolence. Accordingly, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may modulate the levels or activity of acute-phase proteins, their systemic effects, or both.
  • In certain embodiments, antisense and RNAi agents may modulate local inflammation, systemic inflammation, or both. In certain embodiments, they may reduce or maintain (i.e., prevent further increases) local inflammation or local inflammatory responses. In certain embodiments, depending on the needs of the subject, antisense and RNAi agents may increase local inflammation or local inflammatory responses. In certain embodiments, they may reduce or maintain (i.e., prevent further increases) systemic inflammation or systemic inflammatory responses. In certain embodiments, depending on the needs of the subject, antisense and RNAi agents may increase systemic inflammation or systemic inflammatory responses.
  • In certain embodiments, the modulation of inflammation or inflammatory responses can be associated with one or more tissues or organs. Non-limiting examples of such tissues or organs include skin (e.g., dermis, epidermis, subcutaneous layer), hair follicles, nervous system (e.g., brain, spinal cord, peripheral nerves), auditory system or balance organs (e.g., inner ear, middle ear, outer ear), respiratory system (e.g., nose, trachea, lungs), gastroesophogeal tissues, the gastrointestinal system (e.g., mouth, esophagus, stomach, small intestines, large intestines, rectum), vascular system (e.g., heart, blood vessels and arteries), liver, gallbladder, lymphatic/immune system (e.g., lymph nodes, lymphoid follicles, spleen, thymus, bone marrow), uro-genital system (e.g., kidneys, ureter, bladder, urethra, cervix, Fallopian tubes, ovaries, uterus, vulva, prostate, bulbourethral glands, epidiymis, prostate, seminal vesicles, testicles), musculoskeletal system (e.g., skeletal muscles, smooth muscles, bone, cartilage, tendons, ligaments), adipose tissue, mammaries, and the endocrine system (e.g., hypothalamus, pituitary, thyroid, pancreas, adrenal glands). Accordingly, antisense and RNAi agents may be used to modulate inflammation associated with any of these tissues or organs, such as to treat conditions or diseases that are associated with the inflammation of these tissues or organs.
  • As noted above, certain embodiments may employ the antisense and RNAi agents described herein to reduce or manage (i.e., prevent further increases) inflammation or inflammatory responses associated with particular tissues or organs. Included are inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the skin, including inflammation, infections, and cancers associated with the dermal, epidermal, and subcutaneous layers of the skin. Examples of skin-associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, dermatitis, such as psoriasis, irritant dermatitis, seborrheic dermatitis, atopic dermatitis (eczema), allergic contact dermatitis, thermal-induced dermatitis, drug-induced dermatitis, dyshidrotic dermatitis, urticaria, autoimmune dermatitis, skin cancer such as melanoma, and bullous dermatitis. Also included are bacterial, viral and parasitic infections, erythema multiforme, erythema nodosum, granuloma annulare, poison oak/poison ivy, and toxic epidermal necrolysis.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the nervous system, including inflammation, infections, and cancer associated with the brain and spinal cord of the central nervous system, the peripheral nervous system, and the meninges. Expression of inflammatory mediators including complement, adhesion molecules, cyclooxygenase enzymes and their products and cytokines is increased in experimental and clinical neurodegenerative disease, and intervention studies in experimental animals suggest that several of these factors contribute directly to neuronal injury. For instance, specific cytokines, such as interleukin-1 (IL-1), have been implicated heavily in acute neurodegeneration, such as stroke and head injury.
  • Examples of nervous system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, meningitis (i.e., inflammation of the protective membranes covering the brain and spinal cord), myelitis, encaphaloymyelitis (e.g., myalgic encephalomyelitis, acute disseminated encephalomyelitis, encephalomyelitis disseminata or multiple sclerosis, autoimmune encephalomyelitis), arachnoiditis (i.e., inflammation of the arachnoid, one of the membranes that surround and protect the nerves of the central nervous system), granuloma, drug-induced inflammation or meningitis, neurodegenerative diseases such as Alzheimer's disease, stroke, HIV-dementia, encephalitis such viral encephalitis and bacterial encephalitis, parasitic infections, inflammatory demyeleniating disorders, and auto-immune disorders such as CD8+ T Cell-mediated autoimmune diseases of the CNS. Additional examples include Parkinson's disease, myasthenia gravis, motor neuropathy, Guillain-Barre syndrome, autoimmune neuropathy, Lambert-Eaton myasthenic syndrome, paraneoplastic neurological disease, paraneoplastic cerebellar atrophy, non-paraneoplastic stiff man syndrome, progressive cerebellar atrophy, Rasmussen's encephalitis, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, Sydeham chorea, Gilles de la Tourette syndrome, autoimmune polyendocrinopathy, dysimmune neuropathy, acquired neuromyotonia, arthrogryposis multiplex, optic neuritis, and stiff-man syndrome.
  • As noted above, also included is inflammation associated with infections of the nervous system. Specific examples of bacterial infections associated with inflammation of the nervous system include, without limitation, streptococcal infection such as group B streptococci (e.g., subtypes III) and Streptococcus pneumoniae (e.g., serotypes 6, 9, 14, 18 and 23), Escherichia coli (e.g., carrying K1 antigen), Listeria monocytogenes (e.g., serotype IVb), neisserial infection such as Neisseria meningitidis (meningococcus), staphylococcal infection, heamophilus infection such as Haemophilus influenzae type B, Klebsiella, and Mycobacterium tuberculosis. Also included are infections by staphylococci and pseudomonas and other Gram-negative bacilli, mainly with respect to trauma to the skull, which gives bacteria in the nasal cavity the potential to enter the meningeal space, or in persons with cerebral shunt or related device (e.g., extraventricular drain, Ommaya reservoir). Specific examples of viral infections associated with inflammation of the nervous system include, without limitation, enteroviruses, herpes simplex virus type 1 and 2, human T-lymphotrophic virus, varicella zoster virus (chickenpox and shingles), mumps virus, human immunodeficiency virus (HIV), and lymphocytic choriomeningitis virus (LCMV). Meningitis may also result from infection by spirochetes such as Treponema pallidum (syphilis) and Borrelia burgdorferi (Lyme disease), parasites such as malaria (e.g., cerebral malaria), fungi such as Cryptococcus neoformans, and ameoba such as Naegleria fowleri.
  • Meningitis or other forms of nervous system inflammation may also associate with the spread of cancer to the meninges (malignant meningitis), certain drugs such as non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs, antibiotics and intravenous immunoglobulins, sarcoidosis (or neurosarcoidosis), connective tissue disorders such as systemic lupus erythematosus, and certain forms of vasculitis (inflammatory conditions of the blood vessel wall) such as Behçet's disease. Epidermoid cysts and dermoid cysts may cause meningitis by releasing irritant matter into the subarachnoid space. Accordingly, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to treat or manage any one or more of these conditions.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the auditory system or balance organs, such as the inner ear, middle ear, and the outer ear. Examples of auditory system or balance organ associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, outer ear inflammation (e.g., ear infections), middle ear inflammation, which may lead to fluid build-up in the normally air-filled space and associated conductive hearing loss, labyrinthitis, an inner ear infection or inflammation causing both dizziness (vertigo) and hearing loss, vestibular neuronitis, an infection of the vestibular nerve, generally viral, causing vertigo, and cochlear neuronitis, an infection of the cochlear nerve, generally viral, causing sudden deafness but no vertigo. Recipients of cochlear implants for hearing loss are at an increased risk of pneumococcal meningitis and its associated inflammation.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the respiratory system, including inflammation, infections, and cancer associated with the nose, trachea, and lungs. Examples of respiratory system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, atopic asthma, non-atopic asthma, allergic asthma, atopic bronchial IgE-mediated asthma, bronchial asthma, essential asthma, true asthma, intrinsic asthma caused by pathophysiologic disturbances, extrinsic asthma caused by environmental factors, essential asthma of unknown or inapparent cause, non-atopic asthma, bronchitic asthma, emphysematous asthma, exercise-induced asthma, allergen induced asthma, cold air induced asthma, occupational asthma, infective asthma caused by bacterial, fungal, protozoal, or viral infection, non-allergic asthma, incipient asthma, wheezy infant syndrome and bronchiolytis, chronic or acute bronchoconstriction, chronic bronchitis, small airways obstruction, and emphysema. Further examples include obstructive or inflammatory airways diseases such as chronic eosinophilic pneumonia, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease (COPD), COPD that includes chronic bronchitis, pulmonary emphysema or dyspnea associated or not associated with COPD, COPD that is characterized by irreversible, progressive airways obstruction, and adult respiratory distress syndrome (ARDS).
  • Further examples of conditions associated with pulmonary inflammation include conditions related to exacerbation of airways hyper-reactivity consequent to other drug therapy, airways disease that is associated with pulmonary hypertension, bronchitis such as acute bronchitis, acute laryngotracheal bronchitis, arachidic bronchitis, catarrhal bronchitis, croupus bronchitis, dry bronchitis, infectious asthmatic bronchitis, productive bronchitis, staphylococcus or streptococcal bronchitis and vesicular bronchitis, acute lung injury, and bronchiectasis such as cylindric bronchiectasis, sacculated bronchiectasis, fusiform bronchiectasis, capillary bronchiectasis, cystic bronchiectasis, dry bronchiectasis and follicular bronchiectasis.
  • COPD in particular refers to a group of lung diseases that block airflow and make it increasingly difficult for affected individuals to breathe normally. Emphysema and chronic bronchitis are the two main conditions within the group of COPD diseases, but COPD can also refer to damage caused by chronic asthmatic bronchitis, among other conditions known in the art. In most cases, damage to the airways eventually interferes with the exchange of oxygen and carbon dioxide in the lungs. Standard treatments focus mainly on controlling symptoms and minimizing further damage.
  • Emphysema represents one aspect of COPD. Emphysema leads to inflammation within the fragile walls of the alveoli, which may destroy some of the walls and elastic fibers, allowing small airways to collapse upon exhaling, and impairing airflow out of the lungs. Signs and symptoms of emphysema include, for instance, shortness of breath, especially during physical activities, wheezing, and chest tightness.
  • Chronic bronchitis represents another aspect of COPD. Chronic bronchitis is characterized by an ongoing cough, and leads to inflammation and narrowing of the bronchial tubes. This condition also causes increased mucus production, which can further block the narrowed tubes. Chronic bronchitis occurs mainly in smokers, and is typically defined as a cough that lasts for at least three months a year for two consecutive years. Signs and symptoms of chronic bronchitis include, for example, having to clear the throat first thing in the morning, especially for smokers, a chronic cough that produces yellowish sputum, shortness of breath in the later stages, and frequent respiratory infections.
  • As noted above, COPD refers primarily to obstruction in the lungs resulting from the two above-noted chronic lung conditions. However, many individuals with COPD have both of these conditions.
  • Chronic asthmatic bronchitis represents another aspect of COPD. Chronic asthmatic bronchitis is usually characterized as chronic bronchitis combined with asthma (bronchospasm). Asthma may occur when inflamed and infected secretions irritate the smooth muscles in the airways. Symptoms are similar to those of chronic bronchitis, but also include intermittent, or even daily, episodes of wheezing.
  • In certain embodiments, COPD is ultimately caused by cigarette smoke and other irritants. In the vast majority of cases, the lung damage that leads to COPD is caused by long-term cigarette smoking. However, other irritants may cause COPD, including cigar smoke, secondhand smoke, pipe smoke, air pollution and certain occupational fumes. Gastroesophageal reflux disease (GERD), which occurs when stomach acids wash back up into the esophagus, can not only aggravate COPD, but may even cause it in some individuals. In rare cases, COPD results from a genetic disorder that causes low levels of a protein called alpha-1-antitrypsin. Hence, risk factors for COPD include exposure to tobacco smoke, occupational exposure to dusts and chemicals (long-term exposure to chemical fumes, vapors and dusts irritates and inflames the lungs), gastroesophageal reflux disease (a severe form of acid reflux—the backflow of acid and other stomach contents into the esophagus), age (COPD develops slowly over years, so most people are at least 40 years old when symptoms begin), and genetics (a rare genetic disorder known as alpha-1-antitrypsin deficiency is the source of a few cases of COPD).
  • Complications or associated symptoms of COPD may include increased risk of respiratory infections, high blood pressure, heart problems (e.g., heart attacks, arrhythmias, cor pulmonale), lung cancer (smokers with chronic bronchitis are at a higher risk of developing lung cancer than are smokers who don't have chronic bronchitis), pneumonia, pneumothorax, and depression, among others known in the art. Further examples include cough that produces mucus and may be streaked with blood, fatigue, frequent respiratory infections, headaches, shortness of breath (dyspnea) that worsens with mild activity, swelling of the ankles, feet, or legs, which affects both sides of the body, and wheezing. NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to reduce or manage the complications or symptoms associated with COPD or other pulmonary conditions related to inflammation.
  • Subjects with COPD may be identified according to routine diagnostic techniques known in the art. For instance, pulmonary function tests, such as spirometry, measure how much air the lungs can hold and how fast an individual can blow the air out of their lungs. Spirometry can detect COPD before the appearance of symptoms, and can also be used to track disease progression and monitor treatment. In addition, chest X-rays show emphysema, one of the main causes of COPD, and may also rule out other lung problems or heart failure. In addition, arterial blood gas analysis measures how effectively the lungs bring oxygen into the blood and remove carbon dioxide, providing an indication of COPD. Sputum examination, i.e., the analysis of the cells in the sputum, can identify the cause of certain lung problems and help rule out certain lung cancers. Also, computerized tomography (CT) scan produces highly-detailed images of the internal organs, which can help detect emphysema, and, thus, COPD.
  • As elsewhere herein, the amount of NHR-targeted antisense or RNAi agent administered to a subject with COPD (or at risk for COPD) will depend on the characteristics of that subject, such as general health, age, sex, body weight, and tolerance to drugs, as well as the degree, severity, and type of reaction to the agent. For instance, multiple administrations may be utilized (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, etc), typically at a defined frequency (number of administrations per day, per week, per month, etc).
  • Also included are combination therapies. For instance, one or more NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents can be utilized in combination with other treatments for pulmonary inflammation or COPD. Examples of such treatments included, without limitation, lifestyle changes, such as quitting or reducing smoking or other exposure to lung irritants, lung rehabilitation, the use of bronchodilators (e.g., ipratropium, tiotropium, salmeterol, formoterol), steroids such as corticosteroids, antibiotics, metered-dose inhalers (MDIs) and dry powder inhalers (DPIs), nebulizers, replacement gene therapy for alpha-1-antitrypsin deficiency, oxygen therapy, and surgery, including bullectomy, lung volume reduction surgery, and lung transplant.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated the gastrointestinal system, including inflammation, infections, and cancer associated with the mouth, esophagus, stomach, small intestines, large intestines, and rectum. “Gastrointestinal inflammation” as used herein refers to inflammation of a mucosal layer of the gastrointestinal tract, and encompasses acute and chronic inflammatory conditions. Acute inflammation is generally characterized by a short time of onset and infiltration or influx of neutrophils. Chronic inflammation is generally characterized by a relatively longer period of onset and infiltration or influx of mononuclear cells. Chronic inflammation can also typically characterized by periods of spontaneous remission and spontaneous occurrence. “Mucosal layer of the gastrointestinal tract” is meant to include mucosa of the bowel (including the small intestine and large intestine), rectum, stomach (gastric) lining, oral cavity, and the like.
  • “Chronic gastrointestinal inflammation” refers to inflammation of the mucosal of the gastrointestinal tract that is characterized by a relatively longer period of onset, is long-lasting (e.g., from several days, weeks, months, or years and up to the life of the subject), and is often associated with infiltration or influx of mononuclear cells, and can be further associated with periods of spontaneous remission and spontaneous occurrence. “Chronic gastrointestinal inflammatory conditions” (also referred to as “chronic gastrointestinal inflammatory diseases”) having such chronic inflammation include, but are not limited to, inflammatory bowel disease (IBD), colitis induced by environmental insults (e.g., gastrointestinal inflammation associated with a therapeutic regimen, such as chemotherapy, radiation therapy, and the like), colitis in conditions such as chronic granulomatous disease (see, e.g., Schappi et al., Arch Dis Child. 84:147-151, 2001), celiac disease, celiac sprue (i.e., a heritable disease in which the intestinal lining is inflamed in response to the ingestion of a protein known as gluten), food allergies, gastritis, infectious gastritis or enterocolitis (e.g., Helicobacter pylori-infected chronic active gastritis) and other forms of gastrointestinal inflammation caused by an infectious agent, and other like conditions.
  • As used herein, “inflammatory bowel disease” or “IBD” refers to any of a variety of diseases characterized by inflammation of all or part of the intestines. Examples of inflammatory bowel disease include, but are not limited to, Crohn's disease and ulcerative colitis. The term IBD includes pseudomembranous colitis, hemorrhagic colitis, hemolytic-uremic syndrome colitis, collagenous colitis, ischemic colitis, radiation colitis, drug and chemically induced colitis, diversion colitis, ulcerative colitis, irritable bowel syndrome, irritable colon syndrome and Crohn's disease; and within Crohn's disease all the subtypes including active, refractory, and fistulizing and Crohn's disease. Hence, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be employed to treat or manage any one or more of these conditions.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the vascular system, or vascular inflammation, such as inflammation associated with the blood vessels and the heart. Examples of vascular system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, myocarditis, pericarditis, occlusive disease, atherosclerosis, myocardial infarction, thrombosis, Wegener's granulomatosis, Takayasu's arteritis, Kawasaki syndrome, anti-factor VIII autoimmune disease, necrotizing small vessel vasculitis, microscopic polyangiitis, Churg and Strauss syndrome, pauci-immune focal necrotizing glomerulonephritis, crescentic glomerulonephritis, antiphospholipid syndrome, antibody induced heart failure, thrombocytopenic purpura, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, cardiac autoimmunity in Chagas' disease, and anti-helper T lymphocyte autoimmunity. Also included are endocarditis, or infection of the heart valves with spread of small clusters of bacteria through the bloodstream, phlebitis or vasculitis, inflammation of one or more veins, and thrombophlebitis, vein inflammation related to a thrombus. Thrombophlebitis may occur repeatedly in different locations, and is then referred to as thrombophlebitis migrans, or migrating thrombophlebitis. Phlebitis may associate with a variety of causes, such as bacterial infection, exposure to chemical agents, such as irritating or vesicant solutions, physical trauma from skin puncture such as movement of a cannula into the vein during insertion, medications such as Celebrex, Olanzepine, antidepressants, and others, and alcohol abuse. Certain embodiments may relate to treating or managing heart inflammation caused by any one or more of acute rheumatic fever, congenital toxoplasmosis, enterovirus antenatal infection, lyme disease, and rheumatic fever.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the liver or gallbladder, including acute and chronic liver inflammation, and acute and chronic cholecystis. Examples of liver or gallbladder associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, auto-immune hepatitis, viral hepatitis (e.g., Hepatitis A virus, Hepatitis B virus, Hepatitis C virus, Hepatitis D virus, Hepatitis E virus, mononucleosis, rubella, Epstein-Barr virus, and cytomegalovirus), other causes of hepatitis such as severe bacterial infection, ameobic infections, medicines (e.g., agomelatine, allopurinol, amitryptyline, amiodarone, asathioprine, paracetamol, halothane, ibuprofen, indomethacin, isoniazid, rifampicin, pyrazinamide, ketoconazole, loratadine, methotrexate, methyldopa, minocycline, nifedipine, nitrofurantoin, phenytoin, valproic acid, troglitazone, zidovudine), toxins (e.g., alcohol, fungal toxins), and metabolic disorders (e.g., Wilson's disease, a disorder of the body's copper metabolism, haemochromatosis, disorder of the body's iron metabolism, non-alcoholic steatohepatitis, alpha 1-antitrypsin deficiency). Additional examples include non-alcoholic fatty liver disease, cirrhosis such as primary biliary cirrhosis, obstructive jaundice, ischemic hepatitis, and gall bladder disease.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the lymphatic/immune system. Examples of lymphatic/immune system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, auto-immune diseases, such as Chagas disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disorder (COPD), Crohn's disease, dermatomyositis, diabetes mellitus type I, endometriosis, Goodpasture's syndrome, Graves' disease, Guillain-Barre syndrome, Hachimoto's disease, hidradenitis suppurativa, Kawasaki disease, IgA nephropathy, idiopathic thrombocytopenia purpura, interstitial cystitis, lupus erythematosus, mixed connective tissue disease, morphea, myasthenia gravis, narcolepsy, neuromyotonia, pemphigus vulgaris, pernicous anemia, psoriasis, psoriatic arthritis, poliomyositis, primary biliary cirrhosis, rheumatoid arthritis, schizophrenia, scleroderma, Sjogren's syndrome, stiff person syndrome, temporal arteritis, ulcerative colitis, vitiligo, and Wegener's granulomatosis, in addition to autoimmune hemolytic anemia, and various lymphadenopathies.
  • Also included are immune-related inflammatory conditions associated with the transplantation of a graft, tissue, cell or organ, such as graft rejection, chronic graft rejection, subacute graft rejection, hyperacute graft rejection, acute graft rejection, and graft versus host disease. In certain embodiments, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents can be administered to a transplant donor before or during tissue removal. In certain embodiments, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents can be administered to a transplant recipient before, during, and/or after transplant therapy to reduce inflammation-related complications of transplant therapy. Examples of transplant therapies include bone marrow, stem cell, peripheral blood, liver, lung, heart, skin, and kidney, among others known in the art. Additional examples include inflammatory conditions associated with allergies, such as asthma, hives, urticaria, pollen allergy, dust mite allergy, venom allergy, cosmetics allergy, latex allergy, chemical allergy, drug allergy, insect bite allergy, animal dander allergy, stinging plant allergy, poison ivy allergy and food allergy.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the uro-genital system. Examples of uro-genital system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, inflammations, infections or cancers of the ureter, bladder, urethra, cervix, Fallopian tubes, ovaries, uterus, womb, vulva, prostate, bulbourethral glands, epidiymis, prostate, seminal vesicles, testicles, or kidneys. Also included are auto-immune interstitial nephritis, renal abscess (intrarenal or extrarenal), acute prostatitis, hematuria, urethritis (e.g., Chlamydia and other sexually transmitted diseases), pelvic inflammatory disease (PID), and prostatic abscess. Also included is nephritis associated with one or more of glomerulonephritis, lupus nephritis, nephropathy, gout, poisons or chemicals (e.g., ether, thallium sulfate), certain medications (e.g., piroxicam, candyl, feldene gel, fensaid, pirox), Herrmann syndrome, yellow fever, immune complex diseases, typhoid fever, urethral stricture, renal tuberculosism, and post-streptococcal glomerulonephritis.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the musculoskeletal system. Examples of musculoskeletal system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, arthritis such as rheumatoid arthritis and psoriatic arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, auto-immune myositis, primary Sjogren's syndrome, smooth muscle auto-immune disease, myositis, polymyositis, tendinitis, ligament inflammation, cartilage inflammation, joint inflammation, synovial inflammation, carpal tunnel syndrome, chronic muscle inflammation, and bone inflammation, including bone inflammation associated with osteoporosis and osteoarthritis. Also included are Tietze's syndrome, a benign, painful, nonsuppurative localized swelling of the costosternal, sternoclavicular, or costochondral joints, costochondritis, sternalis syndrome, xiphoidalgia, spontaneous sternoclavicular subluxation, sternocostoclavicular hyperostosis, fibromyalgia, shoulder tendinitis or bursitis, gouty arthritis, polymyalgia rheumatica, lupus erythematosus, bone spurs, and fractures such as stress fractures.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with the endocrine system. Examples of endocrine system associated inflammatory conditions include, without limitation, inflammation, infection, or cancer associated with the hypothalamus, pituitary, thyroid, pancreas, or adrenal glands, glandular diseases such as pancreatic disease, diabetes such as Type I diabetes, thyroid disease, Graves' disease, thyroiditis, spontaneous autoimmune thyroiditis, Hashimoto's thyroiditis, idiopathic myxedema, ovarian autoimmunity, autoimmune anti-sperm infertility, autoimmune prostatitis and Type I autoimmune polyglandular syndrome.
  • Certain embodiments relate to reducing inflammatory responses and conditions associated with adipose tissues, an active participant in regulating physiologic and pathologic processes, including immunity and inflammation. Macrophages are components of adipose tissue and actively participate in its activities. Furthermore, cross-talk between lymphocytes and adipocytes can lead to immune regulation. Adipose tissue produces and releases a variety of pro-inflammatory and anti-inflammatory factors, including the adipokines leptin, adiponectin, resistin, and visfatin, as well as cytokines and chemokines, such as TNF-alpha, IL-6, monocyte chemoattractant protein 1, and others. Proinflammatory molecules produced by adipose tissue have been implicated as active participants in the development of insulin resistance and the increased risk of cardiovascular disease associated with obesity. In contrast, reduced leptin levels may predispose to increased susceptibility to infection caused by reduced T-cell responses in malnourished individuals. Altered adipokine levels have been observed in a variety of inflammatory conditions (see, e.g., Fantuzzi, J Allergy Clin Immunol. 115:911-19, 2005; and Berg et al., Circulation Research. 96:939, 2005).
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be employed to treat or manage inflammation associated with hypersensitivity. Examples of such conditions include type I hypersensitivity, type II hypersensitivity, type III hypersensitivity, type IV hypersensitivity, immediate hypersensitivity, antibody mediated hypersensitivity, immune complex mediated hypersensitivity, T-lymphocyte mediated hypersensitivity, and delayed type hypersensitivity.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be employed to treat or manage auto-inflammatory conditions. Examples of auto-inflammatory conditions include familial Mediterranean fever, TNF receptor associated periodic syndrome (TRAPS), Hyper-IgD syndrome (HIDS), CIAS1-related diseases such as Muckle-Wells syndrome, familial cold auto-inflammatory syndrome, and neonatal onset multisystem inflammatory disease, PAPA syndrome (pyogenic sterile arthritis, pyoderma gangrenosum, acne), and Blau syndrome.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be employed to treat or manage inflammation associated with a variety of cancers. Examples of such cancers include, without limitation, prostate cancer, breast cancer, colon cancer, rectal cancer, lung cancer, ovarian cancer, testicular cancer, stomach cancer, bladder cancer, pancreatic cancer, liver cancer, kidney cancer, brain cancer, melanoma, non-melanoma skin cancer, bone cancer, lymphoma, leukemia, thyroid cancer, endometrial cancer, multiple myeloma, acute myeloid leukemia, neuroblastoma, glioblastoma, and non-Hodgkin's lymphoma.
  • As noted above, certain embodiments may employ NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents to modulate systemic inflammation, such as to reduce or manage systemic inflammation. In certain embodiments, systemic inflammation may by associated with systemic inflammatory response syndrome (SIRS), a whole-body inflammatory condition with a variety of potential causes. SIRS may be characterized or identified according to routine diagnostic techniques. As one non-limiting example, SIRS may be identified by the presence of two or more of the following: (i) a body temperature that is less than 36° C. or greater than 38° C., (ii) a heart rate that is greater than 90 beats per minute, (iii) tachypnea (high respiratory rate), with greater than 20 breaths per minute; or, an arterial partial pressure of carbon dioxide less than 4.3 kPa (32 mmHg), and (iv) white blood cell count less than 4000 cells/mm3 (4×109 cells/L) or greater than 12,000 cells/mm3 (12×109 cells/L); or the presence of greater than 10% immature neutrophils (band forms).
  • SIRS is broadly classified as either infectious or non-infectious. Most generally, infectious SIRS is associated with sepsis, a whole-body inflammatory state combined with a known or suspected infection, which includes bacteremia, viremia, parasitemia, and toxic shock syndrome. Sepsis may be associated with a wide variety of infectious agents, including, without limitation, bacteria such as Streptococcus agalactiae, Escherichia coli, Haemophilus influenzae, Listeria monocytogenes, Coagulase-negative Staphylococcus, Staphylococcus aureus, Klebsiella species, Pseudomonas aeruginosa, Enterobacter species, S. agalactiae, Serratia species, Acinetobacter species, Streptococcus pneumoniae, Salmonella species, and Neisseria meningitidis; viruses such as rubella, cytomegalovirus, herpes simplex and the chickenpox virus; parasites such as in malarial infection (e.g., Plasmodium falciparum), trypanosomiasis, and filariasis; and fungi such as Candida species, Aspergillus species, Histoplasma species, Cryptococcus neoformans, Coccidioides immitis, Blastomyces dermatitidis, and Pneumocystis carinii. In certain instances, infections in the lungs (e.g., pneumonia), bladder and kidneys (e.g., urinary tract infections), skin (e.g., cellulitis), abdomen (e.g., appendicitis), and other areas (e.g., meningitis) can spread and lead to sepsis. NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to modulate inflammation associated with any of these infectious agents, whether sepsis is present or otherwise.
  • Noninfectious SIRS may be associated with trauma, burns, pancreatitis, ischemia, hemorrhage, surgical complications, adrenal insufficiency, pulmonary embolism, aortic aneurysm, cardiac tamponade, anaphylaxis, and drug overdose, among others. SIRS is often complicated by the failure of one or more organs or organ system, including those described herein. Specific examples include acute lung injury, acute kidney injury, shock, and multiple organ dysfunction syndrome, among others. Typically, SIRS is treated by focusing on the underlying problem (e.g., adequate fluid replacement for hypovolemia, IVF/NPO for pancreatitis, epinephrine/steroids/benadryl for anaphylaxis). In certain instances, selenium, glutamine, and eicosapentaenoic acid have shown effectiveness in improving symptoms of SIRS, and antioxidants such as vitamin E may also be helpful. Hence, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to treat or manage SIRS and the complications of SIRS, alone or in combination with other therapies.
  • Systemic inflammation may also be associated with “cytokine storm,” a dangerous immune reaction caused by a positive feedback loop between cytokines and immune cells, resulting in highly elevated levels of various cytokines. In certain instances, cytokine storm (hypercytokinemia) includes the systemic release of numerous known inflammatory mediators such as cytokines, oxygen free radicals, and coagulation factors). Included are elevated levels of pro-inflammatory cytokines such as TNF-alpha, IL-1, and IL-6, and anti-inflammatory cytokines such as IL-10 and IL-1 receptor antagonist. Cytokine storms can occur in a number of infectious and non-infectious diseases including graft versus host disease (GVHD), acute respiratory distress syndrome (ARDS), sepsis, avian influenza, smallpox, and SIRS. Cytokine storm may also be induced by certain medications. Treatment includes OX40 IG, which reduces T-cell responses, ACE inhibitors, Angiotensin II receptor blockers, corticosteroids, gemfibrozil, free radical scavengers, and TNF-α blockers. Accordingly, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be employed to treat or manage cytokine storm, alone or in combination with other therapies.
  • Certain embodiments may employ NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents to reduce any one or more of granulomatous inflammation, fibrinous inflammation, purulent inflammation, serous inflammation, or ulcerative inflammation. Granulomatous inflammation is characterized by the formation of granulomas, typically resulting from a response to infectious agents such as tuberculosis, leprosy, and syphilis. Fibrinous inflammation results from a large increase in vascular permeability, which allows fibrin to pass through the blood vessels. If an appropriate pro-coagulative stimulus is present, such as a cancer cell, a fibrinous exudate is deposited. This process is commonly seen in serous cavities, where the conversion of fibrinous exudate into a scar can occur between serous membranes, limiting their function. Purulent inflammation results from the formation of a large amount of pus, which consists of neutrophils, dead cells, and fluid. Infection by pyogenic bacteria such as staphylococci is characteristic of this kind of inflammation. Large, localized collections of pus enclosed by surrounding tissues are called abscesses. Serous inflammation is characterized by the copious effusion of non-viscous serous fluid, commonly produced by mesothelial cells of serous membranes, but may also be derived from blood plasma. Examples of this type of inflammation include skin blisters. Ulcerative inflammation, which typically occurs near an epithelium, results in the necrotic loss of tissue from the surface, thereby exposing lower layers of tissue. The subsequent excavation of the epithelium is known as an ulcer.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be employed in the treatment of physical injuries or wounds. Examples include abrasions, bruises, cuts, puncture wounds, lacerations, impact wounds, concussions, contusions, thermal burns, frostbite, chemical burns, sunburns, gangrene, necrosis, desiccations, radiation burns, radioactivity burns, smoke inhalation, torn muscles, pulled muscles, torn tendons, pulled tendons, pulled ligaments, torn ligaments, hyperextensions, torn cartilage, bone fractures, pinched nerves, ulcers, and gunshot or other traumatic wounds.
  • NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be employed to treat or manage idiopathic inflammation or inflammation of unknown etiology. Also included are combination therapies, in which one or more NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents are administered or utilized in combination with one or more other therapies for any of the inflammatory diseases or conditions described herein, including those therapies that are commonly available and known in the art. Examples of combination therapies include the use of standard anti-inflammatory agents such as non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs (NSAIDs), immune selective anti-inflammatory derivatives (ImSAIDs), and steroids (e.g., corticosteroids), anti-infectives such as antibiotics and anti-viral agents, anti-oxidants, cytokines, chemotherapeutic agents and other anti-cancer therapies, and immunosuppressive therapies.
  • Criteria for assessing the signs and symptoms of inflammatory and other conditions, including for purposes of making differential diagnosis and also for monitoring treatments such as determining whether a therapeutically effective dose has been administered in the course of treatment, e.g., by determining improvement according to accepted clinical criteria, will be apparent to those skilled in the art and are exemplified by the teachings of e.g., Berkow et al., eds., The Merck Manual, 16th edition, Merck and Co., Rahway, N.J., 1992; Goodman et al., eds., Goodman and Gilman's The Pharmacological Basis of Therapeutics, 10th edition, Pergamon Press, Inc., Elmsford, N.Y., (2001); Avery's Drug Treatment: Principles and Practice of Clinical Pharmacology and Therapeutics, 3rd edition, ADIS Press, Ltd., Williams and Wilkins, Baltimore, Md. (1987); Ebadi, Pharmacology, Little, Brown and Co., Boston, (1985); Osolci al., eds., Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18th edition, Mack Publishing Co., Easton, Pa. (1990); Katzung, Basic and Clinical Pharmacology, Appleton and Lange, Norwalk, Conn. (1992).
  • Certain embodiments may employ NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents to increase inflammation. For instance, depending on the needs of the subject, certain embodiments may increase acute inflammation or increase acute inflammatory responses or both. Certain embodiments may increase chronic inflammation or chronic inflammatory responses or both. Certain embodiments may increase both acute and chronic inflammation. Certain embodiments may increase local or systemic inflammation or both.
  • In certain embodiments, NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to treat or manage immunodeficiencies, including primary immunodeficiencies and secondary immunodeficiencies, in which the body may not mount an adequate inflammatory response. Examples of primary immunodeficiencies include various autosomal recessive and X-linked genetic conditions such as T-cell and B-cell immunodeficiencies, including combined T-cell and B-cell immunodeficiencies, antibody deficiencies, well-defined syndromes, immune dysregulation diseases, phagocyte disorders, innate immunity disorders, and complement deficiencies.
  • Examples of T-cell and B-cell immunodeficiencies include T−/B+ deficiencies such as γc deficiency, JAK3 deficiency, interleukin 7 receptor chain a deficiency, CD45 deficiency, CD3δ/CD3ε deficiency; and T−/B− deficiencies such as RAG 1/2 deficiency, DCLRE1C deficiency, adenosine deaminase (ADA) deficiency, reticular dysgenesis. Additional examples include Omenn syndrome, DNA ligase type IV deficiency, CD40 ligand deficiency, CD40 deficiency, purine nucleoside phosphorylase (PNP) deficiency, MHC class II deficiency, CD3γ deficiency, CD8 deficiency, ZAP-70 deficiency, TAP-1/2 deficiency, and winged helix deficiency.
  • Examples of antibody deficiencies include X-linked agammaglobulinemia (btk deficiency, or Bruton's agammaglobulinemia), μ-Heavy chain deficiency, 1-5 deficiency, Igα deficiency, BLNK deficiency, thymoma with immunodeficiency, common variable immunodeficiency (CVID), ICOS deficiency, CD19 deficiency, TACI (TNFRSF13B) deficiency, and BAFF receptor deficiency. Additional examples include AID deficiency, UNG deficiency, heavy chain deletions, kappa chain deficiency, isolated IgG subclass deficiency, IgA with IgG subclass deficiency, selective immunoglobulin A deficiency, and transient hypogammaglobulinemia of infancy (THI).
  • Examples of “well-defined syndromes” include Wiskott-Aldrich syndrome, ataxia telangiectasia, ataxia-like syndrome, Nijmegen breakage syndrome, Bloom syndrome, DiGeorge syndrome, immuno-osseous dysplasias such as cartilage-hair hypoplasia, Schimke syndrome, Hermansky-Pudlak syndrome type 2, Hyper-IgE syndrome, chronic mucocutaneous candidiasis.
  • Examples of immune dysregulation diseases include immunodeficiency with hypopigmentation or albinism such as Chediak-Higashi syndrome and Griscelli syndrome type 2, familial hemophagocytic lymphohistiocytosis such as perforin deficiency, MUNC13D deficiency, and syntaxin 11 deficiency, X-linked lymphoproliferative syndrome, autoimmune lymphoproliferative syndrome such as type 1a (CD95 defects), type 1b (Fas ligand defects), type 2a (CASP10 defects), and type 2b (CASP8 defects), autoimmune polyendocrinopathy with candidiasis and ectodermal dystrophy, and immunodysregulation polyendocrinopathy enteropathy X-linked syndrome. Additionally, diseases affecting the bone marrow may result in abnormal or few leukocytes, such as leukopenia. Leukopenia can be induced by certain infections and diseases, including viral infection, Rickettsia infection, some protozoa, tuberculosis, and certain cancers
  • Examples of phagocyte disorders include severe congenital neutropenia such as ELA2 deficiency (e.g., with myelodysplasia), GFI1 deficiency (with T/B lymphopenia) or G-CSFR deficiency (G-CSF-unresponsive), Kostmann syndrome, cyclic neutropenia, X-linked neutropenia/myelodysplasia, leukocyte adhesion deficiency types 1, 2 and 3, RAC2 deficiency, 0-actin deficiency, localized juvenile periodontitis, Papillon-Lefèvre syndrome, specific granule deficiency, Shwachman-Diamond syndrome, chronic granulomatous disease, including X-linked and autosomal forms, neutrophil glucose-6-phosphate dehydrogenase deficiency, IL-12 and IL-23 β1 chain deficiency, IL-12p40 deficiency, interferon γ receptor 1 deficiency, interferon γ receptor 2 deficiency, and STAT1 deficiency.
  • Examples of innate immunity deficiencies include hypohidrotic ectodermal dysplasia such as NEMO deficiency and IKBA deficiency, IRAK-4 deficiency, WHIM syndrome (warts, hypogammaglobulinaemia, infections, myleokathexis), and epidermodysplasia verruciformis. Examples of complement deficiencies and exemplary associated conditions include C1q deficiency (e.g., lupus-like syndrome, rheumatoid disease, infections), C1r deficiency, C4 deficiency, C2 deficiency (e.g., lupus-like syndrome, vasculitis, polymyositis, pyogenic infections), C3 deficiency (e.g., recurrent pyogenic infections), C5 deficiency (e.g., neisserial infections), C6 deficiency, C7 deficiency (e.g., vasculitis), C8a and C8b deficiency, C9 deficiency (e.g., neisserial infections), C1-inhibitor deficiency (e.g., hereditary angioedema), Factor I deficiency (pyogenic infections), Factor H deficiency (e.g., haemolytic-uraemic syndrome, membranoproliferative glomerulonephritis), Factor D deficiency (e.g., neisserial infections), Properdin deficiency (e.g., neisserial infections), MBP deficiency (e.g., pyogenic infections), and MASP2 deficiency.
  • Primary immune deficiencies can be diagnosed according to routine techniques in the art. Exemplary diagnostic tests include, without limitation, performing counts of the different types of mononuclear cells in the blood (e.g., lymphocytes and monocytes, including lymphocytes, different groups of B lymphocytes such as CD19+, CD20+, and CD21+ lymphocytes, natural killer cells, and monocytes positive for CD15+), measuring the presence of activation markers (e.g., HLA-DR, CD25, CD80), performing tests for T cell function such as skin tests for delayed-type hypersensitivity, cell responses to mitogens and allogeneic cells, cytokine production by cells, performing tests for B cell function such as by identifying antibodies to routine immunizations and commonly acquired infections and by quantifying IgG subclasses, and performing tests or phagocyte function, such as by measuring the reduction of nitro blue tetrazolium chloride, and performing assays of chemotaxis and bactericidal activity. NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may therefore be used to stimulate or maintain acute inflammation or acute inflammatory responses in subjects with a primary immunodeficiency, as described herein and known in the art.
  • Examples of causes of secondary immunodeficiencies include malnutrition, aging, and medications (e.g., chemotherapy, disease-modifying anti-rheumatic drugs, immunosuppressive drugs after organ transplants, glucocorticoids). Additional causes include various cancers, including cancers of the bone marrow and blood cells (e.g., leukemia, lymphoma, multiple myeloma), and certain chronic infections, such as acquired immunodeficiency syndrome (AIDS), caused by the human immunodeficiency virus (HIV). NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may be used to stimulate or maintain acute inflammation or acute inflammatory responses in subjects with an immunodeficiency, as described herein and known in the art. NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents may also be used to stimulate or maintain chronic inflammation or chronic inflammatory responses in subjects with a secondary immunodeficiency, as described herein and known in the art.
  • As noted above, certain embodiments include methods of treating metabolic diseases, whether due to activity or insufficient activity of a given NHR, such as GR. Examples of conditions associated with excessive (e.g., chronic, acute) GR or glucocorticoid activation include diabetes (e.g., insulin resistance), hypertension, osteoporosis, reduced cognitive function, and glaucoma. Examples of conditions associated with GR or glucocorticoid deficiencies include Addison's disease, familial glucocorticoid deficiency, chronic glucocorticoid deficiency, acute glucocorticoid defiency, and their associated symptoms, such as hypoglycemia, hyperpigmentation, muscle weakness, seizures, and failure to thrive. Additional examples of metabolic diseases include adrenoleukodystrophy, Krabbe's disease (globoid cell leukodystrophy), metachromatic leukodystrophy, Alexander's disease, Canavan's disease (spongiform leukodystrophy), Pelizaeus-Merzbacher disease, Cockayne's syndrome, Hurler's disease, Lowe's syndrome, Leigh's disease, Wilson's disease, Hallervorden-Spatz disease, Tay-Sachs disease, etc. The utility of the NHR-targeted antisense and RNAi agents of the invention in modulating metabolic processes may be monitored using any of a variety of techniques known and available in the art including, for example, assays which measure adipocyte lipogenesis or adipocyte lipolysis.
  • Certain embodiments include modulation of NHRs such as GR for the treatment of auto-immune conditions. Examples of auto-immune conditions include but are not limited to, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, autoimmune neonatal thrombocytopenia, idiopathic thrombocytopenia purpura, autoimmunocytopenia, hemolytic anemia, antiphospholipid syndrome, dermatitis, allergic encephalomyelitis, myocarditis, relapsing polychondritis, rheumatic heart disease, glomerulonephritis (for example, IgA nephropathy), multiple sclerosis, neuritis, uveitis ophthalmia, polyendocrinopathies, purpura (for example, Henloch-Scoenlein purpura), Reiter's disease, stiff-man syndrome, autoimmune pulmonary inflammation, Guillain-Barre Syndrome, insulin dependent diabetes mellitus, and autoimmune inflammatory eye disease.
  • Additional autoimmune diseases, disorders or conditions include, but are not limited to, autoimmune thyroiditis; hypothyroidism, including Hashimoto's thyroiditis and thyroiditis characterized, for example, by cell-mediated and humoral thyroid cytotoxicity; SLE (which is often characterized, for example, by circulating and locally generated immune complexes); Goodpasture's syndrome (which is often characterized, for example, by anti-basement membrane antibodies); pemphigus (which is often characterized, for example, by epidermal acantholytic antibodies); receptor autoimmunities such as, for example, Graves' disease (which is often characterized, for example, by antibodies to a thyroid stimulating hormone receptor; myasthenia gravis, which is often characterized, for example, by acetylcholine receptor antibodies); insulin resistance (which is often characterized, for example, by insulin receptor antibodies); autoimmune hemolytic anemia (which is often characterized, for example, by phagocytosis of antibody-sensitized red blood cells); and autoimmune thrombocytopenic purpura (which is often characterized, for example, by phagocytosis of antibody-sensitized platelets).
  • Additional examples of conditions that can be treated by the antisense or RNAi agents provided herein include non-alcoholic steatohepatitis (e.g., targeting TR), diabetes (e.g., targeting PPAR), conditions associated with calcium reabsorption and mobilization (e.g., targeting VDR), cancer (e.g., targeting ER and/or ERR), birth control/pregnancy related issues (e.g., targeting PR), and conditions associated with hormone regulation such as low testosterone (e.g., targeting AR), among others.
  • An effective in vivo treatment regimen using the antisense oligonucleotides or RNAi agents of the invention may vary according to the duration, dose, frequency and route of administration, as well as the condition of the subject under treatment (i.e., prophylactic administration versus administration in response to an existing condition). Accordingly, such in vivo therapy will often require monitoring by tests appropriate to the particular type of viral infection under treatment, and corresponding adjustments in the dose or treatment regimen, in order to achieve an optimal therapeutic outcome. In certain embodiments, treatment may be monitored, e.g., by general indicators of inflammation.
  • Pharmaceutical Formulations
  • In certain embodiments, the present invention provides formulations or compositions suitable for the therapeutic delivery of antisense oligomers or other agents such as RNAi agents, as described herein. Hence, in certain embodiments, the present invention provides pharmaceutically acceptable compositions that comprise a therapeutically-effective amount of one or more of the oligomers or agents described herein, formulated together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers (additives) and/or diluents. While it is possible for an oligomer of the present invention to be administered alone, it is preferable to administer the compound as a pharmaceutical formulation (composition).
  • Methods for the delivery of nucleic acid molecules are described, for example, in Akhtar et al., 1992, Trends Cell Bio., 2:139; and Delivery Strategies for Antisense Oligonucleotide Therapeutics, ed. Akhtar; Sullivan et al., PCT WO 94/02595. These and other protocols can be utilized for the delivery of virtually any nucleic acid molecule, including the isolated oligomers of the present invention.
  • As detailed below, the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention may be specially formulated for administration in solid or liquid form, including those adapted for the following: (1) oral administration, for example, drenches (aqueous or non-aqueous solutions or suspensions), tablets, e.g., those targeted for buccal, sublingual, and systemic absorption, boluses, powders, granules, pastes for application to the tongue; (2) parenteral administration, for example, by subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or epidural injection as, for example, a sterile solution or suspension, or sustained-release formulation; (3) topical application, for example, as a cream, ointment, or a controlled-release patch or spray applied to the skin; (4) intravaginally or intrarectally, for example, as a pessary, cream or foam; (5) sublingually; (6) ocularly; (7) transdermally; or (8) nasally.
  • The phrase “pharmaceutically acceptable” is employed herein to refer to those compounds, materials, compositions, and/or dosage forms which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of human beings and animals without excessive toxicity, irritation, allergic response, or other problem or complication, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
  • The phrase “pharmaceutically acceptable carrier” as used herein means a pharmaceutically-acceptable material, composition or vehicle, such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, manufacturing aid (e.g., lubricant, talc magnesium, calcium or zinc stearate, or steric acid), or solvent encapsulating material, involved in carrying or transporting the subject compound from one organ, or portion of the body, to another organ, or portion of the body. Each carrier must be “acceptable” in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not injurious to the patient.
  • Some examples of materials that can serve as pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers include, without limitation: (1) sugars, such as lactose, glucose and sucrose; (2) starches, such as corn starch and potato starch; (3) cellulose, and its derivatives, such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; (4) powdered tragacanth; (5) malt; (6) gelatin; (7) talc; (8) excipients, such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; (9) oils, such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; (10) glycols, such as propylene glycol; (11) polyols, such as glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; (12) esters, such as ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; (13) agar; (14) buffering agents, such as magnesium hydroxide and aluminum hydroxide; (15) alginic acid; (16) pyrogen-free water; (17) isotonic saline; (18) Ringer's solution; (19) ethyl alcohol; (20) pH buffered solutions; (21) polyesters, polycarbonates and/or polyanhydrides; and (22) other non-toxic compatible substances employed in pharmaceutical formulations.
  • Additional non-limiting examples of agents suitable for formulation with the antisense oligomers of the instant invention include: PEG conjugated nucleic acids, phospholipid conjugated nucleic acids, nucleic acids containing lipophilic moieties, phosphorothioates, P-glycoprotein inhibitors (such as Pluronic P85) which can enhance entry of drugs into various tissues; biodegradable polymers, such as poly (DL-lactide-coglycolide) microspheres for sustained release delivery after implantation (Emerich, D F et al., 1999, Cell Transplant, 8, 47-58) Alkermes, Inc. Cambridge, Mass.; and loaded nanoparticles, such as those made of polybutylcyanoacrylate, which can deliver drugs across the blood brain barrier and can alter neuronal uptake mechanisms (Prog Neuropsychopharmacol Biol Psychiatry, 23, 941-949, 1999).
  • The invention also features the use of the composition comprising surface-modified liposomes containing poly (ethylene glycol) lipids (PEG-modified, branched and unbranched or combinations thereof, or long-circulating liposomes or stealth liposomes). Oligomers of the invention can also comprise covalently attached PEG molecules of various molecular weights. These formulations offer a method for increasing the accumulation of drugs in target tissues. This class of drug carriers resists opsonization and elimination by the mononuclear phagocytic system (MPS or RES), thereby enabling longer blood circulation times and enhanced tissue exposure for the encapsulated drug (Lasic et al. Chem. Rev. 1995, 95, 2601-2627; Ishiwata et al., Chem. Pharm. Bull. 1995, 43, 1005-1011). Such liposomes have been shown to accumulate selectively in tumors, presumably by extravasation and capture in the neovascularized target tissues (Lasic et al., Science 1995, 267, 1275-1276; Oku et al., 1995, Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 1238, 86-90). The long-circulating liposomes enhance the pharmacokinetics and pharmacodynamics of DNA and RNA, particularly compared to conventional cationic liposomes which are known to accumulate in tissues of the MPS (Liu et al., J. Biol. Chem. 1995, 42, 24864-24870; Choi et al., International PCT Publication No. WO 96/10391; Ansell et al., International PCT Publication No. WO 96/10390; Holland et al., International PCT Publication No. WO 96/10392). Long-circulating liposomes are also likely to protect drugs from nuclease degradation to a greater extent compared to cationic liposomes, based on their ability to avoid accumulation in metabolically aggressive MPS tissues such as the liver and spleen.
  • In a further embodiment, the present invention includes oligomer compositions prepared for delivery as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,692,911, 7,163,695 and 7,070,807. In this regard, in one embodiment, the present invention provides an oligomer of the present invention in a composition comprising copolymers of lysine and histidine (HK) as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 7,163,695, 7,070,807, and 6,692,911 either alone or in combination with PEG (e.g., branched or unbranched PEG or a mixture of both), in combination with PEG and a targeting moiety or any of the foregoing in combination with a crosslinking agent. In certain embodiments, the present invention provides antisense oligomers in compositions comprising gluconic-acid-modified polyhistidine or gluconylated-polyhistidine/transferrin-polylysine. One skilled in the art will also recognize that amino acids with properties similar to His and Lys may be substituted within the composition.
  • Certain embodiments of the oligomers described herein may contain a basic functional group, such as amino or alkylamino, and are, thus, capable of forming pharmaceutically-acceptable salts with pharmaceutically-acceptable acids. The term “pharmaceutically-acceptable salts” in this respect, refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic acid addition salts of compounds of the present invention. These salts can be prepared in situ in the administration vehicle or the dosage form manufacturing process, or by separately reacting a purified compound of the invention in its free base form with a suitable organic or inorganic acid, and isolating the salt thus formed during subsequent purification. Representative salts include the hydrobromide, hydrochloride, sulfate, bisulfate, phosphate, nitrate, acetate, valerate, oleate, palmitate, stearate, laurate, benzoate, lactate, phosphate, tosylate, citrate, maleate, fumarate, succinate, tartrate, napthylate, mesylate, glucoheptonate, lactobionate, and laurylsulphonate salts and the like. (See, e.g., Berge et al. (1977) “Pharmaceutical Salts”, J. Pharm. Sci. 66:1-19).
  • The pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the subject oligomers include the conventional nontoxic salts or quaternary ammonium salts of the compounds, e.g., from non-toxic organic or inorganic acids. For example, such conventional nontoxic salts include those derived from inorganic acids such as hydrochloride, hydrobromic, sulfuric, sulfamic, phosphoric, nitric, and the like; and the salts prepared from organic acids such as acetic, propionic, succinic, glycolic, stearic, lactic, malic, tartaric, citric, ascorbic, palmitic, maleic, hydroxymaleic, phenylacetic, glutamic, benzoic, salicyclic, sulfanilic, 2-acetoxybenzoic, fumaric, toluenesulfonic, methanesulfonic, ethane disulfonic, oxalic, isothionic, and the like.
  • In certain embodiments, the oligomers of the present invention may contain one or more acidic functional groups and, thus, are capable of forming pharmaceutically acceptable salts with pharmaceutically acceptable bases. The term “pharmaceutically acceptable salts” in these instances refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic base addition salts of compounds of the present invention. These salts can likewise be prepared in situ in the administration vehicle or the dosage form manufacturing process, or by separately reacting the purified compound in its free acid form with a suitable base, such as the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically-acceptable metal cation, with ammonia, or with a pharmaceutically-acceptable organic primary, secondary or tertiary amine. Representative alkali or alkaline earth salts include the lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and aluminum salts and the like. Representative organic amines useful for the formation of base addition salts include ethylamine, diethylamine, ethylenediamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, piperazine and the like. (See, e.g., Berge et al., supra).
  • Wetting agents, emulsifiers and lubricants, such as sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium stearate, as well as coloring agents, release agents, coating agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present in the compositions.
  • Examples of pharmaceutically-acceptable antioxidants include: (1) water soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbic acid, cysteine hydrochloride, sodium bisulfate, sodium metabisulfite, sodium sulfite and the like; (2) oil-soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT), lecithin, propyl gallate, alpha-tocopherol, and the like; and (3) metal chelating agents, such as citric acid, ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA), sorbitol, tartaric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like.
  • Formulations of the present invention include those suitable for oral, nasal, topical (including buccal and sublingual), rectal, vaginal and/or parenteral administration. The formulations may conveniently be presented in unit dosage form and may be prepared by any methods well known in the art of pharmacy. The amount of active ingredient that can be combined with a carrier material to produce a single dosage form will vary depending upon the host being treated, the particular mode of administration. The amount of active ingredient which can be combined with a carrier material to produce a single dosage form will generally be that amount of the compound which produces a therapeutic effect. Generally, out of one hundred percent, this amount will range from about 0.1 percent to about ninety-nine percent of active ingredient, preferably from about 5 percent to about 70 percent, most preferably from about 10 percent to about 30 percent.
  • In certain embodiments, a formulation of the present invention comprises an excipient selected from cyclodextrins, celluloses, liposomes, micelle forming agents, e.g., bile acids, and polymeric carriers, e.g., polyesters and polyanhydrides; and an oligomer of the present invention. In certain embodiments, an aforementioned formulation renders orally bioavailable an oligomer of the present invention.
  • Methods of preparing these formulations or compositions include the step of bringing into association an oligomer of the present invention with the carrier and, optionally, one or more accessory ingredients. In general, the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association a compound of the present invention with liquid carriers, or finely divided solid carriers, or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product.
  • Formulations of the invention suitable for oral administration may be in the form of capsules, cachets, pills, tablets, lozenges (using a flavored basis, usually sucrose and acacia or tragacanth), powders, granules, or as a solution or a suspension in an aqueous or non-aqueous liquid, or as an oil-in-water or water-in-oil liquid emulsion, or as an elixir or syrup, or as pastilles (using an inert base, such as gelatin and glycerin, or sucrose and acacia) and/or as mouth washes and the like, each containing a predetermined amount of a compound of the present invention as an active ingredient. An oligomer of the present invention may also be administered as a bolus, electuary or paste.
  • In solid dosage forms of the invention for oral administration (capsules, tablets, pills, dragees, powders, granules, trouches and the like), the active ingredient may be mixed with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers, such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate, and/or any of the following: (1) fillers or extenders, such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol, and/or silicic acid; (2) binders, such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, sucrose and/or acacia; (3) humectants, such as glycerol; (4) disintegrating agents, such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates, and sodium carbonate; (5) solution retarding agents, such as paraffin; (6) absorption accelerators, such as quaternary ammonium compounds and surfactants, such as poloxamer and sodium lauryl sulfate; (7) wetting agents, such as, for example, cetyl alcohol, glycerol monostearate, and non-ionic surfactants; (8) absorbents, such as kaolin and bentonite clay; (9) lubricants, such as talc, calcium stearate, magnesium stearate, solid polyethylene glycols, sodium lauryl sulfate, zinc stearate, sodium stearate, stearic acid, and mixtures thereof; (10) coloring agents; and (11) controlled release agents such as crospovidone or ethyl cellulose. In the case of capsules, tablets and pills, the pharmaceutical compositions may also comprise buffering agents. Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-shelled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugars, as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols and the like.
  • A tablet may be made by compression or molding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients. Compressed tablets may be prepared using binder (e.g., gelatin or hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose), lubricant, inert diluent, preservative, disintegrant (for example, sodium starch glycolate or cross-linked sodium carboxymethyl cellulose), surface-active or dispersing agent. Molded tablets may be made by molding in a suitable machine a mixture of the powdered compound moistened with an inert liquid diluent.
  • The tablets, and other solid dosage forms of the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention, such as dragees, capsules, pills and granules, may optionally be scored or prepared with coatings and shells, such as enteric coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical-formulating art. They may also be formulated so as to provide slow or controlled release of the active ingredient therein using, for example, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose in varying proportions to provide the desired release profile, other polymer matrices, liposomes and/or microspheres. They may be formulated for rapid release, e.g., freeze-dried. They may be sterilized by, for example, filtration through a bacteria-retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved in sterile water, or some other sterile injectable medium immediately before use. These compositions may also optionally contain opacifying agents and may be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain portion of the gastrointestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner. Examples of embedding compositions which can be used include polymeric substances and waxes. The active ingredient can also be in micro-encapsulated form, if appropriate, with one or more of the above-described excipients.
  • Liquid dosage forms for oral administration of the compounds of the invention include pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, microemulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs. In addition to the active ingredient, the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as, for example, water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers, such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof.
  • Besides inert diluents, the oral compositions can also include adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring, coloring, perfuming and preservative agents.
  • Suspensions, in addition to the active compounds, may contain suspending agents as, for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol and sorbitan esters, microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar-agar and tragacanth, and mixtures thereof.
  • Formulations for rectal or vaginal administration may be presented as a suppository, which may be prepared by mixing one or more compounds of the invention with one or more suitable nonirritating excipients or carriers comprising, for example, cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol, a suppository wax or a salicylate, and which is solid at room temperature, but liquid at body temperature and, therefore, will melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
  • Formulations or dosage forms for the topical or transdermal administration of an oligomer as provided herein include powders, sprays, ointments, pastes, creams, lotions, gels, solutions, patches and inhalants. The active oligomers may be mixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically-acceptable carrier, and with any preservatives, buffers, or propellants which may be required. The ointments, pastes, creams and gels may contain, in addition to an active compound of this invention, excipients, such as animal and vegetable fats, oils, waxes, paraffins, starch, tragacanth, cellulose derivatives, polyethylene glycols, silicones, bentonites, silicic acid, talc and zinc oxide, or mixtures thereof.
  • Powders and sprays can contain, in addition to an oligomer of the present invention, excipients such as lactose, talc, silicic acid, aluminum hydroxide, calcium silicates and polyamide powder, or mixtures of these substances. Sprays can additionally contain customary propellants, such as chlorofluorohydrocarbons and volatile unsubstituted hydrocarbons, such as butane and propane.
  • Transdermal patches have the added advantage of providing controlled delivery of an oligomer of the present invention to the body. Such dosage forms can be made by dissolving or dispersing the oligomer in the proper medium. Absorption enhancers can also be used to increase the flux of the agent across the skin. The rate of such flux can be controlled by either providing a rate controlling membrane or dispersing the agent in a polymer matrix or gel, among other methods known in the art.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions suitable for parenteral administration may comprise one or more oligomers of the invention in combination with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable sterile isotonic aqueous or nonaqueous solutions, dispersions, suspensions or emulsions, or sterile powders which may be reconstituted into sterile injectable solutions or dispersions just prior to use, which may contain sugars, alcohols, antioxidants, buffers, bacteriostats, solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient or suspending or thickening agents. Examples of suitable aqueous and nonaqueous carriers which may be employed in the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof, vegetable oils, such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters, such as ethyl oleate. Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions, and by the use of surfactants.
  • These compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents. Prevention of the action of microorganisms upon the subject oligomers may be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid, and the like. It may also be desirable to include isotonic agents, such as sugars, sodium chloride, and the like into the compositions. In addition, prolonged absorption of the injectable pharmaceutical form may be brought about by the inclusion of agents which delay absorption such as aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
  • In some cases, in order to prolong the effect of a drug, it is desirable to slow the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material having poor water solubility, among other methods known in the art. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon its rate of dissolution which, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally-administered drug form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
  • Injectable depot forms may be made by forming microencapsule matrices of the subject oligomers in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending on the ratio of oligomer to polymer, and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of oligomer release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations may also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions that are compatible with body tissues.
  • When the oligomers of the present invention are administered as pharmaceuticals, to humans and animals, they can be given per se or as a pharmaceutical composition containing, for example, 0.1 to 99% (more preferably, 10 to 30%) of active ingredient in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • As noted above, the formulations or preparations of the present invention may be given orally, parenterally, topically, or rectally. They are typically given in forms suitable for each administration route. For example, they are administered in tablets or capsule form, by injection, inhalation, eye lotion, ointment, suppository, etc. administration by injection, infusion or inhalation; topical by lotion or ointment; and rectal by suppositories.
  • The phrases “parenteral administration” and “administered parenterally” as used herein means modes of administration other than enteral and topical administration, usually by injection, and includes, without limitation, intravenous, intramuscular, intraarterial, intrathecal, intracapsular, intraorbital, intracardiac, intradermal, intraperitoneal, transtracheal, subcutaneous, subcuticular, intraarticulare, subcapsular, subarachnoid, intraspinal and intrasternal injection and infusion.
  • The phrases “systemic administration,” “administered systemically,” “peripheral administration” and “administered peripherally” as used herein mean the administration of a compound, drug or other material other than directly into the central nervous system, such that it enters the patient's system and, thus, is subject to metabolism and other like processes, for example, subcutaneous administration.
  • Regardless of the route of administration selected, the oligomers of the present invention, which may be used in a suitable hydrated form, and/or the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention, may be formulated into pharmaceutically-acceptable dosage forms by conventional methods known to those of skill in the art. Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions of this invention may be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active ingredient which is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular patient, composition, and mode of administration, without being unacceptably toxic to the patient.
  • The selected dosage level will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the particular oligomer of the present invention employed, or the ester, salt or amide thereof, the route of administration, the time of administration, the rate of excretion or metabolism of the particular oligomer being employed, the rate and extent of absorption, the duration of the treatment, other drugs, compounds and/or materials used in combination with the particular oligomer employed, the age, sex, weight, condition, general health and prior medical history of the patient being treated, and like factors well known in the medical arts.
  • A physician or veterinarian having ordinary skill in the art can readily determine and prescribe the effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition required. For example, the physician or veterinarian could start doses of the compounds of the invention employed in the pharmaceutical composition at levels lower than that required in order to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and gradually increase the dosage until the desired effect is achieved. In general, a suitable daily dose of a compound of the invention will be that amount of the compound which is the lowest dose effective to produce a therapeutic effect. Such an effective dose will generally depend upon the factors described above. Generally, oral, intravenous, intracerebroventricular and subcutaneous doses of the compounds of this invention for a patient, when used for the indicated effects, will range from about 0.0001 to about 100 mg per kilogram of body weight per day.
  • If desired, the effective daily dose of the active compound may be administered as two, three, four, five, six or more sub-doses administered separately at appropriate intervals throughout the day, optionally, in unit dosage forms. In certain situations, dosing is one administration per day. In certain embodiments, dosing is one or more administration per every 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 days, or every 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12 weeks, or every 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12 months, as needed, to treat the desired condition.
  • Nucleic acid molecules can be administered to cells by a variety of methods known to those familiar to the art, including, but not restricted to, encapsulation in liposomes, by iontophoresis, or by incorporation into other vehicles, such as hydrogels, cyclodextrins, biodegradable nanocapsules, and bioadhesive microspheres, as described herein and known in the art. In certain embodiments, microemulsification technology may be utilized to improve bioavailability of lipophilic (water insoluble) pharmaceutical agents. Examples include Trimetrine (Dordunoo, S. K., et al., Drug Development and Industrial Pharmacy, 17(12), 1685-1713, 1991 and REV 5901 (Sheen, P. C., et al., J Pharm Sci 80(7), 712-714, 1991). Among other benefits, microemulsification provides enhanced bioavailability by preferentially directing absorption to the lymphatic system instead of the circulatory system, which thereby bypasses the liver, and prevents destruction of the compounds in the hepatobiliary circulation.
  • In one aspect of invention, the formulations contain micelles formed from an oligomer as provided herein and at least one amphiphilic carrier, in which the micelles have an average diameter of less than about 100 nm. More preferred embodiments provide micelles having an average diameter less than about 50 nm, and even more preferred embodiments provide micelles having an average diameter less than about 30 nm, or even less than about 20 nm.
  • While all suitable amphiphilic carriers are contemplated, the presently preferred carriers are generally those that have Generally-Recognized-as-Safe (GRAS) status, and that can both solubilize the compound of the present invention and microemulsify it at a later stage when the solution comes into a contact with a complex water phase (such as one found in human gastro-intestinal tract). Usually, amphiphilic ingredients that satisfy these requirements have HLB (hydrophilic to lipophilic balance) values of 2-20, and their structures contain straight chain aliphatic radicals in the range of C-6 to C-20. Examples are polyethylene-glycolized fatty glycerides and polyethylene glycols.
  • Examples of amphiphilic carriers include saturated and monounsaturated polyethyleneglycolyzed fatty acid glycerides, such as those obtained from fully or partially hydrogenated various vegetable oils. Such oils may advantageously consist of tri-, di-, and mono-fatty acid glycerides and di- and mono-polyethyleneglycol esters of the corresponding fatty acids, with a particularly preferred fatty acid composition including capric acid 4-10, capric acid 3-9, lauric acid 40-50, myristic acid 14-24, palmitic acid 4-14 and stearic acid 5-15%. Another useful class of amphiphilic carriers includes partially esterified sorbitan and/or sorbitol, with saturated or mono-unsaturated fatty acids (SPAN-series) or corresponding ethoxylated analogs (TWEEN-series).
  • Commercially available amphiphilic carriers may be particularly useful, including Gelucire-series, Labrafil, Labrasol, or Lauroglycol (all manufactured and distributed by Gattefosse Corporation, Saint Priest, France), PEG-mono-oleate, PEG-di-oleate, PEG-mono-laurate and di-laurate, Lecithin, Polysorbate 80, etc (produced and distributed by a number of companies in USA and worldwide).
  • In certain embodiments, the delivery may occur by use of liposomes, nanocapsules, microparticles, microspheres, lipid particles, vesicles, and the like, for the introduction of the compositions of the present invention into suitable host cells. In particular, the compositions of the present invention may be formulated for delivery either encapsulated in a lipid particle, a liposome, a vesicle, a nanosphere, a nanoparticle or the like. The formulation and use of such delivery vehicles can be carried out using known and conventional techniques.
  • Hydrophilic polymers suitable for use in the present invention are those which are readily water-soluble, can be covalently attached to a vesicle-forming lipid, and which are tolerated in vivo without toxic effects (i.e., are biocompatible). Suitable polymers include polyethylene glycol (PEG), polylactic (also termed polylactide), polyglycolic acid (also termed polyglycolide), a polylactic-polyglycolic acid copolymer, and polyvinyl alcohol. In certain embodiments, polymers have a molecular weight of from about 100 or 120 daltons up to about 5,000 or 10,000 daltons, or from about 300 daltons to about 5,000 daltons. In other embodiments, the polymer is polyethyleneglycol having a molecular weight of from about 100 to about 5,000 daltons, or having a molecular weight of from about 300 to about 5,000 daltons. In certain embodiments, the polymer is polyethyleneglycol of 750 daltons (PEG(750)). Polymers may also be defined by the number of monomers therein; a preferred embodiment of the present invention utilizes polymers of at least about three monomers, such PEG polymers consisting of three monomers (approximately 150 daltons).
  • Other hydrophilic polymers which may be suitable for use in the present invention include polyvinylpyrrolidone, polymethoxazoline, polyethyloxazoline, polyhydroxypropyl methacrylamide, polymethacrylamide, polydimethylacrylamide, and derivatized celluloses such as hydroxymethylcellulose or hydroxyethylcellulose.
  • In certain embodiments, a formulation of the present invention comprises a biocompatible polymer selected from the group consisting of polyamides, polycarbonates, polyalkylenes, polymers of acrylic and methacrylic esters, polyvinyl polymers, polyglycolides, polysiloxanes, polyurethanes and co-polymers thereof, celluloses, polypropylene, polyethylenes, polystyrene, polymers of lactic acid and glycolic acid, polyanhydrides, poly(ortho)esters, poly(butic acid), poly(valeric acid), poly(lactide-co-caprolactone), polysaccharides, proteins, polyhyaluronic acids, polycyanoacrylates, and blends, mixtures, or copolymers thereof.
  • Cyclodextrins are cyclic oligosaccharides, consisting of 6, 7 or 8 glucose units, designated by the Greek letter α, β. or γ, respectively. The glucose units are linked by α-1,4-glucosidic bonds. As a consequence of the chair conformation of the sugar units, all secondary hydroxyl groups (at C-2, C-3) are located on one side of the ring, while all the primary hydroxyl groups at C-6 are situated on the other side. As a result, the external faces are hydrophilic, making the cyclodextrins water-soluble. In contrast, the cavities of the cyclodextrins are hydrophobic, since they are lined by the hydrogen of atoms C-3 and C-5, and by ether-like oxygens. These matrices allow complexation with a variety of relatively hydrophobic compounds, including, for instance, steroid compounds such as 17α-estradiol (see, e.g., van Uden et al. Plant Cell Tiss. Org. Cult. 38:1-3-113 (1994)). The complexation takes place by Van der Waals interactions and by hydrogen bond formation. For a general review of the chemistry of cyclodextrins, see, Wenz, Agnew. Chem. Int. Ed. Engl., 33:803-822 (1994).
  • The physico-chemical properties of the cyclodextrin derivatives depend strongly on the kind and the degree of substitution. For example, their solubility in water ranges from insoluble (e.g., triacetyl-beta-cyclodextrin) to 147% soluble (w/v) (G-2-beta-cyclodextrin). In addition, they are soluble in many organic solvents. The properties of the cyclodextrins enable the control over solubility of various formulation components by increasing or decreasing their solubility.
  • Numerous cyclodextrins and methods for their preparation have been described. For example, Parmeter (I), et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 3,453,259) and Gramera, et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 3,459,731) described electroneutral cyclodextrins. Other derivatives include cyclodextrins with cationic properties [Parmeter (II), U.S. Pat. No. 3,453,257], insoluble crosslinked cyclodextrins (Solms, U.S. Pat. No. 3,420,788), and cyclodextrins with anionic properties [Parmeter (III), U.S. Pat. No. 3,426,011]. Among the cyclodextrin derivatives with anionic properties, carboxylic acids, phosphorous acids, phosphinous acids, phosphonic acids, phosphoric acids, thiophosphonic acids, thiosulphinic acids, and sulfonic acids have been appended to the parent cyclodextrin [see, Parmeter (III), supra]. Furthermore, sulfoalkyl ether cyclodextrin derivatives have been described by Stella, et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 5,134,127).
  • Liposomes consist of at least one lipid bilayer membrane enclosing an aqueous internal compartment. Liposomes may be characterized by membrane type and by size. Small unilamellar vesicles (SUVs) have a single membrane and typically range between 0.02 and 0.05 μm in diameter; large unilamellar vesicles (LUVS) are typically larger than 0.05 μm. Oligolamellar large vesicles and multilamellar vesicles have multiple, usually concentric, membrane layers and are typically larger than 0.1 μm. Liposomes with several nonconcentric membranes, i.e., several smaller vesicles contained within a larger vesicle, are termed multivesicular vesicles.
  • One aspect of the present invention relates to formulations comprising liposomes containing an oligomer of the present invention, where the liposome membrane is formulated to provide a liposome with increased carrying capacity. Alternatively or in addition, the compound of the present invention may be contained within, or adsorbed onto, the liposome bilayer of the liposome. An oligomer of the present invention may be aggregated with a lipid surfactant and carried within the liposome's internal space; in these cases, the liposome membrane is formulated to resist the disruptive effects of the active agent-surfactant aggregate.
  • According to one embodiment of the present invention, the lipid bilayer of a liposome contains lipids derivatized with polyethylene glycol (PEG), such that the PEG chains extend from the inner surface of the lipid bilayer into the interior space encapsulated by the liposome, and extend from the exterior of the lipid bilayer into the surrounding environment.
  • Active agents contained within liposomes of the present invention are in solubilized form. Aggregates of surfactant and active agent (such as emulsions or micelles containing the active agent of interest) may be entrapped within the interior space of liposomes according to the present invention. A surfactant acts to disperse and solubilize the active agent, and may be selected from any suitable aliphatic, cycloaliphatic or aromatic surfactant, including but not limited to biocompatible lysophosphatidylcholines (LPCs) of varying chain lengths (for example, from about C14 to about C20). Polymer-derivatized lipids such as PEG-lipids may also be utilized for micelle formation as they will act to inhibit micelle/membrane fusion, and as the addition of a polymer to surfactant molecules decreases the CMC of the surfactant and aids in micelle formation. Preferred are surfactants with CMCs in the micromolar range; higher CMC surfactants may be utilized to prepare micelles entrapped within liposomes of the present invention.
  • Liposomes according to the present invention may be prepared by any of a variety of techniques that are known in the art. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,235,871; Published PCT applications WO 96/14057; New RRC, Liposomes: A practical approach, IRL Press, Oxford (1990), pages 33-104; Lasic D D, Liposomes from physics to applications, Elsevier Science Publishers BV, Amsterdam, 1993. For example, liposomes of the present invention may be prepared by diffusing a lipid derivatized with a hydrophilic polymer into preformed liposomes, such as by exposing preformed liposomes to micelles composed of lipid-grafted polymers, at lipid concentrations corresponding to the final mole percent of derivatized lipid which is desired in the liposome. Liposomes containing a hydrophilic polymer can also be formed by homogenization, lipid-field hydration, or extrusion techniques, as are known in the art.
  • In another exemplary formulation procedure, the active agent is first dispersed by sonication in a lysophosphatidylcholine or other low CMC surfactant (including polymer grafted lipids) that readily solubilizes hydrophobic molecules. The resulting micellar suspension of active agent is then used to rehydrate a dried lipid sample that contains a suitable mole percent of polymer-grafted lipid, or cholesterol. The lipid and active agent suspension is then formed into liposomes using extrusion techniques as are known in the art, and the resulting liposomes separated from the unencapsulated solution by standard column separation.
  • In one aspect of the present invention, the liposomes are prepared to have substantially homogeneous sizes in a selected size range. One effective sizing method involves extruding an aqueous suspension of the liposomes through a series of polycarbonate membranes having a selected uniform pore size; the pore size of the membrane will correspond roughly with the largest sizes of liposomes produced by extrusion through that membrane. See e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,737,323 (Apr. 12, 1988). In certain embodiments, reagents such as DharmaFECT® and Lipofectamine® may be utilized to introduce polynucleotides or proteins into cells.
  • The release characteristics of a formulation of the present invention depend on the encapsulating material, the concentration of encapsulated drug, and the presence of release modifiers. For example, release can be manipulated to be pH dependent, for example, using a pH sensitive coating that releases only at a low pH, as in the stomach, or a higher pH, as in the intestine. An enteric coating can be used to prevent release from occurring until after passage through the stomach. Multiple coatings or mixtures of cyanamide encapsulated in different materials can be used to obtain an initial release in the stomach, followed by later release in the intestine. Release can also be manipulated by inclusion of salts or pore forming agents, which can increase water uptake or release of drug by diffusion from the capsule. Excipients which modify the solubility of the drug can also be used to control the release rate. Agents which enhance degradation of the matrix or release from the matrix can also be incorporated. They can be added to the drug, added as a separate phase (i.e., as particulates), or can be co-dissolved in the polymer phase depending on the compound. In most cases the amount should be between 0.1 and thirty percent (w/w polymer). Types of degradation enhancers include inorganic salts such as ammonium sulfate and ammonium chloride, organic acids such as citric acid, benzoic acid, and ascorbic acid, inorganic bases such as sodium carbonate, potassium carbonate, calcium carbonate, zinc carbonate, and zinc hydroxide, and organic bases such as protamine sulfate, spermine, choline, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, and triethanolamine and surfactants such as Tween® and Pluronic®. Pore forming agents which add microstructure to the matrices (i.e., water soluble compounds such as inorganic salts and sugars) are added as particulates. The range is typically between one and thirty percent (w/w polymer).
  • Uptake can also be manipulated by altering residence time of the particles in the gut. This can be achieved, for example, by coating the particle with, or selecting as the encapsulating material, a mucosal adhesive polymer. Examples include most polymers with free carboxyl groups, such as chitosan, celluloses, and especially polyacrylates (as used herein, polyacrylates refers to polymers including acrylate groups and modified acrylate groups such as cyanoacrylates and methacrylates).
  • An oligomer may be formulated to be contained within, or, adapted to release by a surgical or medical device or implant. In certain aspects, an implant may be coated or otherwise treated with an oligomer. For example, hydrogels, or other polymers, such as biocompatible and/or biodegradable polymers, may be used to coat an implant with the compositions of the present invention (i.e., the composition may be adapted for use with a medical device by using a hydrogel or other polymer). Polymers and copolymers for coating medical devices with an agent are well-known in the art. Examples of implants include, but are not limited to, stents, drug-eluting stents, sutures, prosthesis, vascular catheters, dialysis catheters, vascular grafts, prosthetic heart valves, cardiac pacemakers, implantable cardioverter defibrillators, IV needles, devices for bone setting and formation, such as pins, screws, plates, and other devices, and artificial tissue matrices for wound healing.
  • In addition to the methods provided herein, the oligomers for use according to the invention may be formulated for administration in any convenient way for use in human or veterinary medicine, by analogy with other pharmaceuticals. The antisense oligomers and their corresponding formulations may be administered alone or in combination with other therapeutic strategies in the treatment of inflammation.
  • In accordance with the invention, routes of antisense oligomer delivery include, but are not limited to, various systemic routes, including oral and parenteral routes, e.g., intravenous, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, and intramuscular, as well as inhalation, transdermal, pulmonary and topical delivery. The appropriate route may be determined by one of skill in the art, as appropriate to the condition of the subject under treatment. For example, an appropriate route for delivery of an antisense oligomer in the treatment of a condition of the skin may include topical delivery, while delivery of a antisense oligomer for the treatment of a respiratory condition (e.g., COPD) may include inhalation, intranasal or pulmonary delivery. The oligomer may also be delivered directly to the site of inflammation infection, or to the bloodstream.
  • The antisense oligomer may be administered in any convenient vehicle which is physiologically acceptable. Such a composition may include any of a variety of standard pharmaceutically acceptable carriers employed by those of ordinary skill in the art. Examples include, but are not limited to, saline, phosphate buffered saline (PBS), water, aqueous ethanol, emulsions, such as oil/water emulsions or triglyceride emulsions, tablets and capsules. The choice of suitable physiologically acceptable carrier will vary dependent upon the chosen mode of administration.
  • In some instances, as noted above, liposomes may be employed to facilitate uptake of the antisense oligonucleotide into cells. (See, e.g., Williams, S. A., Leukemia 10(12):1980-1989, 1996; Lappalainen et al., Antiviral Res. 23:119, 1994; Uhlmann et al., antisense oligonucleotides: a new therapeutic principle, Chemical Reviews, Volume 90, No. 4, pages 544-584, 1990; Gregoriadis, G., Chapter 14, Liposomes, Drug Carriers in Biology and Medicine, pp. 287-341, Academic Press, 1979). Hydrogels may also be used as vehicles for antisense oligomer administration, for example, as described in WO 93/01286 or PCT Application No US1992/005305. Alternatively, the oligonucleotides may be administered in microspheres or microparticles. (See, e.g., Wu, G. Y. and Wu, C. H., J. Biol. Chem. 262:4429-4432, 1987). Alternatively, the use of gas-filled microbubbles complexed with the antisense oligomers can enhance delivery to target tissues, as described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,245,747.
  • Sustained release compositions may also be used. These may include semipermeable polymeric matrices in the form of shaped articles such as films or microcapsules.
  • In one aspect of the method, the subject is a human subject, e.g., a patient diagnosed as having a localized or systemic inflammatory condition. The condition of a patient may also dictate prophylactic administration of an antisense oligomer of the invention, e.g., in the case of a patient who (1) is immunocompromised; (2) is a burn victim; (3) has an indwelling catheter; or (4) is about to undergo or has recently undergone surgery. In one preferred embodiment, the oligomer is a phosphorodiamidate morpholino oligomer, contained in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and is delivered orally. In another preferred embodiment, the oligomer is a phosphorodiamidate morpholino oligomer, contained in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and is delivered intravenously (i.v.).
  • In certain embodiments, the antisense compounds may be administered in an amount and manner effective to result in a peak blood concentration of at least 200-400 nM antisense oligomer. Typically, one or more doses of antisense oligomer are administered, generally at regular intervals, for a period of about one to two weeks. Preferred doses for oral administration are from about 1-100 mg oligomer per 70 kg. In some cases, doses of greater than 100 mg oligomer/patient may be necessary. For i.v. administration, preferred doses are from about 1 mg to 500 mg oligomer per 70 kg. The antisense oligomer may be administered at regular intervals for a short time period, e.g., daily for two weeks or less. However, in some cases the oligomer is administered intermittently over a longer period of time. Administration may be followed by, or concurrent with, administration of an antibiotic or other therapeutic treatment. The treatment regimen may be adjusted (dose, frequency, route, etc.) as indicated, based on the results of immunoassays, other biochemical tests and physiological examination of the subject under treatment.
  • All publications and patent applications cited in this specification are herein incorporated by reference as if each individual publication or patent application were specifically and individually indicated to be incorporated by reference.
  • Although the foregoing invention has been described in some detail by way of illustration and example for purposes of clarity of understanding, it will be readily apparent to one of ordinary skill in the art in light of the teachings of this invention that certain changes and modifications may be made thereto without departing from the spirit or scope of the appended claims. The following examples are provided by way of illustration only and not by way of limitation. Those of skill in the art will readily recognize a variety of noncritical parameters that could be changed or modified to yield essentially similar results.
  • EXAMPLES Materials and Methods
  • All peptides were custom synthesized by Global Peptide Services (Ft. Collins, Colo.) or at AVI BioPharma (Corvallis, Oreg.) and purified to >90% purity. Phosphorodiamidate morpholino oligomers (PMO) were synthesized at AVI BioPharma in accordance with known methods, as described, for example, in ((Summerton and Weller 1997) and U.S. Pat. No. 5,185,444 and further described in PCT application No. U.S. Ser. No. 08/012,804. Exemplary structures of the PMO are as shown in FIGS. 1A-C.
  • Some of the PMO oligomers were conjugated at the 3′ end with an arginine-rich peptide ((RXRRBR)2XB; SEQ ID NO:26) to form peptide-conjugated PMOs (PPMOs) to enhance cellular uptake as described (U.S. Pat. No. 7,468,418, PCT application No. US08/008168 and (Marshall, Oda et al. 2007; Abes, Moulton et al. 2008)).
  • A synthetic pathway that can be used to make morpholino subunits containing a (1-piperazino) phosphinylideneoxy linkage is described in PCT application No. U.S. Ser. No. 07/011,435 and further experimental detail for a representative synthesis is provided below. Reaction of piperazine and trityl chloride gave trityl piperazine, which was isolated as the succinate salt. Reaction with ethyl trifluoroacetate in the presence of a weak base (such as diisopropylethylamine or DIEA) provided 1-trifluoroacetyl-4-trityl piperazine, which was immediately reacted with HCl to provide the salt in good yield. Introduction of the dichlorophosphoryl moiety was performed with phosphorus oxychloride in toluene.
  • The acid chloride is reacted with morpholino subunits (moN), which may be prepared as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,185,444 or in Summerton and Weller, 1997 (cited above) and further described in PCT application No. U.S. Ser. No. 08/012,804, to provide the activated subunits. Suitable protecting groups are used for the nucleoside bases, where necessary; for example, benzoyl for adenine and cytosine, phenylacetyl for guanine, and pivaloylmethyl for inosine. The subunits containing the (1-piperazino) phosphinylideneoxy linkage can be incorporated into the existing PMO synthesis protocol, as described, for example in Summerton and Weller (1997), without modification.
  • Example 1 Activation of Glucocorticoid Receptor in an In Vivo Model System
  • Male Sprague Dawley rats were treated with vehicle (n=3) or glucocorticoid receptor antisense PMO targeting either GR exon 6 or exon 7 (SEQ ID NOs: 13 or 16, respectively) for three days at the dose of 30 mg/kg/day administered subcutaneously. The animals were subsequently challenged with dexamethasone and tyrosine aminotransferase (TAT) activity was measured in liver extracts six hours later. The target sequence for these two antisense oligomers between mouse and rats are conserved. The same two antisense oligomers were used to treat primary rat hepatocytes followed by measurement of TAT activity. The following table shows the level of TAT activity in the treated animals and primary hepatocytes relative to vehicle controls.
  • TABLE A
    Tyrosine aminotransferase (TAT) activity
    Name SEQ ID NO TAT activity (% control)
    Observations in vitro
    muSA6 16 +22.8
    muSA7 13 +13.4
    Observations in vivo
    muSA6 16 +81.2
    muSA7 13 +50.2
  • The above results indicate an induction of TAT activity when antisense PMO targeting either exons 6 or 7 are used in treatments. The loss of the GR ligand binding domain, through the selective removal of either exon 6 or 7, results in a ligand-independent glucocorticoid receptor or liGR by deleting the H3 domain (exon 6) or the H5 domain (exon 7) (see point mutation studied by Zhang et al (Zhang, Simisky et al. 2005)).
  • Example 2 Antisense Induced Alternative Splicing of Glucocorticoid Receptor Pre-mRNA in Rat Hepatocytes
  • To determine a molecular basis for the increased TAT activity described in Example 1, primary rat hepatocytes were treated with either dexamethasone at 100 nM, a MuSA6 peptide-conjugated PPMO at 5 μM (SEQ ID NO: 16 conjugated at the 3′ end to SEQ ID NO: 19) or a combination treatment with 100 nM dexamethasone and 5 μM MuSA6 PPMO. Total RNA was extracted and purified from Sprague Dawley primary rat hepatocytes using the QuickGene RNA cultured cell HC kit from Autogen. The resulting total RNA was reverse transcribed and PCR amplified using the SuperScript III 1-Step RTPCR kit from Life Technologies and the following primer pairs using standard conditions. The forward primer was directed to exon 4 (FWD: 5′ GTG CTG GAA GAA ACG ATT GC 3′) (SEQ ID NO:27) and the reverse primer was directed to exon 8 (REV: 5′ CAG TTG GTA AAA CCG TTG CC 3′) (SEQ ID NO:28). PCR amplification products using these primers are able to detect mRNA isoforms lacking exons 5 and/or 6. The expected PCR amplification products for the rat glucocorticoid mRNA isoform lacking exon 6 is 504 bp compared to 780 bp obtained from the full length mRNA isoform.
  • FIG. 4 indicates the presence of the expected 504 bp band only in MuSA6-treated hepatocytes. DNA sequence analysis was then performed on both the upper and lower bands from the RT-PCR reaction, and the precise removal of exon 6 was observed in the sequence from the lower 504 bp band. Antisense agents are thus capable of inducing precise exon-skipping of exon 6 of the glucocorticoid receptor.
  • Example 3 Pulmonary Administration of Antisense Agents Induces Alternative Splice Forms of the Glucocorticoid Receptor mRNA in an In Vivo Mouse Model
  • C57BL/6 mice were treated intranasally with 100 μg of peptide-conjugated MuSA7 PPMO (SEQ ID NO: 13 conjugated at the 3′ end to SEQ ID NO: 19) in 40 μl of PBS at −48 hr, −24 hr and −4 h. LPS was then administered intranasally at 0 hr (50 ug/mouse in 50 μl PBS) to induce an inflammatory response in the lungs. The mice were sacrificed at 0 min, 40 min, 90 min, 6 hr, and 22 hr post-LPS treatment. Lung tissue was used for both extraction of mRNA and subsequent RT-PCR for glucocorticoid receptor mRNA splice variants. RNA was extracted as described in Example 2, but a murine-specific pair of PCR primers was used ((FWD: 5′-GTG CTG GAA GAA ATG ATT GC-3′) (SEQ ID NO:29) and (REV: 5′-GTT GAT AAA ACC GCT GCC-3′) (SEQ ID NO:30)), directed to the same locations in exons 5 and 8 as described for the primers in Example 2.
  • FIG. 5 shows the presence of the expected alternative splice isoform lacking exon 7 (635 bp) compared to the band from the full length mRNA (780 bp). The upper and lower bands from the RT-PCR reactions were sequenced and the expected sequence indicating the precise removal of exon 7 was determined to be present in the lower 635 bp band. Antisense agents are thus capable of inducing precise in vivo exon-skipping of exon 7 of the glucocorticoid receptor.
  • Example 4 Antisense Agents Reduce T-Cell Activation in Stimulated Splenocytes
  • Carboxyfluorescein succinimidyl ester (CFSE)-labeled mouse splenocytes were stimulated at 0.5×106 cells/well in a 96 well plate on plate bound anti-CD3 at 10 μg/ml. A MuSA6 PPMO (SEQ ID NO:16 conjugated at the 3′ end to SEQ ID NO:19) was added at 10 μM, 5 μM, and 2.5 μM with or without 10×10−12 M dexamethasone. Soluble anti-CD28 was added at 10 μg/ml and cells were incubated at 37° C. for 72 hours. CD4+ and CD8+ T-cells were analyzed for CFSE dilution and CD25 by flow cytometry.
  • FIG. 6A shows that MuSA6 treatment reduces the mean fluorescence intensity of cell-surface activation marker CD25 on the surface of CD8+ T-cells. FIG. 6B shows that MuSA6 treatment also reduces the percentage of dividing CD8+ T-cells relative to controls. Parallel observations were made for CD4+ T-cells (FIGS. 6C and 6D). The legends in FIGS. 6A-6D refer to MuSA6 (the peptide-conjugated PMO described above) and Peptide only (SEQ ID NO: 19). Antisense-induced exon-skipping of exon 6 of the glucocorticoid receptor thus reduces activation of CD4+ and CD8+ T-cells.
  • SEQUENCE LISTING
    Seq
    ID
    Sequence (5′ to 3′) No
    TTCTTGAATAAACTGTGTAGCGCAGACCTTCCCATTACAGTTCATTTCTATGTATTTGTTTAAATACCCACA 1
    G/CTCGAAAAACAAAGAAAAAAATAAAAGGAATTCAGCAGGCCACTACAGGAGTCTCACAAGAAACCTCTGA
    AAATCCTGGTAACAAAACAATAGTTCCTGCAACGTTACCACAACTCACCCCTACCCTGGTGTCACTGTTGGA
    GGTTATTGAACCTGAAGTGTTATATGCAGGATATGATAGCTCTGTTCCAGACTCAACTTGGAGGATCATGAC
    TACGCTCAACATGTTAGGAGGGCGGCAAGTGATTGCAGCAGTGAAATGGGCAAAGGCAATACCAG/GTAAGA
    TGCAAAACATAAAAGAGCAACTATATAAACCTTTGTGTTTTCTTCAGCAAAAACACTTTGGCTTTTATATCA
    TCGTGAGCCCATGGCTTATCTTGTTTCTCTTAGTTCTGGGGACTATGAAGGGGAGAGTCAGGTGAATACAGG
    TGATAGGGAGTTTATAATAAAACATTTACATTACTCCCTGCTTTTCAAATCATTATGCACAGGATGGTAATT
    TCACATAGGATGATGTAATATCAGAATTCAAGTTACAAGACTCACTCAAAACTCCTTTTACACTGAAGTTTG
    GGGAAAGAAAATGTTTTTAGTTAATTCCATTTGTTTTCCTTCATTGTGCCACTTTTAAAAATCAGGTTGTTT
    GTAAGATTGGTAAACATCAAGTATGTTGATTGTCAAAATTTGTACTAAAGTAGAATGATTTTAACCCTTCAC
    TAAATGAAATGCTACACATTGAATGTAATTTTAAAGATAATTTTAAATAAAAGTTACCCTATTGGAATTTGG
    TGTGGAATGGCAGAGGTCAATGTTAGTGTCAGCTCTGACTTTAAAGACAGGGAATTGACAAGCCTGTGTTCA
    CGCAAATAGTTAGGGAGAGAGCAAGAAAGTAACCTGACCTCCTGTCATCCTTGTTTTATTAAGGGGGAAAGA
    GGTGTGAATAGCAGGGCAAATGTTTTGCTTAACTCATTGATTAATACCTCAAGCCAAGATTCTTTTCTGTTT
    TTTAAAATCAATACATAATAGTTGTACATATTTACTGTACATATTTATATTTAGGGGGTACATGTAATAATT
    TAATAAAAGCATACAACGTGTAAGGATCAAATCAGAGTAACTGGGATATCCATCACCTCAAACATTTGTTTG
    GGGAACATTCCAAATCTTCTCTTTTAGCTATTTTGAAATATAAAGTAAATTATTGTTAACTATAGTCATCCT
    GTTGTGCTACTGAACACTAAAACTTATTTCTTCTAACTGTATTTTTGCACCCGTCAACCATTCCCGCTTCAT
    CCCCATCACCACTATCTTTCCCGGTCACTGGTAACCGCCAAGCCAAGAATTTTGGCTATTTTACTATTTAGT
    TCATGTTTACTTAAGCAGACAGAGGTGACAAAACTGGCTTTTTTTTTTTTTTTTTACATTAAAAGCTATTAA
    AAAGCACCTAGGGGGCTGGGTGCGATGGCTCACGCCTGTAATCCCAGCACTTTGGGAAGCCCAGGTGGGTGG
    ATCAGTTGAGGTCAGGAGTTCGAGACCAGCCTGGCCAGCATAGCAAAACCCCATCTCTACTAAAATTACAAA
    AATTAGCCGGGCATGGTGGTATGAATCTGTATTCCTAGCTACTTGGGAGGCTGGCACTGAGAATCACTTGAA
    CCCGGGAGGCGGAGGTTGCAGTGAGCCGAGATGGCACCATTGCACTCCAGCCTGGGTGACAGAGCAAGACTT
    TGTCTCAATTAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAACACAAGAGGGTTTGTGAGTCTTAAAGTGTCAGATGACAG
    AAGAAAACTGTGTCTACCTAGTATTTAATTTCCATTTTCTGTTAGGGGTGCCCTTGTTTTGACAGGGCTAAT
    TGATCTCATTGCTCCTTGGCAATTCCCACAGAGATGATCTTCTGAAGAGTGTTGCCTCATACCTTTATTTCT
    CTTAATTCAG/GTTTCAGGAACTTACACCTGGATGACCAAATGACCCTACTGCAGTACTCCTGGATGTTTCT
    TATGGCATTTGCTCTGGGGTGGAGATCATATAGACAATCAAGTGCAAACCTGCTGTGTTTTGCTCCTGATCT
    GATTATTAATGA/GTAAGTTGTATGTGTGTCATTTTCCCTGTATTCATAGGGTATCTTTAACCAGCTGATGT
    TTTCCTGATTGACT
    TTCGAGCTGTGGGTATTTAAAC
    2
    TGTTTTTCGAGCTGTGGGTATT 3
    TTCTTTGTTTTTCGAGCTGTGG 4
    ATTTTTTTCTTTGTTTTTCGAG 5
    TTCCTTTTATTTTTTTCTTTGT 6
    TCTTGTGAGACTCCTGTAGTGG 7
    GCCTTTGCCCATTTCACTGCTG 8
    CCTGGTATTGCCTTTGCCCATT 9
    TCCTGAAACCTGAATTAAGAGA 10
    TAAGTTCCTGAAACCTGAATTA 11
    GGTCATCCAGGTGTAAGTTCCT 12
    CATTTGGTCATCCAGGTGTAAG 13
    AGGGTCATTTGGTCATCCAGGT 14
    CACATCTGGTCTCATTCCAGGG 15
    ATTTTTTTTCTTCGTTTTTCGAG 16
    ATTTTTTTCTTCGTTTTTCGAG 17
    RRRQRRKKRC 18
    RRRRRRRRRFFC 19
    RRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxB 20
    RAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRAhxB 21
    AhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxB 22
    RAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxB 23
    RAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxRAhxB 24
    RAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRRAhxRAhxB 25
    RAhxRRBRRAhxRRBRAhxB 26
    Primer GTG CTG GAA GAA ACG ATT GC 27
    Primer CAG TTG GTA AAA CCG TTG CC 28
    Primer GTG CTG GAA GAA ATG ATT GC 29
    Primer GTT GAT AAA ACC GCT GCC 30
    (X′Y′X′) (X′Z′Z′) (X′Y′X′) (X′Z′Z′) 31
    (RY′R) (RRY′) (RY′R) (RRY′) 32
    (RRY′) (RY′R) (RRY′) 33
    GCAGGGTAGAGTCATTCTCTGC 34
    GGTCGTACATGCAGGGTAGAGT 35
    ACATTGGTCGTACATGCAGGGT 36
    GAGAGAAGCAGTAAGGTTTTCA 37
    CTCTTCAGACCGTCCTTAGGAA 38
    GGCTCTTCAGACCGTCCTTAGG 39
    AGGTCATTCTAATTTCATCAAA 40
    CATGCATAGAATCCAAGAGTTT 41
  • REFERENCES
    • Abes, R., H. M. Moulton, et al. (2008). “Delivery of steric block morpholino oligomers by (R-X-R)4 peptides: structure-activity studies.” Nucleic Acids Res.
    • Graziewicz, M. A., T. K. Tarrant, et al. (2008). “An endogenous TNF-alpha antagonist induced by splice-switching oligonucleotides reduces inflammation in hepatitis and arthritis mouse models.” Mol Ther 16(7): 1316-22.
    • Gronemeyer, H., J. A. Gustafsson, et al. (2004). “Principles for modulation of the nuclear receptor superfamily.” Nat Rev Drug Discov 3(11): 950-64.
    • Marshall, N. B., S. K. Oda, et al. (2007). “Arginine-rich cell-penetrating peptides facilitate delivery of antisense oligomers into murine leukocytes and alter pre-mRNA splicing.” Journal of Immunological Methods 325(1-2): 114-126.
    • Moulton, H. M., M. H. Nelson, et al. (2004). “Cellular uptake of antisense morpholino oligomers conjugated to arginine-rich peptides.” Bioconjug Chem 15(2): 290-9.
    • Newton, R., R. Leigh, et al. (2010). “Pharmacological strategies for improving the efficacy and therapeutic ratio of glucocorticoids in inflammatory lung diseases.” Pharmacol Ther 125(2): 286-327.
    • Overington, J. P., B. Al-Lazikani, et al. (2006). “How many drug targets are there?” Nat Rev Drug Discov 5(12): 993-6.
    • Sazani, P., R. Kole, et al. (2007). Splice switching oligomers for the TNF superfamily receptors and their use in treatment of disease. PCT WO2007058894.
    • Summerton, J. and D. Weller (1997). “Morpholino antisense oligomers: design, preparation, and properties.” Antisense Nucleic Acid Drug Dev 7(3): 187-95.
    • Zhang, J., J. Simisky, et al. (2005). “A critical role of helix 3-helix 5 interaction in steroid hormone receptor function.” Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 102(8): 2707-12.

Claims (24)

1.-50. (canceled)
51. An antisense morpholino oligomer of 20 to 30 bases comprising a base sequence that is complementary to at least 15 contiguous bases of SEQ ID NO:1, wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer alters splicing of the human glucocorticoid receptor (GR) pre-mRNA transcript and increases expression of a ligand independent form of the GR; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
52. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer has 20 to 23 bases.
53. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the base sequence is complementary to at least 17 contiguous bases of SEQ ID NO:1.
54. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the base sequence is complementary to at least 20 contiguous bases of SEQ ID NO:1.
55. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the base sequence is 100% complementary to contiguous bases of SEQ ID NO:1.
56. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer contains about 10%-50% intersubunit cationic linkages.
57. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer comprises an arginine-rich carrier peptide.
58. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 57, wherein the peptide is linked at its C-terminus to the 5′ end of the antisense morpholino oligomer through a one or two-amino acid linker.
59. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 57, wherein the peptide is linked at its C-terminus to the 3′ end of the antisense morpholino oligomer through a one or two-amino acid linker.
60. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 59, wherein the linker is AhxβAla, wherein Ahx is 6-amino hexanoic acid and βAla is β-alanine.
61. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the arginine-rich carrier peptide is selected from any one of SEQ ID NOS: 18-26.
62. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer comprises phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkages in accordance with the structure:
Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00008
wherein Z═O, Y1═O, and X═N(CH3)2.
63. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 56, wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer comprises phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkages in accordance with the structure:
Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00009
wherein Z is S or O,
X═NR1R2 or OR6,
Y1═O or NR7,
and each phosphorus-containing linkage is independently selected from:
(a) uncharged linkage (a), wherein each of R1, R2, R6, and R7 is independently selected from hydrogen and lower alkyl;
(b1) cationic linkage (b1), wherein X═NR1R2 and Y1═O, wherein NR1R2 represents a group of the formula:
Figure US20150368653A1-20151224-C00010
wherein each R is independently H or CH3,
R4 is H, CH3 or an electron pair, and
R3 is selected from H, lower alkyl, C(═NH)NH2, Z-L-NHC(═NH)NH2, and
[C(O)CHR′NH]mH, wherein Z is carbonyl (C(O)) or a direct bond, L is an optional linker up to 18 atoms in length having bonds selected from alkyl, alkoxy, and alkylamino, R′ is a side chain of a naturally occurring amino acid or a one- or two-carbon homolog thereof, and m is 1 to 6;
(b2) cationic linkage (b2), wherein X═NR1R2 and Y1═O, wherein R1═H or CH3, and R2=LNR3R4R5, wherein L, R3, and R4 are defined as above, and R5 is H, lower alkyl, or lower (alkoxy)alkyl; and
(b3) cationic linkage (b3), wherein Y═NR′ and X═OR6, wherein R7=LNR3R4R5, wherein L, R3, R4, and R5 are defined as above, and R6 is H or lower alkyl;
wherein at least one phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkage is selected from cationic linkages (b1), (b2), and (b3).
64. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 63, wherein each of R1 and R2, in linkages of type (a), is methyl.
65. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 63, wherein at least one phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, R4 is H, CH3, or an electron pair, and R3 is selected from H, CH3, C(═NH)NH2, and C(O)-L-NHC(═NH)NH2.
66. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 63, wherein at least one phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, R4 is an electron pair, and R3 is selected from C(═NH)NH2 and C(O)-L-NHC(═NH)NH2.
67. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 66, wherein R3 is C(O)-L-NHC(NH)NH2, and L is a hydrocarbon having the structure —(CH2)n—, where n is 1 to 12.
68. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 63, wherein at least one phosphorus-containing intersubunit linkage is of type (b1), where each R is H, and each of R3 and R4 is independently H or CH3.
69. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the base sequence comprises any one of SEQ ID NOS:2-14.
70. The antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51, wherein the base sequence consists of any one of SEQ ID NOS:2-14.
71. A pharmaceutical composition comprising: (i) an antisense morpholino oligomer of claim 51 or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and (ii) a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
72. An antisense morpholino oligomer of 20 to 30 bases comprising a base sequence that is 100% complementary to contiguous bases of SEQ ID NO:1, wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer comprises phosphorodiamidate intersubunit linkages, and wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer alters splicing of the human glucocorticoid receptor (GR) pre-mRNA transcript and increases expression of a ligand independent form of the GR; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
73. A pharmaceutical composition comprising: (i) an antisense morpholino oligomer of 20 to 30 bases comprising a base sequence that is 100% complementary to contiguous bases of SEQ ID NO:1, wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer comprises phosphorodiamidate intersubunit linkages, and wherein the antisense morpholino oligomer alters splicing of the human glucocorticoid receptor (GR) pre-mRNA transcript and increases expression of a ligand independent form of the GR; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and (ii) a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
US14/716,141 2010-03-12 2015-05-19 Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors Abandoned US20150368653A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US14/716,141 US20150368653A1 (en) 2010-03-12 2015-05-19 Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US31365210P 2010-03-12 2010-03-12
US13/046,356 US9068185B2 (en) 2010-03-12 2011-03-11 Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors
US14/716,141 US20150368653A1 (en) 2010-03-12 2015-05-19 Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US13/046,356 Continuation US9068185B2 (en) 2010-03-12 2011-03-11 Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20150368653A1 true US20150368653A1 (en) 2015-12-24

Family

ID=44009904

Family Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US13/046,356 Expired - Fee Related US9068185B2 (en) 2010-03-12 2011-03-11 Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors
US14/716,141 Abandoned US20150368653A1 (en) 2010-03-12 2015-05-19 Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors

Family Applications Before (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US13/046,356 Expired - Fee Related US9068185B2 (en) 2010-03-12 2011-03-11 Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors

Country Status (3)

Country Link
US (2) US9068185B2 (en)
EP (1) EP2545173A2 (en)
WO (1) WO2011113015A2 (en)

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US10202602B2 (en) 2010-05-28 2019-02-12 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Oligonucleotide analogues having modified intersubunit linkages and/or terminal groups

Families Citing this family (17)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2004097017A2 (en) 2003-04-29 2004-11-11 Avi Biopharma, Inc. Compositions for enhancing transport and antisense efficacy of nucleic acid analog into cells
US8067571B2 (en) 2005-07-13 2011-11-29 Avi Biopharma, Inc. Antibacterial antisense oligonucleotide and method
US20100016215A1 (en) * 2007-06-29 2010-01-21 Avi Biopharma, Inc. Compound and method for treating myotonic dystrophy
US20110269665A1 (en) 2009-06-26 2011-11-03 Avi Biopharma, Inc. Compound and method for treating myotonic dystrophy
EP2545173A2 (en) * 2010-03-12 2013-01-16 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors
WO2012031243A2 (en) 2010-09-03 2012-03-08 Avi Biopharma, Inc. dsRNA MOLECULES COMPRISING OLIGONUCLEOTIDE ANALOGS HAVING MODIFIED INTERSUBUNIT LINKAGES AND/OR TERMINAL GROUPS
US9161948B2 (en) 2011-05-05 2015-10-20 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Peptide oligonucleotide conjugates
CA2854907C (en) 2011-11-18 2020-03-10 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Functionally-modified oligonucleotides and subunits thereof
CN102526742B (en) * 2012-03-05 2013-07-10 中国药科大学 Functional nano-carrier with escape capability of lysosome and preparation method of same
US10119135B2 (en) * 2012-05-22 2018-11-06 Ruprecht-Karls-Universität Heidelberg Therapeutic micro RNA targets in chronic pulmonary diseases
US8859774B2 (en) 2012-05-25 2014-10-14 Corcept Therapeutics, Inc. Heteroaryl-ketone fused azadecalin glucocorticoid receptor modulators
AR092982A1 (en) 2012-10-11 2015-05-13 Isis Pharmaceuticals Inc MODULATION OF THE EXPRESSION OF ANDROGEN RECEIVERS
WO2016196897A1 (en) 2015-06-04 2016-12-08 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Methods and compounds for treatment of lymphocyte-related diseases and conditions
EP3211081A1 (en) * 2016-02-26 2017-08-30 Secarna Pharmaceuticals GmbH & Co. KG Novel approach for treating inflammatory disorders
EP3420084B1 (en) 2016-02-26 2021-08-04 Secarna Pharmaceuticals GmbH & Co. KG Novel approach for treating inflammatory disorders
WO2019167995A1 (en) * 2018-02-28 2019-09-06 国立大学法人東京医科歯科大学 Ischemic-lesion-site-specific gene therapy
BR112021010461A2 (en) 2018-12-19 2021-08-24 Corcept Therapeutics Incorporated Formulation and unit dose for oral administration of relacorillant

Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US8779128B2 (en) * 2010-05-28 2014-07-15 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Oligonucleotide analogues having modified intersubunit linkages and/or terminal groups
US9068185B2 (en) * 2010-03-12 2015-06-30 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors
US9161948B2 (en) * 2011-05-05 2015-10-20 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Peptide oligonucleotide conjugates

Family Cites Families (110)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CH445129A (en) 1964-04-29 1967-10-15 Nestle Sa Process for the preparation of high molecular weight inclusion compounds
US3459731A (en) 1966-12-16 1969-08-05 Corn Products Co Cyclodextrin polyethers and their production
US3453257A (en) 1967-02-13 1969-07-01 Corn Products Co Cyclodextrin with cationic properties
US3426011A (en) 1967-02-13 1969-02-04 Corn Products Co Cyclodextrins with anionic properties
US3453259A (en) 1967-03-22 1969-07-01 Corn Products Co Cyclodextrin polyol ethers and their oxidation products
US3687808A (en) 1969-08-14 1972-08-29 Univ Leland Stanford Junior Synthetic polynucleotides
US4235871A (en) 1978-02-24 1980-11-25 Papahadjopoulos Demetrios P Method of encapsulating biologically active materials in lipid vesicles
US4469863A (en) 1980-11-12 1984-09-04 Ts O Paul O P Nonionic nucleic acid alkyl and aryl phosphonates and processes for manufacture and use thereof
US5023243A (en) 1981-10-23 1991-06-11 Molecular Biosystems, Inc. Oligonucleotide therapeutic agent and method of making same
US4476301A (en) 1982-04-29 1984-10-09 Centre National De La Recherche Scientifique Oligonucleotides, a process for preparing the same and their application as mediators of the action of interferon
US5550111A (en) 1984-07-11 1996-08-27 Temple University-Of The Commonwealth System Of Higher Education Dual action 2',5'-oligoadenylate antiviral derivatives and uses thereof
US5235033A (en) 1985-03-15 1993-08-10 Anti-Gene Development Group Alpha-morpholino ribonucleoside derivatives and polymers thereof
US5405938A (en) 1989-12-20 1995-04-11 Anti-Gene Development Group Sequence-specific binding polymers for duplex nucleic acids
US5185444A (en) 1985-03-15 1993-02-09 Anti-Gene Deveopment Group Uncharged morpolino-based polymers having phosphorous containing chiral intersubunit linkages
US5521063A (en) 1985-03-15 1996-05-28 Antivirals Inc. Polynucleotide reagent containing chiral subunits and methods of use
US5166315A (en) 1989-12-20 1992-11-24 Anti-Gene Development Group Sequence-specific binding polymers for duplex nucleic acids
US5506337A (en) 1985-03-15 1996-04-09 Antivirals Inc. Morpholino-subunit combinatorial library and method
US5034506A (en) 1985-03-15 1991-07-23 Anti-Gene Development Group Uncharged morpholino-based polymers having achiral intersubunit linkages
US5217866A (en) 1985-03-15 1993-06-08 Anti-Gene Development Group Polynucleotide assay reagent and method
ATE171185T1 (en) 1985-03-15 1998-10-15 Antivirals Inc POLYNUCLEOTIDE IMMUNOTESTING AGENTS AND METHODS
US4737323A (en) 1986-02-13 1988-04-12 Liposome Technology, Inc. Liposome extrusion method
DE3788914T2 (en) 1986-09-08 1994-08-25 Ajinomoto Kk Compounds for cleaving RNA at a specific position, oligomers used in the preparation of these compounds and starting materials for the synthesis of these oligomers.
US5276019A (en) 1987-03-25 1994-01-04 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Inhibitors for replication of retroviruses and for the expression of oncogene products
US5264423A (en) 1987-03-25 1993-11-23 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Inhibitors for replication of retroviruses and for the expression of oncogene products
US5188897A (en) 1987-10-22 1993-02-23 Temple University Of The Commonwealth System Of Higher Education Encapsulated 2',5'-phosphorothioate oligoadenylates
US4924624A (en) 1987-10-22 1990-05-15 Temple University-Of The Commonwealth System Of Higher Education 2,',5'-phosphorothioate oligoadenylates and plant antiviral uses thereof
WO1989005358A1 (en) 1987-11-30 1989-06-15 University Of Iowa Research Foundation Dna and rna molecules stabilized by modifications of the 3'-terminal phosphodiester linkage and their use as nucleic acid probes and as therapeutic agents to block the expression of specifically targeted genes
US5403711A (en) 1987-11-30 1995-04-04 University Of Iowa Research Foundation Nucleic acid hybridization and amplification method for detection of specific sequences in which a complementary labeled nucleic acid probe is cleaved
US5543508A (en) 1987-12-15 1996-08-06 Gene Shears Pty. Limited Ribozymes
EP0406309A4 (en) 1988-03-25 1992-08-19 The University Of Virginia Alumni Patents Foundation Oligonucleotide n-alkylphosphoramidates
US5278302A (en) 1988-05-26 1994-01-11 University Patents, Inc. Polynucleotide phosphorodithioates
US5216141A (en) 1988-06-06 1993-06-01 Benner Steven A Oligonucleotide analogs containing sulfur linkages
US5256775A (en) 1989-06-05 1993-10-26 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Exonuclease-resistant oligonucleotides
US5399676A (en) 1989-10-23 1995-03-21 Gilead Sciences Oligonucleotides with inverted polarity
US5264564A (en) 1989-10-24 1993-11-23 Gilead Sciences Oligonucleotide analogs with novel linkages
US5264562A (en) 1989-10-24 1993-11-23 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Oligonucleotide analogs with novel linkages
US5177198A (en) 1989-11-30 1993-01-05 University Of N.C. At Chapel Hill Process for preparing oligoribonucleoside and oligodeoxyribonucleoside boranophosphates
US5955589A (en) 1991-12-24 1999-09-21 Isis Pharmaceuticals Inc. Gapped 2' modified oligonucleotides
US5623065A (en) 1990-08-13 1997-04-22 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Gapped 2' modified oligonucleotides
US5587361A (en) 1991-10-15 1996-12-24 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oligonucleotides having phosphorothioate linkages of high chiral purity
KR0166088B1 (en) 1990-01-23 1999-01-15 . Derivatives of cyclodextrins exhibiting enhanced aqueous solubility and the use thereof
US5149797A (en) 1990-02-15 1992-09-22 The Worcester Foundation For Experimental Biology Method of site-specific alteration of rna and production of encoded polypeptides
US5220007A (en) 1990-02-15 1993-06-15 The Worcester Foundation For Experimental Biology Method of site-specific alteration of RNA and production of encoded polypeptides
US5321131A (en) 1990-03-08 1994-06-14 Hybridon, Inc. Site-specific functionalization of oligodeoxynucleotides for non-radioactive labelling
US5470967A (en) 1990-04-10 1995-11-28 The Dupont Merck Pharmaceutical Company Oligonucleotide analogs with sulfamate linkages
US5608046A (en) 1990-07-27 1997-03-04 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Conjugated 4'-desmethyl nucleoside analog compounds
US5618704A (en) 1990-07-27 1997-04-08 Isis Pharmacueticals, Inc. Backbone-modified oligonucleotide analogs and preparation thereof through radical coupling
US5610289A (en) 1990-07-27 1997-03-11 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Backbone modified oligonucleotide analogues
US5602240A (en) 1990-07-27 1997-02-11 Ciba Geigy Ag. Backbone modified oligonucleotide analogs
US5489677A (en) 1990-07-27 1996-02-06 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oligonucleoside linkages containing adjacent oxygen and nitrogen atoms
US5623070A (en) 1990-07-27 1997-04-22 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Heteroatomic oligonucleoside linkages
US5541307A (en) 1990-07-27 1996-07-30 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Backbone modified oligonucleotide analogs and solid phase synthesis thereof
US5677437A (en) 1990-07-27 1997-10-14 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Heteroatomic oligonucleoside linkages
PT98562B (en) 1990-08-03 1999-01-29 Sanofi Sa PROCESS FOR THE PREPARATION OF COMPOSITIONS THAT UNDERSEAD SEEDS OF NUCLEO-SIDS WITH NEAR 6 TO NEAR 200 NUCLEASE-RESISTANT BASES
US5177196A (en) 1990-08-16 1993-01-05 Microprobe Corporation Oligo (α-arabinofuranosyl nucleotides) and α-arabinofuranosyl precursors thereof
US5214134A (en) 1990-09-12 1993-05-25 Sterling Winthrop Inc. Process of linking nucleosides with a siloxane bridge
US5561225A (en) 1990-09-19 1996-10-01 Southern Research Institute Polynucleotide analogs containing sulfonate and sulfonamide internucleoside linkages
EP0549686A4 (en) 1990-09-20 1995-01-18 Gilead Sciences Inc Modified internucleoside linkages
US5539082A (en) 1993-04-26 1996-07-23 Nielsen; Peter E. Peptide nucleic acids
US5719262A (en) 1993-11-22 1998-02-17 Buchardt, Deceased; Ole Peptide nucleic acids having amino acid side chains
US5714331A (en) 1991-05-24 1998-02-03 Buchardt, Deceased; Ole Peptide nucleic acids having enhanced binding affinity, sequence specificity and solubility
JPH07501204A (en) 1991-06-28 1995-02-09 マサチューセッツ インスティテュート オブ テクノロジー Topical oligonucleotide therapy
EP0621944B1 (en) 1991-07-25 1997-03-05 The Whitaker Corporation Liquid level sensor
US5571799A (en) 1991-08-12 1996-11-05 Basco, Ltd. (2'-5') oligoadenylate analogues useful as inhibitors of host-v5.-graft response
US5700922A (en) 1991-12-24 1997-12-23 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. PNA-DNA-PNA chimeric macromolecules
US5633360A (en) 1992-04-14 1997-05-27 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Oligonucleotide analogs capable of passive cell membrane permeation
US5434257A (en) 1992-06-01 1995-07-18 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Binding compentent oligomers containing unsaturated 3',5' and 2',5' linkages
AU4769893A (en) 1992-07-17 1994-02-14 Ribozyme Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method and reagent for treatment of animal diseases
US5652355A (en) 1992-07-23 1997-07-29 Worcester Foundation For Experimental Biology Hybrid oligonucleotide phosphorothioates
US5476925A (en) 1993-02-01 1995-12-19 Northwestern University Oligodeoxyribonucleotides including 3'-aminonucleoside-phosphoramidate linkages and terminal 3'-amino groups
GB9304618D0 (en) 1993-03-06 1993-04-21 Ciba Geigy Ag Chemical compounds
CA2159629A1 (en) 1993-03-31 1994-10-13 Sanofi Oligonucleotides with amide linkages replacing phosphodiester linkages
EP0733059B1 (en) 1993-12-09 2000-09-13 Thomas Jefferson University Compounds and methods for site-directed mutations in eukaryotic cells
US5625050A (en) 1994-03-31 1997-04-29 Amgen Inc. Modified oligonucleotides and intermediates useful in nucleic acid therapeutics
US5820873A (en) 1994-09-30 1998-10-13 The University Of British Columbia Polyethylene glycol modified ceramide lipids and liposome uses thereof
US5885613A (en) 1994-09-30 1999-03-23 The University Of British Columbia Bilayer stabilizing components and their use in forming programmable fusogenic liposomes
US5753613A (en) 1994-09-30 1998-05-19 Inex Pharmaceuticals Corporation Compositions for the introduction of polyanionic materials into cells
IL115849A0 (en) 1994-11-03 1996-01-31 Merz & Co Gmbh & Co Tangential filtration preparation of liposomal drugs and liposome product thereof
US5545729A (en) 1994-12-22 1996-08-13 Hybridon, Inc. Stabilized ribozyme analogs
US5652356A (en) 1995-08-17 1997-07-29 Hybridon, Inc. Inverted chimeric and hybrid oligonucleotides
US6245747B1 (en) 1996-03-12 2001-06-12 The Board Of Regents Of The University Of Nebraska Targeted site specific antisense oligodeoxynucleotide delivery method
US6794499B2 (en) 1997-09-12 2004-09-21 Exiqon A/S Oligonucleotide analogues
US7572582B2 (en) 1997-09-12 2009-08-11 Exiqon A/S Oligonucleotide analogues
WO1999042091A2 (en) 1998-02-19 1999-08-26 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Use of polycations as endosomolytic agents
US7084125B2 (en) 1999-03-18 2006-08-01 Exiqon A/S Xylo-LNA analogues
ATE356824T1 (en) 1999-05-04 2007-04-15 Santaris Pharma As L-RIBO-LNA ANALOGUE
US7070807B2 (en) 1999-12-29 2006-07-04 Mixson A James Branched histidine copolymers and methods for using same
US7163695B2 (en) 1999-12-29 2007-01-16 Mixson A James Histidine copolymer and methods for using same
US6756213B1 (en) * 2000-10-11 2004-06-29 Applera Corporation Nucleic acid encoding retinoic acid receptor
CA2459347C (en) 2001-09-04 2012-10-09 Exiqon A/S Locked nucleic acid (lna) compositions and uses thereof
KR100464261B1 (en) 2002-01-24 2005-01-03 주식회사 파나진 A Novel Monomer For Synthesis of PNA Oligomer And A Process For Producing The Same
KR20030084444A (en) 2002-04-26 2003-11-01 주식회사 파나진 A Novel Monomer For Synthesis of PNA Oligomer And A Process For Producing The Same
US7569575B2 (en) 2002-05-08 2009-08-04 Santaris Pharma A/S Synthesis of locked nucleic acid derivatives
AU2003233634A1 (en) * 2002-05-20 2003-12-12 Pharmacia Corporation Antisense modulation of glucocorticoid receptor expression
WO2004097017A2 (en) * 2003-04-29 2004-11-11 Avi Biopharma, Inc. Compositions for enhancing transport and antisense efficacy of nucleic acid analog into cells
WO2005014782A2 (en) 2003-06-13 2005-02-17 Alnylam Europe Ag., Double-stranded ribonucleic acid with increased effectiveness in an organism
US7211668B2 (en) 2003-07-28 2007-05-01 Panagene, Inc. PNA monomer and precursor
CA2538729A1 (en) 2003-09-12 2005-03-31 Avi Biopharma, Inc. Compound and method for treating androgen-independent prostate cancer
EP2363480A3 (en) * 2004-01-20 2015-10-07 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Modulation of glucocorticoid receptor expression
AU2005325262B2 (en) 2004-04-27 2011-08-11 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Single-stranded and double-stranded oligonucleotides comprising a 2-arylpropyl moiety
CA2572151A1 (en) 2004-06-30 2006-08-24 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oligonucleotides comprising a non-phosphate backbone linkage
US7579451B2 (en) 2004-07-21 2009-08-25 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oligonucleotides comprising a modified or non-natural nucleobase
EP1913011B1 (en) 2004-08-04 2016-11-02 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals Inc. Oligonucleotides comprising a ligand tethered to a modified or non-natural nucleobase
US8357664B2 (en) 2004-10-26 2013-01-22 Avi Biopharma, Inc. Antisense antiviral compound and method for treating influenza viral infection
CA2621964A1 (en) * 2005-09-08 2007-03-15 Avi Biopharma, Inc. Antisense antiviral compound and method for treating picornavirus infection
EP2368988A1 (en) 2005-09-19 2011-09-28 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Modulation of Glucocorticoid Receptor Expression
CA2629323A1 (en) 2005-11-10 2007-05-24 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Splice switching oligomers for tnf superfamily receptors and their use in treatment of disease
JP2009536222A (en) * 2006-05-05 2009-10-08 アイシス ファーマシューティカルズ, インコーポレーテッド Compounds and methods for modulating the expression of PCSK9
LT2024499T (en) 2006-05-10 2018-02-26 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Oligonucleotide analogs having cationic intersubunit linkages
JP5653160B2 (en) 2010-10-15 2015-01-14 ダンロップスポーツ株式会社 Golf ball

Patent Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US9068185B2 (en) * 2010-03-12 2015-06-30 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors
US8779128B2 (en) * 2010-05-28 2014-07-15 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Oligonucleotide analogues having modified intersubunit linkages and/or terminal groups
US9161948B2 (en) * 2011-05-05 2015-10-20 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Peptide oligonucleotide conjugates

Non-Patent Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
Bronnegard et al. TEM 6: 160-164, 1995 *
Charmandari et al. The Journal of Clinical Endocrinology & Metabolism 90:3696-3705, 2005 *
Lowenberg et al. Steroids 73:1025-1029, 2008 *

Cited By (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US10202602B2 (en) 2010-05-28 2019-02-12 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Oligonucleotide analogues having modified intersubunit linkages and/or terminal groups
US10760078B2 (en) 2010-05-28 2020-09-01 Sarepta Therapeutics, Inc. Oligonucleotide analogues having modified intersubunit linkages and/or terminal groups

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US20110224283A1 (en) 2011-09-15
EP2545173A2 (en) 2013-01-16
US9068185B2 (en) 2015-06-30
WO2011113015A3 (en) 2011-10-27
WO2011113015A2 (en) 2011-09-15

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US9068185B2 (en) Antisense modulation of nuclear hormone receptors
EP2569431B1 (en) Methods for identifying compounds which modulate interleukins 17 and 23 signaling activity
US20230151362A1 (en) Methods and means for efficient dkipping of exon 45 in duchenne muscular dystrophy pre-mrna
KR102329187B1 (en) Oligonucleotide analogues targeting human LMNA
AU2009310557B2 (en) Methods and means for efficient skipping of exon 45 in Duchenne Muscular Dystrophy pre-mRNA
US9394323B2 (en) Antisense antiviral compound and method for treating influenza viral infection
EP3133160B1 (en) Exon skipping compositions for dmd
KR20210081323A (en) Muscle targeting complexes and their use for treating myotonic dystrophy
JP2024525614A (en) Muscle targeting complexes and their use for modulating genes associated with muscle health - Patents.com

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION